You are on page 1of 478

GE Healthcare

Technical
Publication

Direction 5154945
Revision 4
GE Healthcare
LOGIQ™P5/A5 Service Manual

Operating Documentation

Copyright© 2008 by General Electric Co.


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Page 1-2 -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Important Precautions

• THIS SERVICE MANUAL IS AVAILABLE IN ENGLISH ONLY.


• IF A CUSTOMER’S SERVICE PROVIDER REQUIRES A LANGUAGE OTHER
THAN ENGLISH, IT IS THE CUSTOMER’S RESPONSIBILITY TO PROVIDE
TRANSLATION SERVICES.
WARNING • DO NOT ATTEMPT TO SERVICE THE EQUIPMENT UNLESS THIS SERVICE
(EN) MANUAL HAS BEEN CONSULTED AND IS UNDERSTOOD.
• FAILURE TO HEED THIS WARNING MAY RESULT IN INJURY TO THE SERVICE
PROVIDER, OPERATOR OR PATIENT FROM ELECTRIC SHOCK, MECHANICAL
OR OTHER HAZARDS.

• CE MANUEL DE MAINTENANCE N’EST DISPONIBLE QU’EN ANGLAIS.


• SI LE TECHNICIEN DU CLIENT A BESOIN DE CE MANUEL DANS UNE AUTRE
LANGUE QUE L’ANGLAIS, C’EST AU CLIENT QU’IL INCOMBE DE LE FAIRE
TRADUIRE.
AVERTISSEMENT • NE PAS TENTER D’INTERVENTION SUR LES é QUIPEMENTS TANT QUE LE
(FR)
MANUEL SERVICE N’A PAS é Té CONSULTé ET COMPRIS.
• LE NON-RESPECT DE CET AVERTISSEMENT PEUT ENTRAîNER CHEZ LE
TECHNICIEN, L’OPé RATEUR OU LE PATIENT DES BLESSURES DUES à DES
DANGERS é LECTRIQUES, Mé CANIQUES OU AUTRES.

• DIESES KUNDENDIENST-HANDBUCH EXISTIERT NUR IN ENGLISCHER


SPRACHE.
• FALLS EIN FREMDER KUNDENDIENST EINE ANDERE SPRACHE BENö TIGT,
IST ES AUFGABE DES KUNDEN Fü R EINE ENTSPRECHENDE ÜBERSETZUNG
ZU SORGEN.
• VERSUCHEN SIE NICHT, DAS GERä T ZU REPARIEREN, BEVOR DIESES
WARNUNG
(DE) KUNDENDIENST-HANDBUCH NICHT ZU RATE GEZOGEN UND VERSTANDEN
WURDE.
• WIRD DIESE WARNUNG NICHT BEACHTET, SO KANN ES ZU VERLETZUNGEN
DES KUNDENDIENSTTECHNIKERS, DES BEDIENERS ODER DES PATIENTEN
DURCH ELEKTRISCHE SCHLä GE, MECHANISCHE ODER SONSTIGE
GEFAHREN KOMMEN.

- i
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

• ESTE MANUAL DE SERVICIO Só LO EXISTE EN INGLé S.


• SI ALGú N PROVEEDOR DE SERVICIOS AJENO A GEHC SOLICITA UN IDIOMA
QUE NO SEA EL INGLé S, ES RESPONSABILIDAD DEL CLIENTE OFRECER UN
SERVICIO DE TRADUCCIó N.
AVISO • NO SE DEBERá DAR SERVICIO Té CNICO AL EQUIPO, SIN HABER
(ES) CONSULTADO Y COMPRENDIDO ESTE MANUAL DE SERVICIO.
• LA NO OBSERVANCIA DEL PRESENTE AVISO PUEDE DAR LUGAR A QUE EL
PROVEEDOR DE SERVICIOS, EL OPERADOR O EL PACIENTE SUFRAN
LESIONES PROVOCADAS POR CAUSAS ELé CTRICAS, MECá NICAS O DE
OTRA NATURALEZA.

• ESTE MANUAL DE ASSISTê NCIA Té CNICA Só SE ENCONTRA DISPONíVEL EM


INGLê S.
• SE QUALQUER OUTRO SERVIç O DE ASSISTê NCIA Té CNICA, QUE Nã O A
GEHC, SOLICITAR ESTES MANUAIS NOUTRO IDIOMA, é DA
RESPONSABILIDADE DO CLIENTE FORNECER OS SERVIç OS DE TRADUç ã O.
ATENÇÃO
(PT) • Nã O TENTE REPARAR O EQUIPAMENTO SEM TER CONSULTADO E
COMPREENDIDO ESTE MANUAL DE ASSISTê NCIA Té CNICA.
• O Nã O CUMPRIMENTO DESTE AVISO PODE POR EM PERIGO A SEGURANç A
DO Té CNICO, OPERADOR OU PACIENTE DEVIDO A‘ CHOQUES ELé TRICOS,
MECâ NICOS OU OUTROS.

• IL PRESENTE MANUALE DI MANUTENZIONE è DISPONIBILE SOLTANTO IN


INGLESE.
• SE UN ADDETTO ALLA MANUTENZIONE ESTERNO ALLA GEHC RICHIEDE IL
MANUALE IN UNA LINGUA DIVERSA, IL CLIENTE è TENUTO A PROVVEDERE
DIRETTAMENTE ALLA TRADUZIONE.
AVVERTENZA • SI PROCEDA ALLA MANUTENZIONE DELL’APPARECCHIATURA SOLO DOPO
(IT) AVER CONSULTATO IL PRESENTE MANUALE ED AVERNE COMPRESO IL
CONTENUTO.
• NON TENERE CONTO DELLA PRESENTE AVVERTENZA POTREBBE FAR
COMPIERE OPERAZIONI DA CUI DERIVINO LESIONI ALL’ADDETTO ALLA
MANUTENZIONE, ALL’UTILIZZATORE ED AL PAZIENTE PER FOLGORAZIONE
ELETTRICA, PER URTI MECCANICI OD ALTRI RISCHI.

• KÄESOLEV TEENINDUSJUHEND ON SAADAVAL AINULT INGLISE KEELES.


• KUI KLIENDITEENINDUSE OSUTAJA Nõ UAB JUHENDIT INGLISE KEELEST
ERINEVAS KEELES, VASTUTAB KLIENT Tõ LKETEENUSE OSUTAMISE EEST.
HOIATUS • ä RGE ü RITAGE SEADMEID TEENINDADA ENNE EELNEVALT Kä ESOLEVA
(ET)
TEENINDUSJUHENDIGA TUTVUMIST JA SELLEST ARU SAAMIST.
• Kä ESOLEVA HOIATUSE EIRAMINE Võ IB Põ HJUSTADA TEENUSEOSUTAJA,
OPERAATORI Võ I PATSIENDI VIGASTAMIST ELEKTRILö ö GI, MEHAANILISE
Võ I MUU OHU TAGAJä RJEL.

ii -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

• TÄMÄ HUOLTO-OHJE ON SAATAVILLA VAIN ENGLANNIKSI.


• JOS ASIAKKAAN PALVELUNTARJOAJA VAATII MUUTA KUIN
ENGLANNINKIELISTä MATERIAALIA, TARVITTAVAN Kä ä NNö KSEN
HANKKIMINEN ON ASIAKKAAN VASTUULLA.
VAROITUS • ä Lä YRITä KORJATA LAITTEISTOA ENNEN KUIN OLET VARMASTI LUKENUT
(FI)
JA YMMä RTä NYT Tä Mä N HUOLTO-OHJEEN.
• MIKä LI Tä Tä VAROITUSTA EI NOUDATETA, SEURAUKSENA VOI OLLA
PALVELUNTARJOAJAN, LAITTEISTON Kä YTTä Jä N TAI POTILAAN
VAHINGOITTUMINEN Sä HKö ISKUN, MEKAANISEN VIAN TAI MUUN
VAARATILANTEEN VUOKSI.

• ΤΟ ΠΑΡΟΝ ΕΓΧΕΙΡΙ∆ΙΟ ΣΕΡΒΙΣ ∆ΙΑΤΙΘΕΤΑΙ ΣΤΑ ΑΓΓΛΙΚΑ ΜΟΝΟ.


• ΕΑΝ ΤΟ ΑΤΟΜΟ ΠΑΡΟΧΗΣ ΣΕΡΒΙΣ ΕΝΟΣ ΠΕΛΑΤΗ ΑΠΑΙΤΕΙ ΤΟ ΠΑΡΟΝ
ΕΓΧΕΙΡΙ∆ΙΟ ΣΕ ΓΛΩΣΣΑ ΕΚΤΟΣ ΤΩΝ ΑΓΓΛΙΚΩΝ, ΑΠΟΤΕΛΕΙ ΕΥΘΥΝΗ ΤΟΥ
ΠΕΛΑΤΗ ΝΑ ΠΑΡΕΧΕΙ ΥΠΗΡΕΣΙΕΣ ΜΕΤΑΦΡΑΣΗΣ.
ΠΡΟΕΙ∆ΟΠΟΙΗΣΗ • ΜΗΝ ΕΠΙΧΕΙΡΗΣΕΤΕ ΤΗΝ ΕΚΤΕΛΕΣΗ ΕΡΓΑΣΙΩΝ ΣΕΡΒΙΣ ΣΤΟΝ ΕΞΟΠΛΙΣΜΟ
(EL) ΕΚΤΟΣ ΕΑΝ ΕΧΕΤΕ ΣΥΜΒΟΥΛΕΥΤΕΙ ΚΑΙ ΕΧΕΤΕ ΚΑΤΑΝΟΗΣΕΙ ΤΟ ΠΑΡΟΝ
ΕΓΧΕΙΡΙ∆ΙΟ ΣΕΡΒΙΣ.
• ΕΑΝ ∆Ε ΛΑΒΕΤΕ ΥΠΟΨΗ ΤΗΝ ΠΡΟΕΙ∆ΟΠΟΙΗΣΗ ΑΥΤΗ, ΕΝ∆ΕΧΕΤΑΙ ΝΑ
ΠΡΟΚΛΗΘΕΙ ΤΡΑΥΜΑΤΙΣΜΟΣ ΣΤΟ ΑΤΟΜΟ ΠΑΡΟΧΗΣ ΣΕΡΒΙΣ, ΣΤΟ ΧΕΙΡΙΣΤΗ Ή
ΣΤΟΝ ΑΣΘΕΝΗ ΑΠΟ ΗΛΕΚΤΡΟΠΛΗΞΙΑ, ΜΗΧΑΝΙΚΟΥΣ Ή ΑΛΛΟΥΣ ΚΙΝ∆ΥΝΟΥΣ.

• EZEN KARBANTARTÁSI KÉZIKÖNYV KIZÁRÓLAG ANGOL NYELVEN ÉRHETŐ


EL.
• HA A VEVŐ SZOLGÁLTATÓJA ANGOLTÓL ELTÉRŐ NYELVRE TART IGÉNYT,
AKKOR A VEVŐ FELELŐSSÉGE A FORDÍTÁS ELKÉSZÍTTETÉSE.
FIGYELMEZTETÉS • NE PRÓBÁLJA ELKEZDENI HASZNÁLNI A BERENDEZÉST, AMÍG A
(HU) KARBANTARTÁSI KÉZIKÖNYVBEN LEÍRTAKAT NEM ÉRTELMEZTÉK.
• EZEN FIGYELMEZTETÉS FIGYELMEN KÍVÜL HAGYÁSA A SZOLGÁLTATÓ,
MŰKÖDTETŐ VAGY A BETEG ÁRAMÜTÉS, MECHANIKAI VAGY EGYÉB
VESZÉLYHELYZET MIATTI SÉRÜLÉSÉT EREDMÉNYEZHETI.

• ÞESSI ÞJÓNUSTUHANDBÓK ER EINGÖNGU FÁANLEG Á ENSKU.


• EF ÞJÓNUSTUAÐILI VIÐSKIPTAMANNS ÞARFNAST ANNARS TUNGUMÁLS EN
ENSKU, ER ÞAÐ Á ÁBYRGÐ VIÐSKIPTAMANNS AÐ ÚTVEGA ÞÝÐINGU.
VIÐVÖRUN • REYNIÐ EKKI AÐ ÞJÓNUSTA TÆKIÐ NEMA EFTIR AÐ HAFA SKOÐAÐ OG
(IS) SKILIÐ ÞESSA ÞJÓNUSTUHANDBÓK.
• EF EKKI ER FARIÐ AÐ ÞESSARI VIÐVÖRUN GETUR ÞAÐ VALDIÐ MEIÐSLUM
ÞJÓNUSTUVEITANDA, STJÓRNANDA EÐA SJÚKLINGS VEGNA RAFLOSTS,
VÉLRÆNNAR EÐA ANNARRAR HÆTTU.

- iii
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

• TENTO SERVISNÍ NÁVOD EXISTUJE POUZE V ANGLICKé M JAZYCE.


• V Př íPADě , ŽE POSKYTOVATEL SLUŽEB ZÁKAZNÍKŮM POTř EBUJE Ná VOD
V JINé M JAZYCE, JE ZAJIšTě Ní Př EKLADU DO ODPOVíDAJíCíHO JAZYKA
ú KOLEM Zá KAZNíKA.
• NEPROVÁDĚJTE ú DRŽBU TOHOTO ZAř íZENí, ANIŽ BYSTE SI Př Eč ETLI
VÝSTRAHA TENTO SERVISNÍ NÁVOD A POCHOPILI JEHO OBSAH.
(CS)
• V Př íPADě NEDODRŽOVá Ní Té TO VýSTRAHY Mů ŽE DOJíT ÚRAZU
ELEKTRICKÁM PROUDEM PRACOVNíKA POSKYTOVATELE SLUŽEB,
OBSLUŽNé HO PERSONá LU NEBO PACIENTů VLIVEM ELEKTRICKé HOP
PROUDU, RESPEKTIVE VLIVEM K RIZIKU MECHANICKÉHO POŠKOZENÍ NEBO
JINÉMU RIZIKU.

• DENNE SERVICEMANUAL FINDES KUN PÅ ENGELSK.


• HVIS EN KUNDES TEKNIKER HAR BRUG FOR ET ANDET SPROG END
ENGELSK, ER DET KUNDENS ANSVAR AT SØRGE FOR OVERSÆTTELSE.
ADVARSEL • FORSØG IKKE AT SERVICERE UDSTYRET MEDMINDRE
(DA) DENNE SERVICEMANUAL ER BLEVET LÆST OG FORSTÅET.
• MANGLENDE OVERHOLDELSE AF DENNE ADVARSEL KAN MEDFØRE SKADE
PÅ GRUND AF ELEKTRISK, MEKANISK ELLER ANDEN FARE FOR
TEKNIKEREN, OPERATØREN ELLER PATIENTEN.

• DEZE ONDERHOUDSHANDLEIDING IS ENKEL IN HET ENGELS


VERKRIJGBAAR.
• ALS HET ONDERHOUDSPERSONEEL EEN ANDERE TAAL VEREIST, DAN IS DE
KLANT VERANTWOORDELIJK VOOR DE VERTALING ERVAN.
WAARSCHUWING • PROBEER DE APPARATUUR NIET TE ONDERHOUDEN VOORDAT DEZE
(NL) ONDERHOUDSHANDLEIDING WERD GERAADPLEEGD EN BEGREPEN IS.
• INDIEN DEZE WAARSCHUWING NIET WORDT OPGEVOLGD, ZOU HET
ONDERHOUDSPERSONEEL, DE OPERATOR OF EEN PATIËNT GEWOND
KUNNEN RAKEN ALS GEVOLG VAN EEN ELEKTRISCHE SCHOK,
MECHANISCHE OF ANDERE GEVAREN.

• šĪ APKALPES ROKASGRĀMATA IR PIEEJAMA TIKAI ANGĻU VALODĀ.


• JA KLIENTA APKALPES SNIEDZĒJAM NEPIECIEŠAMA INFORMĀCIJA CITĀ
VALODĀ, NEVIS ANGĻU, KLIENTA PIENĀKUMS IR NODROŠINĀT TULKOŠANU.
BRĪDINĀJUMS • NEVEICIET APRĪKOJUMA APKALPI BEZ APKALPES ROKASGRĀMATAS
(LV) IZLASĪŠANAS UN SAPRAŠANAS.
• ŠĪ BRĪDINĀJUMA NEIEVĒROŠANA VAR RADĪT ELEKTRISKĀS STRĀVAS
TRIECIENA, MEHĀNISKU VAI CITU RISKU IZRAISĪTU TRAUMU APKALPES
SNIEDZĒJAM, OPERATORAM VAI PACIENTAM.

iv -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

• ŠIS EKSPLOATAVIMO VADOVAS YRA IŠLEISTAS TIK ANGLŲ KALBA.


• JEI KLIENTO PASLAUGŲ TEIKĖJUI REIKIA VADOVO KITA KALBA – NE ANGLŲ,
VERTIMU PASIRŪPINTI TURI KLIENTAS.
ĮSPĖJIMAS • NEMĖGINKITE ATLIKTI ĮRANGOS TECHNINĖS PRIEŽIŪROS DARBŲ, NEBENT
(LT) VADOVAUTUMĖTĖS ŠIUO EKSPLOATAVIMO VADOVU IR JĮ SUPRASTUMĖTE
• NEPAISANT ŠIO PERSPĖJIMO, PASLAUGŲ TEIKĖJAS, OPERATORIUS AR
PACIENTAS GALI BŪTI SUŽEISTAS DĖL ELEKTROS SMŪGIO, MECHANINIŲ AR
KITŲ PAVOJŲ.

• DENNE SERVICEHÅNDBOKEN FINNES BARE PÅ ENGELSK.


• HVIS KUNDENS SERVICELEVERANDØR TRENGER ET ANNET SPRÅK, ER DET
KUNDENS ANSVAR Å SØRGE FOR OVERSETTELSE.
ADVARSEL • IKKE FORSØK Å REPARERE UTSTYRET UTEN AT DENNE
(NO) SERVICEHÅNDBOKEN ER LEST OG FORSTÅTT.
• MANGLENDE HENSYN TIL DENNE ADVARSELEN KAN FØRE TIL AT
SERVICELEVERANDØREN, OPERATØREN ELLER PASIENTEN SKADES PÅ
GRUNN AV ELEKTRISK STØT, MEKANISKE ELLER ANDRE FARER.

• NINIEJSZY PODRĘCZNIK SERWISOWY DOSTĘPNY JEST JEDYNIE W JĘZYKU


ANGIELSKIM.
• JEś LI FIRMA ś WIADCZĄCA KLIENTOWI USłUGI SERWISOWE WYMAGA
UDOSTę PNIENIA PODRę CZNIKA W Ję ZYKU INNYM NIŻ ANGIELSKI,
OBOWIĄZEK ZAPEWNIENIA STOSOWNEGO TłUMACZENIA SPOCZYWA NA
KLIENCIE.
OSTRZEŻENIE
• NIE PRó BOWAć SERWISOWAć NINIEJSZEGO SPRZę TU BEZ UPRZEDNIEGO
(PL)
ZAPOZNANIA SIę Z PODRę CZNIKIEM SERWISOWYM.
• NIEZASTOSOWANIE SIę DO TEGO OSTRZEŻENIA MOżE GROZIć
OBRAŻENIAMI CIAłA SERWISANTA, OPERATORA LUB PACJENTA W WYNIKU
PORAŻENIA PRĄDEM, URAZU MECHANICZNEGO LUB INNEGO RODZAJU
ZAGROŻEń .

• ACEST MANUAL DE SERVICE ESTE DISPONIBIL NUMAI ÎN LIMBA ENGLEZĂ.


• DACĂ UN FURNIZOR DE SERVICII PENTRU CLIENŢI NECESITĂ O ALTĂ LIMBĂ
DECÂT CEA ENGLEZĂ, ESTE DE DATORIA CLIENTULUI SĂ FURNIZEZE O
TRADUCERE.
ATENŢIE • NU ÎNCERCAŢI SĂ REPARAŢI ECHIPAMENTUL DECÂT ULTERIOR
(RO)
CONSULTĂRII ŞI ÎNŢELEGERII ACESTUI MANUAL DE SERVICE.
• IGNORAREA ACESTUI AVERTISMENT AR PUTEA DUCE LA RĂNIREA
DEPANATORULUI, OPERATORULUI SAU PACIENTULUI ÎN URMA
PERICOLELOR DE ELECTROCUTARE, MECANICE SAU DE ALTĂ NATURĂ.

- v
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

• Да н н о е рук о в о дс т в о п о о б с луж и в а н и ю ПРЕДОСТАВЛЯЕТСЯ


т о ль к о н а а н г ли й с к о м Яз ы к е .
• Ес ли с е рв и с н о МУ ПЕРСОНАЛУ к ли е н т а н е о б х о ди мо рук о в о дс т в о
н е н а а н г ли й с к о м ЯЗЫКЕ, к ли е н т у с ле дуе т с а мо с т о Ят е ль н о
ОБЕСПЕЧИТЬ п е ре в о д.
ОСТОРОЖНО! • ПЕРЕД ОБСЛУЖИВАНИЕМ ОБОРУДОВАНИЯ ОБЯЗАТЕЛЬНО ОБРАТИТЕСЬ
(RU)
К ДАННОМУ РУКОВОДСТВУ И ПОЙМИТЕ ИЗЛОЖЕННЫЕ В НЕМ СВЕДЕНИЯ.
• НЕСОБЛЮДЕНИЕ УКАЗАННЫХ ТРЕБОВАНИЙ МОЖЕТ ПРИВЕСТИ К ТОМУ,
ЧТО СПЕЦИАЛИСТ ПО ТЕХОБСЛУЖИВАНИЮ, ОПЕРАТОР ИЛИ ПАЦИЕНТ
ПОЛУЧАТ УДАР ЗЛЕКТРИЧЕСКИМ ТОКОМ, МЕХАНИЧЕСКУЮ ТРАВМУ ИЛИ
ДРУГОЕ ПОВРЕЖДЕНИЕ.

• TÁTO SERVISNÁ PRÍRUČKA JE K DISPOZíCII LEN V ANGLIČTINE.


• AK ZÁKAZNÍKOV POSKYTOVATEĽ SLUŽIEB VYŽADUJE INÝ JAZYK AKO
ANGLIČTINU, POSKYTNUTIE PREKLADATEĽSKÝCH SLUŽIEB JE
ZODPOVEDNOSŤOU ZÁKAZNÍKA.
UPOZORNENIE • NEPOKÚŠAJTE SA VYKONÁVAŤ SERVIS ZARIADENIA SKÔR, AKO SI
(SK) NEPREČÍTATE SERVISNÚ PRÍRUČKU A NEPOROZUMIETE JEJ.
• ZANEDBANIE TOHTO UPOZORNENIA Mô ŽE VYÚSTIŤ DO ZRANENIA
POSKYTOVATEĽA SLUŽIEB, OBSLUHUJú CEJ OSOBY ALEBO PACIENTA
ELEKTRICKýM PRú DOM, PRÍPADNE DO MECHANICKé HO ALEBO INé HO
NEBEZPEč ENSTVA.

• DEN HÄR SERVICEHANDBOKEN FINNS BARA TILLGÄNGLIG PÅ ENGELSKA.


• OM EN KUNDS SERVICETEKNIKER HAR BEHOV AV ETT ANNAT SPRÅK ÄN
ENGELSKA ANSVARAR KUNDEN FÖR ATT TILLHANDAHÅLLA
ÖVERSÄTTNINGSTJÄNSTER.
VARNING • FÖRSÖK INTE UTFÖRA SERVICE PÅ UTRUSTNINGEN OM DU INTE HAR LÄST
(SV)
OCH FÖRSTÅR DEN HÄR SERVICEHANDBOKEN.
• OM DU INTE TAR HÄNSYN TILL DEN HÄR VARNINGEN KAN DET RESULTERA I
SKADOR PÅ SERVICETEKNIKERN, OPERATÖREN ELLER PATIENTEN TILL
FÖLJD AV ELEKTRISKA STÖTAR, MEKANISKA FAROR ELLER ANDRA FAROR.

• BU SERVİS KILAVUZU YALNIZCA İNGİLİZCE OLARAK SAĞLANMIŞTIR.


• EĞER MÜŞTERİ TEKNİSYENİ KILAVUZUN İNGİLİZCE DIŞINDAKİ BİR DİLDE
OLMASINI İSTERSE, KILAVUZU TERCÜME ETTİRMEK MÜŞTERİNİN
SORUMLULUĞUNDADIR.
DİKKAT • SERVİS KILAVUZUNU OKUYUP ANLAMADAN EKİPMANLARA MÜDAHALE
(TR)
ETMEYİNİZ.
• BU UYARININ GÖZ ARDI EDİLMESİ, ELEKTRİK ÇARPMASI YA DA MEKANİK
VEYA DİĞER TÜRDEN KAZALAR SONUCUNDA TEKNİSYENİN, OPERATÖRÜN
YA DA HASTANIN YARALANMASINA YOL AÇABİLİR.

vi -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

(JA)

(ZH-CN)

(KO)

- vii
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

DAMAGE IN TRANSPORTATION
All packages should be closely examined at time of delivery. If damage is apparent write “Damage In
Shipment” on ALL copies of the freight or express bill BEFORE delivery is accepted or “signed for” by
a GE representative or hospital receiving agent. Whether noted or concealed, damage MUST be
reported to the carrier immediately upon discovery, or in any event, within 14 days after receipt, and the
contents and containers held for inspection by the carrier. A transportation company will not pay a claim
for damage if an inspection is not requested within this 14 day period.

CERTIFIED ELECTRICAL CONTRACTOR STATEMENT - FOR USA ONLY


All electrical Installations that are preliminary to positioning of the equipment at the site prepared for the
equipment shall be performed by licensed electrical contractors. Other connections between pieces of
electrical equipment, calibrations and testing shall be performed by qualified GE Healthcare personnel.
In performing all electrical work on these products, GE will use its own specially trained field engineers.
All of GE’s electrical work on these products will comply with the requirements of the applicable
electrical codes.

The purchaser of GE equipment shall only utilize qualified personnel (i.e., GE’s field engineers,
personnel of third-party service companies with equivalent training, or licensed electricians) to perform
electrical servicing on the equipment.

OMISSIONS & ERRORS


If there are any omissions, errors or suggestions for improving this documentation, please contact the
GE Healthcare Global Documentation Group with specific information listing the system type, manual
title, part number, revision number, page number and suggestion details. Mail the information to:
Service Documentation, 9900 Innovation Drive (RP-2123), Wauwatosa, WI 53226, USA.

GE Healthcare employees should use the iTrak System to report all documentation errors or omissions.

SERVICE SAFETY CONSIDERATIONS

DANGER DANGEROUS VOLTAGES, CAPABLE OF CAUSING DEATH, ARE PRESENT IN


THIS EQUIPMENT. USE EXTREME CAUTION WHEN HANDLING, TESTING AND
ADJUSTING.

WARNING Use all Personal Protection Equipment (PPE) such as gloves, safety shoes, safety
glasses, and kneeling pad, to reduce the risk of injury.
For a complete review of all safety requirements, see the Chapter 1, Safety Considerations section in
the Service Manual.

viii -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

LEGAL NOTES

The contents of this publication may not be copied or duplicated in any form, in whole or in part, without
prior written permission of GE Healthcare.

GE Healthcare may revise this publication from time to time without written notice.

TRADEMARKS
All products and their name brands are trademarks of their respective holders.

COPYRIGHTS
All Material Copyright© 2004 and 2008 by General Electric Company Inc. All Rights Reserved.

- ix
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Revision History

Revision Date Reason for change


1 June 26, 2006 Initial Release.

2 November 24, 2006 M4 Software Release

3 October 10, 2007 BT08 Software Release

4 22 APR2008 Addition Functional Check Procedure

List of Effected Pages(LOEP)

Pages Revision Pages Revision Pages Revision


Title Page 4 4-1 to 4-12 4 10-1 to 10-14 4
Warnings i to -x 4 5-1 to 5-23 4 11-1 to 11-2 4

TOC vii to 4 6-1 to 6-8 4 A-1 to A-40 4

1-1 to 1-4 4 7-1 to 7-8 4 Index-1 to Index-4 4


2-1 to 2-7 4 8-1 to 8-2 4 Back Cover N/A

3-1 to 3-49 4 9-1 to 9-4 4

x -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Table of Contents
CHAPTER 1 Introduction
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Purpose of Chapter 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Purpose of Service Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1
Typical Users of the Basic Service Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Models Covered by this Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Purpose of Operator Manual(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Important Conventions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Conventions Used in Book . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-3
Standard Hazard Icons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4
Product Icons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
WEEE Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-7
Safety Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 12
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 12
Human Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 12
Mechanical Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 12
Electrical Safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 13
Label Locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 14
Dangerous Procedure Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 16
Lockout/Tagout Requirements (For USA Only) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 16
EMC, EMI, and ESD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 16
Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 16
CE Compliance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 16
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Prevention . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 17
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 18
Contact Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 18
System Manufacturer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 19

CHAPTER 2 Safety
Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
Purpose of chapter 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1
General Console Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
Console Environmental Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
Electrical Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
EMI Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Scan Probe Environmental Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5
Facility Needs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Purchaser Responsibilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6
Required Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Desirable Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Recommended and Alternate Ultrasound Room Layout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Networking Pre-installation Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 10
- 1-xi
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

CHAPTER 3 Installation

Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 1
Installation Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 2
Average Installation Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 2
Installation Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 2
Safety Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 3
Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 4
Moving into Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 9
Adjusting System Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 9
Product Locator Installation Card . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 9
Preparing for Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 10
Verify Customer Order . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 10
Physical Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 10
EMI Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 10
Completing the Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 10
Power On/Boot Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 10
Power Off/ Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 13
Transducer Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 14
System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 15
System Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 15
Electrical Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 17
On-Board Optional Peripherals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 17
External I/O Connector Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 17
Video Specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 20
Setting VCR (Mitsubishi MD3000) USB Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 21
Available Probes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 22
Software/Option Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 22
Connectivity Installation Worksheet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 23
Insite IP Address Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 24
Loading Base System Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 24
Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 24
Paperwork . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 25
Product Locator Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 25
User Manual(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 - 25

CHAPTER 4 Functional Checks


.................................................................
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 - 1
Purpose for Chapter 4 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 - 1
Required Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 - 1
General Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 - 2
Power On/Boot Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 - 2
Power Off / Shutdown . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 - 3
System Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 - 4

1-xii -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

System B/M-Mode Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 7


System CFM and PWD Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 8
Basic Measurements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 9
Probe/Connectors Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 10
Using Cine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 11
Image Management (QG) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 12
Using the DVD-R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 13
Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 17
ECG Check Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 22
Software Configuration Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 22
Peripheral Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 23
Monitor Function Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 24
15" LCDMON II Assy & LCD Panel with filter Function Validation Procedure . . . . 4 - 24
15" OSD Key Assy Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 25
Keyboard Function Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 26
Main Keyboard Assy Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 26
Sub Keyboard Assy Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 29
Trackball Assy validation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 29
A/N Key assy validation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 29
Freeze key validation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 29
TGC key assay / TGC Knob Set validation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 30
Sub Keyboard Encoder Knob Set validation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 30
Mechanical Function Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 31
Cover Parts Function Validation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . - 31
LCD plastic filter Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 32
Air filter set Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 32
TGC key assy/TGD Knob Set, Sub keyboard encoder Knob Set, Keycap set, Main Keyboard
Encoder Knob set Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 33
Cup holder Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 34
Front caster/Rear caster Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 35
Probe holder Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 36
Flexible LCD Arm Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 37
Board Function Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 38
CL1TRX Assy / BL1TRX Assy Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 38
ACWD Assy Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 39
SYSCONML Assy Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 40
APS Assy PCB Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 41
P3RLY,P2RLY and P2RLY with Dummy Assy function check procedure . . . . . . . 4 - 42
SOM Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 43
RFC Assy Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 43
BackPlane Assy Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 44
Nest fan Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 45
Transbox Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 45
DTRX Cooler with heatsink Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 46
ACPC Assy set Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 46
AP950 Transbox Assy Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 47
Fuse set Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 47

- 1-xiii
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

ARP Assy Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 - 47


ASIG ASSY Function Validation Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 - 47
Site Log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4 - 48

CHAPTER 5 Components and Functions


Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 1
General Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 2
Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 3
LOGIQ P5 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 3
LOGIQ A5 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 6
Main Board Detail . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 9
P3RLY and P2RLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 10
CL1TRX and BL1TRX . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 12
SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 16
SOM Module . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 19
Top Console . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 26
Keyboard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 26
LOGIQ P5 Monitor and LOGIQ A5 Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 28
ARP (Rear Panel) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 30
Input/Output Signals for peripheral . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 31
Power Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 32
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 32
TRANSBOX(AC Power) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 32
APS(LV Power & HV Power) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 33
AC Power Outlet for Peripheral . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 34
Cable Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 35
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 35
Internal Cable . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 35
Peripherals and Cable connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 36
Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 39
Fans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 39
Service Platform . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 40
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 40
Global Service User Interface (GSUI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 41
Service Home Page . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 42
Error Logs Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 43
Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 45
Image Quality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 46
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 46
Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 47
Utilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 48
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 49
PM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 49
Remote Software/Option Installation and Updates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 50
RFS (Service For Request) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 - 51

1-xiv -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 51
System Checkout Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 51
Sending RFS Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 53

CHAPTER 6 Service Adjustment


Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Purpose of this chapter 6 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Regulatory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1
Monitor Adjustments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
Rotate and tilt the monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
Brightness and Contrast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
LCD Plastic filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Flexible LCD arm - locking mechanism . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6
Trackball Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7

CHAPTER 7 Diagnostics / Trouble shooting


Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
Purpose of Chapter 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-1
Gathering Trouble Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
Collect Vital System Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2
Collect a Trouble Image with Logs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3
Screen Captures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Check and Record the P2 Key Function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-4
Setting the P2 Key to Screen Capture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-5
Capturing a Screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-6
Reset the P2 Key to Customer’s Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-7
Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8
Common Diagnostics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
Utilities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-9
PC Diagnostics (Non-Interactive Tests) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 10
PC Diagnostics (Interactive Tests) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 14
FRU Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 16
LED Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 20
CL1TRX/BL1TRX Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 20
P3RLY/P2RLY Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 20
SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 20
APS Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 20
Trouble Shooting Tree . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 21
System Does Not Power On / Boot Up . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 21
System Does Not Boot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 22
System Does Not Boot . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 23
Noise in Image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 25
Unable to Scan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 26
- 1-xv
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Trackball . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7 - 27
Monitor Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7 - 28
Unable to Record to VCR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7 - 31
Printer Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7 - 32
DVD-RW Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7 - 34
Network Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7 - 35

CHAPTER 8 Replacement Procedures


Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 8 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 1
DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 2
LCD Panel with filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 3
LCD Plastic filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 6
Monitor cover set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 8
OSD button and lamp set, LCD Plastic Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 12
LCD Std Arm with Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 13
Monitor Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 15
Flexible LCD Arm Removal Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 16
Main Keyboard Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 35
Sub Keyboard Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 38
Trackball Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 40
English, Greek, Russian, Swedish, Norweigian A/N Key assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 41
Freeze key assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 43
TGC key assy / TGC Knob Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 45
Sub Keyboard Encoder Knob Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 47
Keycap set, Main Keyboard Encoder Knob set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 48
Side Left Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 49
Side Right Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 50
Front Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 51
Rear Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 53
Middle Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 55
Top Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 57
Top Bottom Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 58
Pole Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 59
Neck Front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 60
Neck Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 62
Dummy Cover L / R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 64
EMI Cover L . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 66
EMI Cover R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 67
APS Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 68
CL1TRX Assy / BL1TRX Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 71
P3RLY / P2RLY Assy & P2RLY with Dummy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 73
Backplane Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 75
ACWD Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 77
SYSCON PM Assy/SYSCON CM Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 79
PM SOM Assy with 1G/ CM SOM Assy with 512M . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 81

1-xvi -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

ASIG Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 83
Front Caster / Rear Caster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 84
Rear Handle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 86
Rear Hook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 87
Probe Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 89
Cup Holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 90
ECG Cable Hook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 91
Air Filter Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 92
DVD R/W Drive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 93
Nest Fan Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 95
ARP Assy 110V/220V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 97
Cable Arm Hook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 99
SATA HDD Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 100
ACPC Assy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 101
Transbox Assy 110V/220V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 103
Fuse Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 106
Read and Write Serial Info . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 107
Software Loading Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 111
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 111
Parts Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 111
TimeRequired . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 111
Software Loading Steering Guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 112
Before Starting Software Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 113
Installing Base Software Load Image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 121
Installing Base Software Load Image CD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 121
Installig Application Software(R2.x.x) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 131
Standard Confirmation & Functional Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 133
Full backup/Restore procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 143
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 143
Parts Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 143
Full Backup Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 143
Restore procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 147
Software Reloading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 148
General . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 148
Software Reloading Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 148
Mechanical Option Installation instruction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 158
Endo Probe Holder Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 159
Microphone Option fixture Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 160
Drawer Option installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 161
Cable Arm Hook installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 162
BW Printer Fixture Keyboard installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 163
BW printer Fixture Middle installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 166
Color Printer Fixture Middle installation - UP23MD Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 169
Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation - UP23MD Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 172
Printer VCR DVD fixture Top installation - CP900 Printer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 175
Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top Installation (MD-3000) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 178
Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top Installation (MD-800) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 183

- 1-xvii
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Rear Handle installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 185


Additional Task Lamp installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 187
Protect Cover Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 190
Swivel Lock Caster Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 191
Final Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8 - 192

CHAPTER 9 Renewal Parts


Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 1
Purpose of Chapter 9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 1
List of Abbreviations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 1
MONITOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 2
KEYBOARD . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 4
COVERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 6
PCB . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 8
BODY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 10
POWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 12
Cables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 14
Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 15
Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 16
Probes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 - 17

CHAPTER 10 Care and Maintenance


Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 1
Periodic Maintenance Inspections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 1
Purpose of Chapter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 1
Why do Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 2
Keeping Records . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 2
Quality Assurance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 2
Maintenance Task Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 2
How often should care & maintenance tasks be performed? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 2
Tools Required . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 4
Standard GE Tool Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 4
Special Tools, Supplies and Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 6
System Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 7
Preliminary Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 7
Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 8
Input Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 9
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 9
Physical Inspection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 10
Optional Diagnostic Checks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 11
Probe Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 11
Electrical Safety Tests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 12
Safety Test Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 12
GEMS Leakage Current Limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 13
Outlet Test - Wiring Arrangement - USA & Canada . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10 - 14
1-xviii -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Grounding Continuity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 15
Chassis Leakage Current Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 17
Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead to Ground . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 19
Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead to Lead . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 22
Isolated Patient Lead (Sink) Leakage-Isolation Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 22
Probe Leakage Current Test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 24
When There's Too Much Leakage Current . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 28

- 1-xix
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-xx -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Chapter 1
Introduction

Section 1-1
Overview
1-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 1
This chapter describes important issues related to safely servicing the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 scanner. The
service provider must read and understand all the information presented in this manual before installing
or servicing a unit.

Table 1-1 Contents in Chapter 1

Section Description Page Number


1-1 Overview 1-1

1-2 Important Conventions 1-3

1-3 Safety Considerations 1-12

1-4 EMC, EMI, and ESD 1-16

1-5 Customer Assistance 1-18

1-1-2 Purpose of Service Manual


This Service Manual provides installation and service information for the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Ultrasound
Scanning System and contains the following chapters:

1.) Chapter 1 - Introduction: Contains a content summary and warnings.


2.) Chapter 2 - Pre-Installation: Contains pre-installation requirements for the LOGIQ™ P5/A5.
3.) Chapter 3 - Installation: Contains installation procedures.
4.) Chapter 4 - Functional Checks: Contains functional checks that are recommended as part of the
installation, or as required during servicing and periodic maintenance.
5.) Chapter 5 - Components and Functions (Theory): Contains block diagrams and functional
explanations of the electronics.
6.) Chapter 6 - Service Adjustments: Contains instructions on how to make available adjustments to
the LOGIQ™ P5/A5.
7.) Chapter 7 - Diagnostics/Troubleshooting: Provides procedures for running diagnostic or related
routines for the LOGIQ™ P5/A5.
8.) Chapter 8 - Replacement Procedures: Provides disassembly procedures and reassembly
procedures for all changeable Field Replaceable Units (FRU).
9.) Chapter 9 - Renewal Parts: Contains a complete list of field replaceable parts for the LOGIQ™ P5/
A5.
10.)Chapter 10 - Care & Maintenance: Provides periodic maintenance procedures for the LOGIQ™
P5/A5.

Section 1-1 - Overview 1-1


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-1-3 Typical Users of the Basic Service Manual


• Service Personnel (installation, maintenance, etc.)
• Hospital’s Service Personnel
• Contractors (Some parts of Chapter 2 - Pre-Installation)

1-1-4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Models Covered by this Manual

LOGIQ P5 System H-CAT#


H-CAT# GPN Description
H44502LA 5271952 LP5 BT08 for Europe
H44502LB 5264923 LP5 Pro BT08 for Japan
H44502LC 5271313 LP5 Pro for Asia 220v
H44502LD 5267071 LP5 Pro BT08 for India
H44502LE 5271808 LP5 BT08 for USA
H44502LF 5267015 LP5 Pro BT08 for Asia 110v
H44502LG 5265206 LP5 Pro BT08 for Korea

H44502LH 5270329 LP5 Pro BT08 for Europe


H44502LJ 5267794 LP5 Advanced for Japan BT08
H44502LK 5265932 LP5 Advanced BT08 for Latin A
H44502LL 5267952 LP5 Advanced BT08 for Latin B
H44502LM 5271936 LP5 Advanced BT08 for China

H44502LN 5265743 LP5 Premium BT08 for Europe


H44502LP 5263789 LP5 Premium for Asia
H44502LR 5269008 LP5 Premium for India
H44502LS 5272256 LP5 Premium for China
H44502LT 5265727 LP5 Premium for Asia
H44502LW 5270628 LP5 Premium BT08 for Latin A
H44502LY 5263889 LP5 Premium BT08 for Latin C
H44502LZ 5263178 LP5 Premium for USA
H44512LB 5270448 LP5 Premium for Korea
LOGIQ A5 System H-CAT#
H-CAT# GPN Description
H44512LC 5263124 LA5 BT08 for Europe
H44512LD 5265225 LA5 BT08 for USA
H44512LE 5270463 LA5 BT08 for Latin

Figure 1-1 LOGIQ™ P5/A5Model Designation

1-1-5 Purpose of Operator Manual(s)


The Operator Manual(s) should be fully read and understood before operating the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 and
also kept near the unit for quick reference.

1-2 Section 1-1 - Overview


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Section 1-2
Important Conventions
1-2-1 Conventions Used in Book
Icons

Pictures, or icons, are used wherever they reinforce the printed message. The icons, labels and
conventions used on the product and in the service information are described in this chapter.

Safety Precaution Messages

Various levels of safety precaution messages may be found on the equipment and in the service
information. The different levels of concern are identified by a flag word that precedes the precautionary
message. Known or potential hazards are labeled in one of following ways:

DANGER DANGER IS USED TO INDICATE THE PRESENCE OF A HAZARD THAT WILL


CAUSE SEVERE PERSONAL INJURY OR DEATH IF THE INSTRUCTIONS ARE
IGNORED.
WARNING WARNING IS USED TO INDICATE THE PRESENCE OF A HAZARD THAT CAN CAUSE
SEVERE PERSONAL INJURY AND PROPERTY DAMAGE IF INSTRUCTIONS ARE
IGNORED.

CAUTION Caution is used to indicate the presence of a hazard that will or can cause minor personal injury
and property damage if instructions are ignored.

NOTICE Equipment Damage Possible


Notice is used when a hazard is present that can cause property damage but has absolutely no
personal injury risk.
Example: Disk drive will crash.

NOTE: Notes provide important information about an item or a procedure.


Information contained in a NOTE can often save you time or effort.

Section 1-2 - Important Conventions 1-3


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-2-2 Standard Hazard Icons


Important information will always be preceded by the exclamation point contained
within a triangle, as seen throughout this chapter. In addition to text, several
different graphical icons (symbols) may be used to make you aware of specific types
of hazards that could cause harm.

Table 1-2 Standard Hazard Icons

ELECTRICAL MECHANICAL RADIATION

LASER HEAT PINCH

LASER
LIGHT

Other hazard icons make you aware of specific procedures that should be followed.

Table 1-3 Standard Icons Indicating a Special Procedure Be Used

AVOID STATIC ELECTRICITY TAG AND LOCK OUT WEAR EYE PROTECTION

TAG
&
LOCKOUT EYE
PROTECTION
Signed Date

1-4 Section 1-2 - Important Conventions


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-2-3 Product Icons


The following table describes the purpose and location of safety labels and other important information
provided on the equipment.

Table 1-4 Product Icons

LABEL/SYMBOL PURPOSE/MEANING LOCATION

Manufacturer's name and address


Rear of console near power inlet
Date of manufacture
Identification and Rating Plate Under monitor
Model and serial numbers
On each probe
Electrical ratings

Laboratory logo or labels denoting


Rear of console
Device Listing/Certification Labels conformance with industry safety standards
such as UL or IEC. Under front of monitor

Type/Class Label Used to indicate the degree of safety or protection.

Indicates the degree of protection provided by


IP Code (IPX8) the enclosure per IEC 529. IPX8 indicates drip Footswitch
proof.

Equipment Type CF (heart in the box symbol)


IEC 878-02-05 indicates equipment having a ECG connector
high degree of protection suitable for direct Surgical probes
cardiac contact. Defibrillator
IEC60601-2-27

"CAUTION" The equilateral triangle is usually


used in combination with other symbols to Various
advise or warn the user.

ATTENTION - Consult accompanying


documents " is intended to alert the user to
refer to the operator manual or other Various
instructions when complete information cannot
be provided on the label.

"CAUTION - Dangerous voltage" (the lightning


flash with arrowhead in equilateral triangle) is Various
used to indicate electric shock hazards.

"Mains OFF" Indicates the power off position of


Rear of system adjacent to mains switch
the mains power switch.

Section 1-2 - Important Conventions 1-5


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Table 1-4 Product Icons

LABEL/SYMBOL PURPOSE/MEANING LOCATION

"OFF/Standby" Indicates the power off/


standby position of the power switch.
CAUTION Adjacent to On-Off/Standby Switch
This Power Switch DOES NOT ISOLATE
Mains Supply

"Mains ON" Indicates the power on position of


the mains power switch.
"ON" Indicates the power on position of the
power switch. Front Panel Switch
CAUTION
This Power Switch DOES NOT ISOLATE
Mains Supply

"Protective Earth" Indicates the protective


Internal
earth (grounding) terminal.

Product schematics
Indicates an earth GROUND potential
Peripherals

1-6 Section 1-2 - Important Conventions


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-2-4 WEEE Label


The following table describes the meaning of WEEE label and its translation provided on the equipment.

Table 1-5 WEEE Label

LABEL/SYMBOL LANGUAGE PURPOSE/MEANING

This symbol indicates that the waste of electrical and electronic equipment must
not be disposed as unsorted municipal waste and must be collected separately.
English
Please contact an authorized representative of the manufacturer for information
concerning the decommissioning of your equipment.

Tento symbol znamená, že díly elektrických nebo elektronických zařízení


Czech (CZE) nesmí být likvidovány do netříděného odpadu, ale musí být likvidovány
samostatně. Obraťte se prosím na autorizovaného představitele výrobce,
který poskytne informace týkající se likvidace vašeho přístroje.

Dette symbol angiver, at elektrisk og elektronisk affald ikke må


Danish (DAN) bortskaffes som usorteret brændbart affald, men skal indsamles særskilt.
Kontakt venligst en autoriseret repræsentant for producenten for at få
oplysninger om, hvordan dit udstyr skal bortskaffes.

Dit symbool geeft aan dat het afval van elektrische en elektronische
apparatuur niet ongescheiden mag worden meegegeven met het
Dutch (DUT)
huisvuil, maar apart moet worden ingeleverd. Neem contact op met een
erkende vertegenwoordiger van de fabrikant voor informatie over het
inleveren van uw apparatuur.

Aquest símbol indica que els residus dels equips elèctrics i electrònics
Catalan (CAT) s'han d'abocar per separat, no com a residus municipals no classificats.
Contacteu amb un representant autoritzat del fabricant per obtenir
informació sobre com desfer-vos del vostre equip.

Chinese (CHN)

See märk näitab, et tarbetuks muutunud elektri- ja elektroonikaseadmeid


Estonian (EST) ei tohi ära visata sortimata olmejäätmetena, vaid need tuleb eraldi kokku
koguda. Seadmete käitlemise kohta küsige lisateavet tootja volitatud
esindajalt.

Section 1-2 - Important Conventions 1-7


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Table 1-5 WEEE Label

LABEL/SYMBOL LANGUAGE PURPOSE/MEANING

Tämä kuvatunnus ilmaisee, että sillä merkittyä sähkö- ja


elektroniikkalaitetta ei saa hävittää lajittelemattomana yhdyskuntajätteenä
Finnish (FIN)
vaan se on kerättävä talteen erikseen. Ota yhteyttä tuotteen valmistajan
valtuuttamaan myyntiedustajaan ja kysy lisätietoja laitteen käytöstä
poistosta.

Ce symbole indique que les déchets relatifs à l'équipement électrique et


French- France électronique ne doivent pas être jetés comme les ordures ménagères
(FRA) non-triées et doivent être collectés séparément. Contactez un repré
sentant agréé du fabricant pour obtenir des informations sur la mise au
rebut de votre équipement.

Dieses Symbol kennzeichnet elektrische und elektronische Geräte, die


nicht mit dem gewöhnlichen, unsortierten Hausmüll entsorgt werden dü
German (GER) rfen, sondern separat behandelt werden müssen. Bitte nehmen Sie
Kontakt mit einem autorisierten Beauftragten des Herstellers auf, um
Informationen hinsichtlich der Entsorgung Ihres Gerätes zu erhalten.

Αυτό το σύµβολο υποδηλώνει ότι τα απόβλητα ηλεκτρικού και ηλεκτρονικού εξ


οπλισµού δεν πρέπει να απορρίπτονται ως κοινά απορρίµατα, αλλά να συλλέγον
Greek (GRE)
ται ξεχωριστά. Παρακαλούµε επικοινωνήστε µε έναν εξουσιοδοτηµένο αντιπρό
σωπο του κατασκευαστή για πληροφορίες σχετικά µε την απόρριψη του εξοπλισ
µού.

A szimbólum azt jelzi, hogy az elektromos és elektronikus készülék hulladékát


Hungarian
(HUN)
tilos nem szelektív lakossági hulladékként kezelni, hanem elkülönítve kell gyű
jteni. Kérjük, a berendezés leselejtezését illetőleg lépjen kapcsolatba a gyártó
hivatalos képviseletével.

Merki þetta táknar að rafeindatækjum skal eytt á sérstakan máta, ekki m


Icelandic (ICE) á losa rafeindatæki í hefðbundin sorphirðuílát sem óflokkað sorp.
Vinsamlega hafið samband við umboðsmann framleiðanda fyrir upplý
singar um hvernig tækinu skal eytt.

1-8 Section 1-2 - Important Conventions


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Table 1-5 WEEE Label

LABEL/SYMBOL LANGUAGE PURPOSE/MEANING

Questo simbolo indica che i rifiuti derivanti da apparecchiature elettriche ed


elettroniche non devono essere smaltiti come rifiuti municipali indifferenziati e
Italian (ITA)
devono invece essere raccolti separatamente. Per informazioni relative alle
modalità di smantellamento delle apparecchiature fuori uso, contattare un
rappresentante autorizzato del fabbricante.

Japanese
(JPN)

Šis apzīmējums norāda, ka no elektriskā un elektroniskā aprīkojuma


atkritumiem nedrīkst atbrīvoties kā no nešķirotiem mājsaimniecības
Latvian (LAT)
atkritumiem un tie ir jāsavāc atsevišķi. Lūdzu, sazinieties ar pilnvarotu raž
otāja pārstāvi, lai saņemtu informāciju par aprīkojuma ekspluatācijas pā
rtraukšanu.

Šis simbolis nurodo, kad elektros ir elektroninės įrangos atliekos turi būti
Lithuanian
(LIT)
surenkamos atskirai ir negali būti šalinamos kaip nerūšiuotos savivaldybė
s tvarkomos atliekos. Informacijos apie įrangos veikimo sustabdymą
kreipkitės į įgaliotąjį gamintojo atstovą.

Dette symbolet angir at elektrisk og elektronisk utstyr ikke skal kastes


Norwegian
(NOR)
som restavfall, men må leveres inn separat. Ta kontakt med en autorisert
representant for produsenten hvis du vil ha informasjon om hvordan
utstyret skal avhendes.

Ten symbol oznacza, iż składowanie zużytych urządzeń elektrycznych i


Polish (POL) elektronicznych wraz z ogólnymi odpadami miejskimi jest zabronione.
Informacji na temat miejsc składowania tego typu odpadów udziela
producent sprzętu.

Este símbolo indica que os resíduos do equipamento elétrico e eletrônico


Portuguese- não devem ser descartados no sistema de coleta de lixo municipal, e sim
Brazilian (POB) coletados separadamente. Favor entrar em contato com um
representante autorizado do fabricante para obter informações sobre
como descartar seu equipamento.

Section 1-2 - Important Conventions 1-9


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Table 1-5 WEEE Label

LABEL/SYMBOL LANGUAGE PURPOSE/MEANING

Acest simbol indică faptul că deşeurile de echipamente electrice şi


Romanian electronice nu au voie să fie aruncate nediferenţiat ca gunoi menajer şi c
(ROM) ă ele trebuie colectate separat. Vă rugăm să luaţi legătura cu un
reprezentant autorizat al producătorului pentru a obţine informaţii
referitoare la eliminarea ecologică a echipamentului dumneavoastră.

Символ обозначает: недопустимо выбрасывать электрическое и эле


ктронное оборудование с неотсортированным бытовым мусором. Он
Russian (RUS)
о должно собираться отдельно. Для получения сведений об утилиза
ции оборудования обратитесь к авторизованному представителю ко
мпании-производителя.

Ovaj simbol označava da se otpad električne i elektronske opreme ne


sme odlagati zajedno sa običnim gradskim smećem, već se mora
Serbian (SCC)
pokupiti posebno. Molimo vas da kontaktirate ovlašćenog predstavnika
proizvođača svoje opreme, kako bi ste se informisali o njenom pravilnom
rashodu.

Tento symbol označuje, že odpad elektrického a elektronického materiá


Slovakian
(SLK)
lu sa nesmie vyhadzovať do netriedeného komunálneho odpadu, ale mus
í sa likvidovať oddelene. Viac informácií o likvidácii vášho zariadenia vám
poskytne poverený zástupca výrobcu.

Ta simbol obeležava da se elektronski otpad in elektronska oprema ne sme


Slovenian
(SLN)
odlagati skup z navadnim mesnim otpadom, ter se mora pobrat posebej. Prosimo
vas da kontaktirate pooblaščenega prodajalca opreme, kako bi se informirali o
njenem pravilnem rashodu.

Este símbolo indica que el equipo eléctrico y electrónico no debe tirarse


Spanish-Spain
(SPA)
con los desechos domésticos y debe tratarse por separado. Contacte
con el representante local del fabricante para obtener más información
sobre la forma de desechar el equipo.

Denna symbol anger att elektriska och elektroniska utrustningar inte får avyttras
Swedish
(SWE)
som osorterat hushållsavfall och måste samlas in separat. Var god kontakta en
auktoriserad tillverkarrepresentant för information angående avyttring av
utrustningen.

1-10 Section 1-2 - Important Conventions


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Table 1-5 WEEE Label

LABEL/SYMBOL LANGUAGE PURPOSE/MEANING

Bu sembol, elektrikli ve elektronik ekipmanların sınıflandırılmamış çöp


Turkish (TUR) olarak atılmaması ve ayrı olarak toplanması gerektiğini belirtir. Lütfen
ekipmanınızın imhasıyla ilgili olarak üreticinin yetkili temsilcisine baş
vurun.

Section 1-2 - Important Conventions 1-11


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Section 1-3
Safety Considerations
1-3-1 Introduction
The following safety precautions must be observed during all phases of operation, service and repair of
this equipment. Failure to comply with these precautions or with specific warnings elsewhere in this
manual, violates safety standards of design, manufacture and intended use of the equipment.

1-3-2 Human Safety


Operating personnel must not remove the system covers.
Servicing should be performed by authorized personnel only.
Only personnel who have participated in a LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Training are authorized to service the
equipment.

1-3-3 Mechanical Safety


WARNING WHEN THE UNIT IS RAISED FOR A REPAIR OR MOVED ALONG ANY INCLINE, USE
EXTREME CAUTION SINCE IT MAY BECOME UNSTABLE AND TIP OVER.

WARNING ULTRASOUND PROBES ARE HIGHLY SENSITIVE MEDICAL INSTRUMENTS THAT


CAN EASILY BE DAMAGED BY IMPROPER HANDLING. USE CARE WHEN
HANDLING AND PROTECT FROM DAMAGE WHEN NOT IN USE. DO NOT USE A
DAMAGED OR DEFECTIVE PROBE. FAILURE TO FOLLOW THESE PRECAUTIONS
CAN RESULT IN SERIOUS INJURY AND EQUIPMENT DAMAGE.

WARNING NEVER USE A PROBE THAT HAS FALLEN TO THE FLOOR. EVEN IF IT LOOKS OK,
IT MAY BE DAMAGED.

CAUTION Always lower and center the Opertaor I/O Panel before moving the scanner.

CAUTION The LOGIQ™ P5/A5 weighs 75 kg or more, depending on installed peripherals, (165 lbs., or
more) when ready for use. Care must be used when moving it or replacing its parts. Failure
to follow the precautions listed could result in injury, uncontrolled motion and costly
damage.
ALWAYS:
Be sure the pathway is clear.
Use slow, careful motions.
Use two people when moving on inclines or lifting more than 16 kg (35 lbs).

CAUTION There is a pinch point in LCD monitor. Need care for injury on hands or fingers in flipping
down the LCD monitor.

1-12 Section 1-3 - Safety Considerations


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-3-3 Mechanical Safety (cont’d)


NOTE: Special care should be taken when transporting the unit in a vehicle:

• Secure the unit in an upright position.


• Lock the wheels (brake)
• DO NOT use the Control Panel as an anchor point.
• Place the probes in their carrying case.
• Eject DVD media from the system.

CAUTION Keep the heat venting holes on the monitor unobstructed to avoid overheating of the
monitor.

1-3-4 Electrical Safety


To minimize shock hazard, the equipment chassis must be connected to an electrical ground. The
system is equipped with a three-conductor AC power cable. This must be plugged into an approved
electrical outlet with safety ground. If an extension cord is used with the system, make sure that the total
current rating of the system does not exceed the extension cord rating.

The power outlet used for this equipment should not be shared with other types of equipment.

Both the system power cable and the power connector meet international electrical standards.

WARNING DO NOT SERVICE OR DISASSEMBLE PARTS UNDER FRU UNIT LEVEL AT ANY
CIRCUMSTANCES.

Section 1-3 - Safety Considerations 1-13


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-3-5 Label Locations

(7)

(6)

Korea 220V Console

China 220V Console

Figure 1-2 OUTSIDE MARKINGS OF LOGIQ™ P5/A5


(Rear)
1.) Identification and Rating Plate - USA/Asia 120V Console
2.) Identification and Rating Plate - Europe/Asia/Latin America 220V Console
3.) Identification and Rating Plate - Japan 100V Console
4.) Identification and Rating Plate - Korea 220V Console
5.) Identification and Rating Plate - China 220V Console
6.) Caution EIAJ Label
7.) UL Label
1-14 Section 1-3 - Safety Considerations
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-3-5 Label Locations (cont’d)

Figure 1-3 OUTSIDE MARKINGS OF LOGIQ™ P5/A5


1.) Possible Shock Hazard
2.) Label -”Do not use the following devices near this equipment.”
3.) Label - “The equipment weighs approximately 75kg.
4.) Prescription Devices
5.) CE Mark Label (Left), WEEE Label (Right)
6.) CISPR Label
7.) Grouding reliability Label
8.) Voltage Range Indicationand Power indication Label
9.) Standard LCD Arm & flexible LCD Arm Option Label & Mercury Label
10.)LCD Arm Rotation Label

Section 1-3 - Safety Considerations 1-15


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-3-6 Dangerous Procedure Warnings


Warnings, such as the examples below, precede potentially dangerous procedures throughout this
manual. Instructions contained in the warnings must be followed.

DANGER DANGEROUS VOLTAGES, CAPABLE OF CAUSING DEATH, ARE PRESENT


IN THIS EQUIPMENT. USE EXTREME CAUTION WHEN HANDLING, TESTING
AND ADJUSTING.

WARNING EXPLOSION WARNING


DO NOT OPERATE THE EQUIPMENT IN AN EXPLOSIVE ATMOSPHERE.
OPERATION OF ANY ELECTRICAL EQUIPMENT IN SUCH AN ENVIRONMENT
CONSTITUTES A DEFINITE SAFETY HAZARD.

WARNING DO NOT SUBSTITUTE PARTS OR MODIFY EQUIPMENT


BECAUSE OF THE DANGER OF INTRODUCING ADDITIONAL HAZARDS, DO NOT
INSTALL SUBSTITUTE PARTS OR PERFORM ANY UNAUTHORIZED MODIFICATION
OF THE EQUIPMENT.

1-3-7 Lockout/Tagout Requirements (For USA Only)


Follow OSHA Lockout/Tagout requirements by ensuring you are in total control of the electrical Mains
plug.

Section 1-4
EMC, EMI, and ESD
1-4-1 Electromagnetic Compatibility (EMC)
Electromagnetic compatibility describes a level of performance of a device within its electromagnetic
environment. This environment consists of the device itself and its surroundings including other
equipment, power sources and persons with which the device must interface. Inadequate compatibility
results when a susceptible device fails to perform as intended due interference from its environment or
when the device produces unacceptable levels of emission to its environment. This interference is often
referred to as radio–frequency or electromagnetic interference (RFI/EMI) and can be radiated through
space or conducted over interconnecting power of signal cables. In addition to electromagnetic energy,
EMC also includes possible effects from electrical fields, magnetic fields, electrostatic discharge and
disturbances in the electrical power supply.

1-4-2 CE Compliance
The LOGIQ™ P5/A5 unit conforms to all applicable conducted and radiated emission limits and to
immunity from electrostatic discharge, radiated and conducted RF fields, magnetic fields and power line
transient requirements.

For applicable standards refer to the Safety Chapter in the Basic User Manual.

NOTE: For CE Compliance, it is critical that all covers, screws, shielding, gaskets, mesh, clamps, are in
good condition, installed tightly without skew or stress. Proper installation following all
comments noted in this service manual is required in order to achieve full EMC performance.

1-16 Section 1-4 - EMC, EMI, and ESD


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-4-3 Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Prevention

WARNING DO NOT TOUCH ANY BOARDS WITH INTEGRATED CIRCUITS PRIOR TO TAKING
THE NECESSARY ESD PRECAUTIONS:
1.ALWAYS CONNECT YOURSELF, VIA AN ARM-WRIST STRAP, TO THE ADVISED
ESD CONNECTION POINT LOCATED ON THE REAR OF THE SCANNER (TO THE
RIGHT OF THE POWER CONNECTOR).
2.FOLLOW GENERAL GUIDELINES FOR HANDLING OF ELECTROSTATIC
SENSITIVE EQUIPMENT.

Section 1-4 - EMC, EMI, and ESD 1-17


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

Section 1-5
Customer Assistance
1-5-1 Contact Information
If this equipment does not work as indicated in this service manual or in the User Manual, or if you
require additional assistance, please contact the local distributor or appropriate support resource, as
listed below.

Prepare the following information before you call:

- System ID serial number.


- Software version.

Table 1-6 Phone Numbers for Customer Assistance

Location Phone Number

1-800–437–1171
USA/ Canada
GE Medical Systems
Ultrasound Service Engineering
4855 W. Electric Avenue
Milwaukee, WI 53219
1-800-682-5327
Customer Answer Center 1-262-524-5698
Fax: +1-414-647-4125

1-262-524-5300
Latin America
GE Medical Systems
Ultrasound Service Engineering
4855 W. Electric Avenue
Milwaukee, WI 53219

1-262-524-5698
Customer Answer Center
Fax: +1-414-647-4125

Europe Tel: +49 212 2802 208


GE Ultraschall Deutschland GmbH& Co. KG +49 212 2802 207
BeethovenstraBe 239
Postfach 11 05 60, D-42665 Solingen
Germany Fax: +49 212 2802 431

Tel: +65 291-8528


Asia (Singapore/ Japan)
+81 426-482950
GE Ultrasound Asia
Service Department - Ultrasound
298 Tiong Bahru Road #15-01/06
Central Plaza
Fax: +65 272-3997
Singapore 169730
+81 426-482902

1-18 Section 1-5 - Customer Assistance


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-5-2 System Manufacturer

Table 1-7 System Manufacturer

Manufacturer FAX Number

GE Ultrasound Korea
462-120 65-1, Sangdaewon-dong, Joong-won-Gu,
82-31-740-6436
Seongnam-Si, Gyeonggi-do,
Korea

Section 1-5 - Customer Assistance 1-19


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SEVICE MANUAL

1-20 Section 1-5 - Customer Assistance


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Chapter 2
Pre-Installation

Section 2-1
Overview
2-1-1 Purpose of chapter 2
This chapter provides the information required to plan and prepare for the installation of a LOGIQ™ P5/
A5. Included are descriptions of the facility and electrical needs to be met by the purchaser of the unit.
A checklist is also provided at the end of this section to help determine whether the proper planning and
preparation is accomplished before the actual equipment installation is scheduled.

Table 2-1 Contents in Chapter 2

Section Description Page Number

2-1 Overview 2-1

2-2 General Console Requirements 2-2

2-3 Facility Needs 2-6

Section 2-1 - Overview 2-1


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 2-2
General Console Requirements
2-2-1 Console Environmental Requirements
Table 2-2 Environmental Requirements for LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Scanners

Operational Storage Transport

10 - 30 oC -10 - 60 oC -40 - 60 oC
Temperature oF oF
50 - 104 14 - 140 -40 - 140 oF

30 - 85% 30 - 90% 30 - 90%


Humidity
non-condensing non-condensing non-condensing

Pressure 700 - 1060hPa 700 - 1060hPa 700 - 1060hPa

Table 2-3 Environmental Requirements for an Ultrasound Room

Item Values

Power Source refer to Table 2-4 on page 2-3.

Current Rating 7.5A (100V-120V); 3.5A (220-240V)

Radiation Shielding NONE REQUIRED for ULTRASOUND ENERGY

Temperature 20-26 DEG. C (68-79 DEG F) for PATIENT COMFORT

Humidity 50% to 70% for PATIENT COMFORT

Heat Dissipation 2000 BTU/Hr.

Floor Landing Approximately 680 - 800 kg/m2 without Accessories

Floor Condition Gradient: WITHIN 5 degrees

Weight 75 kg (165lbs) without Accessories

2-2-1-1 Cooling
The cooling requirement for the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 is 2000 BTU/hr. This figure does not include cooling
needed for lights, people, or other equipment in the room. Each person in the room places an additional
300 BTU/hr. demand on the cooling system.

2-2-1-2 Lighting
Bright light is needed for system installation, updates and repairs. However, operator and patient
comfort may be optimized if the room light is subdued and indirect. Therefore a combination lighting
system (dim/bright) is recommended. Keep in mind that lighting controls and diameters can be a source
of EMI which could degrade image quality. These controls should be selected to minimize possible
interface.

2-2-2 Electrical Requirements


NOTE: GE Medical Systems requires a dedicated power and ground for the proper operation of its
Ultrasound equipment. This dedicated power shall originate at the last distribution panel before
the system.

2-2 Section 2-2 - General Console Requirements


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

2-2-2 Electrical Requirements (cont’d)


Sites with a mains power system with defined Neutral and Live:

The dedicated line shall consist of one phase, a neutral (not shared with any other circuit), and a full
size ground wire from the distribution panel to the Ultrasound outlet.

Sites with a mains power system without a defined Neutral:

The dedicated line shall consist of one phase (two lines), not shared with any other circuit, and a full
size ground wire from the distribution panel to the Ultrasound outlet.

NOTE: Please note that image artifacts can occur, if at any time within the facility, the ground from the
main facility's incoming power source to the Ultrasound unit is only a conduit.

2-2-2-1 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Power Requirements


The following power line parameters should be monitored for one week before installation. We
recommend that you use an analyzer Dranetz Model 606-3 or Dranetz Model 626:

Table 2-4 Electrical Specifications for LOGIQ™ P5/A5

PARAMETER AREA LIMITS

100~120V 100~120 VAC ±10% (90-132 VAC)


Voltage Range
220~240V 220-240 VAC ±10% (198-264 VAC)

Power All applications MAX. 750 VA

Line Frequency All applications 50/60Hz (±2Hz)

Less than 25% of nominal peak voltage


for less than 1 millisecond for any type of
Power Transients All applications transient, including line frequency,
synchronous, asynchronous, or
aperiodic transients.

Less than 15% of peak voltage for less


Decaying Oscillation All applications
than 1 millisecond.

2-2-2-2 Inrush Current


Inrush Current is not a factor to consider due to the inrush current limiting properties of the power
supplies.

2-2-2-3 Site Circuit Breaker


It is recommended that the branch circuit breaker for the machine be ready accessible.

CAUTION POWER OUTAGE MAY OCCURE.


The LOGIQ™ P5/A5 requires a dedicated single branch circuit. To avoid circuit overload and
possible loss of critical care equipment, make sure you DO NOT have any other equipment
operating on the same circuit.

2-2-2-4 Site Power Outlets


A desiccated AC power outlet must be within reach of the unit without extension cords. Other outlets
adequate for the external peripherals, medical and test equipment needed to support this unit must also
be present within 1 m (3.2 ft.) of the unit. Electrical installation must meet all current local, state, and
national electrical codes.

Section 2-2 - General Console Requirements 2-3


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

2-2-2-5 Unit Power Plug


If the unit arrives without the power plug, or with the wrong plug, you must contact your GE dealer or
the installation engineer must supply what is locally required.

2-2-2-6 Power Stability Requirements


Voltage drop-out
Max 10 ms.

Power Transients
(All applications)
Less than 25% of nominal peak voltage for less than 1 millisecond for any type of transient, including
line frequency, synchronous, asynchronous, or aperiodic transients.

2-2-3 EMI Limitations


Ultrasound machines are susceptible to Electromagnetic Interference (EMI) from radio frequencies,
magnetic fields, and transient in the air wiring. They also generate EMI. The LOGIQ™ P5/A5 complies
with limits as stated on the EMC label. However there is no guarantee that interface will not occur in a
particular installation.

Possible EMI sources should be identified before the unit is installed.

Electrical and electronic equipment may produce EMI unintentionally as the result of defect.

These sources include:

• medical lasers,
• scanners,
• cauterizing guns,
• computers,
• monitors,
• fans,
• gel warmers,
• microwave ovens,
• light dimmers,
• portable phones.
The presence of broadcast station or broadcast van may also cause interference. See for EMI
Prevention tips.

See Table 2-5 for EMI Prevention tips.

Table 2-5 EMI Prevention/abatement

EMI Rule Details

Keep the unit at least 5 meters or 15 feet away from other EMI sources. Special shielding
Be aware of RF sources may be required to eliminate interference problems caused by high frequency, high
powered radio or video broadcast signals.

Poor grounding is the most likely reason a unit will have noisy images. Check grounding of
Ground the unit
the power cord and power outlet.

After you finish repairing or updating the system, replace all covers and tighten all screws.
Replace all screws, RF Any cable with an external connection requires a magnet wrap at each end. Install the
gaskets, covers, cores shield over the front of card cage. Loose or missing covers or RF gaskets allow radio
frequencies to interface with the ultrasound signals.

2-4 Section 2-2 - General Console Requirements


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Table 2-5 EMI Prevention/abatement

EMI Rule Details

If more than 20% or a pair of fingers on the RF gaskets are broken, replace the gaskets.
Replace broken RF gaskets
Do not turn on the unit until any loose metallic part is removed.

Do not place labels where RF Never place a label where RF gaskets meet the unit. Otherwise, the gap created will permit
gaskets touch metal RF leakage. Or, if a label has been found in such a position, move the label.

Use GE specified harnesses The interconnect cables are grounded and require ferrite beads and other shielding. Also,
and peripherals cable length, material, and routing are all important; do not change from what is specified.

Take care with cellular phones Cellular phones may transmit a 5 V/m signal; that could cause image artifacts.

Do not allow cables to lie across the top of the card cage or hang out of the peripheral bays.
Properly dress peripheral
Loop the excess length for peripheral cables inside the peripheral bays. Attach the monitor
cables
cables to the frame.

2-2-4 Scan Probe Environmental Requirements


Operation:10° to 30° C

Storage:--10° to 60° C

NOTE: Temperature in degrees C. Conversion to Degrees F = (Degrees C * 9/5) + 32).

NOTICE SYSTEMS AND ELECTRONIC PROBES ARE DESIGNED FOR STORAGE TEMPERATURES
OF -10 TO + 60 degrees C. WHEN EXPOSED TO LARGE TEMPERATURE VARIATIONS, THE
PRODUCT SHOULD BE KEPT IN ROOM TEMPERATURE FOR 10 HOURS BEFORE USE.

Section 2-2 - General Console Requirements 2-5


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 2-3
Facility Needs
2-3-1 Purchaser Responsibilities
The work and materials needed to prepare the site is the responsibility of the purchaser. Delay,
confusion, and waste of manpower can be avoided by completing pre installation work before delivery.
User the Pre Installation checklist to verify that all needed steps have been taken,
Purchaser reasonability includes:

• Procuring the materials required.


• Completing the preparations before delivery of the ultrasound system.
• Paying the costs for any alternations and modifications not specifically provided in the sales
contract.

NOTE: All electrical installation that are preliminary to the positioning of the equipment at the site
prepared for the equipment must be performed by licensed electrical contractors. Other
connections between pieces of electrical equipment, products involved (and the accompanying
electrical installations) are highly sophisticated and special engineering competence is
required. All electrical work on these product must comply with the requirements of applicable
electrical codes. The purchaser of GE equipment must only utilize qualified personnel to
perform electrical servicing on the equipment.

The desire to use a non-listed or customer provided product or to place an approved product further
from the system than the interface kit allows presents challenges to the installation team. To avoid
delays during installation, such variances should be made known to the individuals or group performing
the installation at the earliest possible date (preferable prior to purchase).
The ultrasound suite must be clean proof to delivery of the machine. Carpet is not recommended
because it collects dust and creates static. Potential sources of EMI (electromagnetic interference)
should also be investigated before delivery. Dirt, static, and EMI can negatively impact system.

2-6 Section 2-3 - Facility Needs


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

2-3-2 Required Features


NOTE: GE Medical Systems requires a dedicated power and ground for the proper operation of its
Ultrasound equipment. This dedicated power shall originate at the last distribution panel before
the system.

Sites with a mains power system with defined Neutral and Live:

The dedicated line shall consist of one phase, a neutral (not shared with any other circuit), and a full
size ground wire from the distribution panel to the Ultrasound outlet.

Sites with a mains power system without a defined Neutral:

The dedicated line shall consist of one phase (two lines), not shared with any other circuit, and a full
size ground wire from the distribution panel to the Ultrasound outlet.

Please note that image artifacts can occur, if at any time within the facility, the ground from the main
facility's incoming power source to the Ultrasound unit is only a conduit.

• Dedicated single branch power outlet of adequate amperage meeting all local and national codes
which is located less than 2.5 m (8 ft.) from the unit’s proposed location
• Door opening is at least 76 cm (30 in) wide
• Proposed location for unit is at least 0.3 m (1 ft.) from the wall for cooling
• Power outlet and place for any external peripheral are within 2 m (6.5 ft.) of each other with
peripheral within 1 m of the unit to connect cables.

NOTE: The LOGIQ™ P5/A5 has two outlets outside the unit. Both are for on board peripherals.

• Clean and protected space to store transducers (in their cases or on a rack)
• Material to safely clean probes (done with a plastic container, never metal)

Section 2-3 - Facility Needs 2-7


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

2-3-3 Desirable Features


• Door is at least 92 cm (3 ft.) wide
• Circuit breaker for dedicated power outlet is easily accessible
• Sink with hot and cold water
• Receptacle for bio–hazardous waste, like used probe sheaths
• Emergency oxygen supply
• Storage for linens and equipment
• Nearby waiting room, lavatory, and dressing room
• Dual level lighting (bright and dim)
• Lockable cabinet ordered by GE for its software and proprietary manuals.

2-8 Section 2-3 - Facility Needs


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

2-3-4 Recommended and Alternate Ultrasound Room Layout


Recommended standard floor plan and a minimal floor plan for ultrasound equipment:

DEDICATED ALALOG TELEPHONE


LINE FOR CONNECTION TO INSITE

18 IN.
(46 CM) LINEN SUPPLY

DEDICATED

PROCESSING
POWER
RECEPTACLE

ROOM,
CONSOLE

FILM

EXAMINATION
COUNTER
FILM VIEWER FOOT
CABINET

SW
FILE

TABLE
TOP
COUNTER TOP STOOL

SINK
76 IN.
(193 CM)

SUCTION LINE
24 IN.
EMERGECY (61 CM)
OXYGEN
SECRETARYS OR
DOCTOR’S DESK

OVERHEAD PATIENT
LIGHTS DIMMER TOILET
FACILITY

DOOR
42 IN.
(107 CM)
A 14 by 17 foot Recommended Floor Plan
Scale : Each square equals one square foot

FILM VIEWER LINEN SUPPLY


SINK
FILM SUPPLIES PROBES/SUPPLIES

EXTERNAL
PERIPHERALS
DEDICATED POWER
OUTLETS
FOOT LOGIQ 5
SW

STOOL CONSOLE DEDICATED ANALOG TELEPHONE


LINE FOR CONNECTION TO INSITE

EXAMINARION GE CABINET
24 IN. TABLE FOT SOFTWARE
(61 CM) 76 IN.
(193 CM)
AND MANUALS
DOOR
30 IN.
(76 CM)
An 8 by 10 foot Minimal Floor Plan

Figure 2-1 RECOMMENDED ULTRASOUND ROOM LAYOUT

Section 2-3 - Facility Needs 2-9


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

2-3-5 Networking Pre-installation Requirements

2-3-5-1 Purpose of DICOM Network Function


DICOM services provide the operator with clinically useful features for moving images and patient
information over a hospital network. Examples of DICOM services include the transfer of images to
workstations for viewing or transferring images to remote printers. As an added benefit, transferring
images in this manner frees up the on-board monitor and peripherals, enabling viewing to be done while
scanning continues. With DICOM, images can be archived, stored, and retrieved faster, easier, and at
a lower cost.

2-3-5-2 DICOM Option Pre-installation Requirements


To configure the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 to work with other network connections, the site’s network
administrator must provide some necessary information.

Information must include:

• A host name, local port number, AE Title, IP address and Net Mask for the LOGIQ™ P5/A5.
• The IP addresses for the default gateway and other routers at the site for ROUTING
INFORMATION.
• The host name, IP address, port and AE Title for each device the site wants connected to the
LOGIQ™ P5/A5 for DICOM APPLICATION INFORMATION. A field for the make (manufacturer)
and the revision of the device, is also included. This information may be useful for solving errors.

2 - 10 Section 2-3 - Facility Needs


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

2-3-5-2 DICOM Option Pre-installation Requirements (cont’d)


.

.
LOGIQ™
Host Name Local Port IP Address . . .

AE Title Net Mask . . .

ROUTING INFORMATION GATEWAY IP Addresses


Destination
IP Addresses Default . . .

ROUTER1 . . . . . .
ROUTER2 . . . . . .
ROUTER3 . . . . . .

DICOM APPLICATION INFORMATION


NAME MAKE/REVISION AE TITLE IP ADDRESSES PORT

Store 1 . . .

Store 2 . . .

Store 3 . . .

Store 4 . . .

Store 5 . . .

Store 6 . . .

Worklist . . .

Storage
. . .
Commit

MPPS . . .

Figure 2-2 Worksheet for DICOM Network Information

Section 2-3 - Facility Needs 2 - 11


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

2 - 12 Section 2-3 - Facility Needs


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Chapter 3
Installation

Section 3-1
Overview
3-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 3
This chapter contains information needed to install the unit. Included are references to a procedure that
describes how to receive and unpack the equipment and how to file a damage or loss claim.
How to prepare the facility and unit of the actual installation, and how to check and test the unit, probes,
and external peripherals for electrical safety are included in this procedure. Also included in this section
are guidelines for transporting the unit to a new site.

Table 3-1 Contents in Chapter 3

Section Description Page Number

3-1 Overview 3-1

3-2 Installation Reminders 3-2

3-3 Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment 3-4

3-4 Preparing for Installation 3-10

3-5 Completing the Installation 3-10

3-6 System Configuration 3-15

3-7 Available Probes 3-22

3-8 Software/Option Configuration 3-22

3-9 Connectivity Installation Worksheet 3-23

3-10 Insite IP Address Configuration 3-24

3-11 Loading Base System Software 3-24

3-12 Warnings 3-24

3-13 Paperwork 3-25

Section 3-1 - Overview 3-1


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-2
Installation Reminders
3-2-1 Average Installation Time

Table 3-2 Average Installation Time

Description Average Installation Time Comments

Unpacking the scanner 0.5 hour

Scanner wo/options 0.5 hour Dependant on the configuration that is required

DICOM Option 0.5 hour Dependant on the amount of configuration

InSite Option 0.5 hour

The LOGIQ™ P5/A5 has been designed to be installed and checked out by an experienced service
technician in approximately four hours. LOGIQ™ P5/A5 consoles with optional equipment may take
slightly longer.

3-2-2 Installation Warnings


1.) Since the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 weighs approximately 75 kg.(165 lb) without options, preferably two
people should unpack it. Two people are also preferable for installing any additional bulky items.
2.) There are no operator serviceable components. To prevent shock, do not remove any covers or
panels. Should problems or malfunctions occur, unplug the power cord. Only qualified service
personnel should carry out servicing and troubleshooting.

NOTE: For information regarding packing labels, refer to LABELS ON PACKAGE.

3.) After being transported, the unit may be very cold or hot. If this is the case, allow the unit to
acclimate before you turn it on. It requires one hour for each 2.5°C increment it's temperature is
below 10°C or above 30°C.

CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Turning the system on without acclimation after arriving at site
may cause the system to be damaged.

Table 3-3 Acclimation Time

°C 60 55 50 45 40 35 30 25 20 15 10 5 0 -5 -10 -15 -20 -25 -30 -35 -40

°F 140 131 122 113 104 96 86 77 68 59 50 41 32 23 14 5 -4 -13 -22 -31 -40

hrs 8 6 4 2 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20

3-2 Section 3-1 - Overview


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-2-3 Safety Reminders

DANGER WHEN USING ANY TEST INSTRUMENT THAT IS CAPABLE OF OPENING THE
AC GROUND LINE (I.E., METER’S GROUND SWITCH IS OPEN), DON’T TOUCH
THE UNIT!
CAUTION Two people should unpack the unit because of its weight. Two people are required whenever
a part weighing 19kg (35 lb.) or more must be lifted.

CAUTION If the unit is very cold or hot, do not turn on its power until it has had a chance to acclimate
to its operating environment.

CAUTION To prevent electrical shock, connect the unit to a properly grounded power outlet. Do not use
a three to two prong adapter. This defeats safety grounding.

CAUTION Do NOT wear the ESD wrist strap when you work on live circuits and more than 30 V peak is
present.

CAUTION Do not use a 20 Amp to 15 Amp adapter on the 120 Vac unit’s power cord. This unit requires
a dedicated 20 A circuit and can have a 15A plug if the on board peripherals do not cause the
unit to draw more than 14.0 amps.

CAUTION Do not operate this unit unless all board covers and frame panels are securely in place.
System performance and cooling require this.

CAUTION OPERATOR MANUAL(S)


The User Manual(s) should be fully read and understood before operating the LOGIQ™ P5/
A5 and kept near the unit for quick reference.

CAUTION ACOUSTIC OUTPUT HAZARD


Although the ultrasound energy transmitted from the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 probe is within FDA
limits, avoid unnecessary exposure. Ultrasound energy can produce heat and mechanical
damage.

Figure 3-1 Environmental Labels

Section 3-1 - Overview 3-3


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-3
Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment
When a new system arrives, check that any components are not damaged and are not in short supply.
If shipping damage or shortage occurs, contact the address shown in Chapter 1.

CAUTION Do not lift the unit by the Keyboard. Equipment damage may result.

CAUTION The crate with the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 weighs approximately 75 kg. (165 lb) Be prepared for a sudden
shift of weight as the unit is removed from its base (pallet)

1.) Cut the three PLASTIC BANDs.

Plastic Bands

Figure 3-2 Cutting the Plastic Bands.

3-4 Section 3-1 - Overview


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-3 Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment (cont’d)


2.) Lift the TOP COVER up and off.

Top Cover

Figure 3-3 Removing the top Cover

Section 3-1 - Overview 3-5


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-3 Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment (cont’d)


3.) Remove the Top Plate up and off..

Top Plate

Figure 3-4 Removing the Top Plate

3-6 Section 3-1 - Overview


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-3 Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment (cont’d)


4.) Remove the three PLASTIC JOINTs from the OUTER SLEEVE
5.) Remove the OUTER SLEEVE.

Plastic Joint

Outer Sleeve

Palette Assy

Figure 3-5 Removing Plastic Joints and Sleeves

Section 3-1 - Overview 3-7


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-3 Receiving and Unpacking the Equipment (cont’d)


6.) Remove the MONITOR SUPPORTER and Option Box.
7.) Remove the PLASTIC BAG.
8.) Unlock the front caster and carefully put the console off the PALETTE.

Monitor Supporter

Figure 3-6 Moving the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 from the crate

3-8 Section 3-1 - Overview


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-3-1 Moving into Position


CAUTION Do not lift the unit by the Keyboard.
Do not tilt the unit more than 5 degrees to avoid tipping it over.
To avoid injury by tipping over. Set the monitor to the lowest position before moving.

CAUTION Equipment Damage Possibility. Lifting the console by holding covers may damage the covers.
Do not lift the console by holding any covers.

In general, a single adult can move the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 along an even surface with no steep grades.
At least two people should move the machine when large humps, grooves, or grades will be
encountered. (It is better to pull from the rear rather than push from the front of the unit). Before moving,
store all loose parts in the unit. Wrap transducers in soft cloth or foam to prevent damage.

Although LOGIQ™ P5/A5 is a compact and mobile machine, two people should move it over rough
surfaces or up and down grades.

3-3-2 Adjusting System Clock


Set the system clock for the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 to the local time. For procedure of adjusting the system
clock, refer to section 3-6-1-1 on page 15.

Fill out proper customer Information the Product Locator Installation Card. Mail this Installation Card
“Product Locator” to the address corresponding to your pole.

3-3-3 Product Locator Installation Card


NOTE: The Product Locator Installation Card shown may not be same as the provided Product Locator
card.

Figure 3-7 Product Locator Installation Card

Section 3-1 - Overview 3-9


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-4
Preparing for Installation
3-4-1 Verify Customer Order
Compare items received by the customer to that which is listed on the delivery order. Report any items
that are missing, back ordered or damaged.

3-4-2 Physical Inspection

3-4-2-1 System Voltage Settings


Verify that the scanner is set to the correct voltage.
The Voltage settings for the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Scanner is found on a label to the right of the Power switch
and External I/O, on the rear of the system.

WARNING Connecting a LOGIQ™ P5/A5 scanner to the wrong voltage level will most likely destroy
the scanner.

3-4-2-2 Video Formats


Check that the video format for VCR playback is set to the locally used video standard, NTSC or PAL.

3-4-3 EMI Protection


This Unit has been designed to minimize the effects of Electro Magnetic Interference (EMI). Many of the
covers, shields, and screws are provided primarily to protect the system from image artifacts caused by
this interference. For this reason, it is imperative that all covers and hardware are installed and secured
before the unit is put into operation.

Section 3-5
Completing the Installation
3-5-1 Power On/Boot Up
NOTE: After turning off the system, wait at least ten seconds before turning it on again. The system
may not be able to boot if power is recycled too quickly.

3-5-1-1 Scanner Power On


1.) Connect the Main Power Cable at the rear of the System.

WARNING Protective earth must be taken when connecting AC power cable (200V) without its plug
to wall outlet.
2.) Connect the Main Power cable to an appropriate mains power outlet.
3.) Switch ON the Main Circuit Breaker at the rear of the System.

3-10 Section 3-4 - Preparing for Installation


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-5-1 Power On/Boot Up (cont’d)

Figure 3-8 Circuit Breaker

When power is applied to the Scanner, and the Rear Circuit breaker is turned ON, Power is distributed
to the DC Power supply unit and power control assy in the AC power assy. When the Power ON/OFF
key is pressed once, the DC power supply is enabled and feed each DC power to board assemblies.
and system run the software.

4.) Press the ON/OFF key at the front of the System once.

Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation 3-11


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-5-1 Power On/Boot Up (cont’d)

Figure 3-9 Power On/Off Switch Location

3-5-1-2 Power Up Sequence


1.) The Start Up Screen will be shown on the Monitor display when the system is turned ON.

Figure 3-10 Start Up Screen Display

2.) After initialization is complete, all lighted buttons on the Control Panel light and the default B-Mode
screen or Patient screen (no probes are connected) is displayed on the monitor display.
3-12 Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-5-1-3 Power Up Sequence

NOTE: To enter the Maintenance Mode, select Maintenance button.

NOTE: Figure 3-11 on page 3-13 displays when Service Dongle inserted in Rear Panel.

Figure 3-11 Start Application Window

NOTE: Start is selected automatically when it time out.

NOTE: In case the system is locked with task manager, use arirang as a passowrd to unlock the
system.

3-5-2 Power Off/ Shutdown


NOTE: After turning off a system, wait at least ten seconds before turning it on again. The system may
not be able to boot if power is recycled too quickly.

3-5-2-1 Power Shutdown


1.) Press the ON/OFF key at the front of the System. refer to Figure 3-9 on page 3-12 .
2.) Click the shutdown icon in the shutdown dialog box and wait until the system shutdown.
3.) Switch OFF the Main Circuit Breaker at the rear of the system refer to Figure 3-8 on page 3-11 .
4.) Disconnect the Main Power Cable is necessary. For example : Relocating the scanner.

Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation 3-13


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-5-3 Transducer Connection


1.) Connect a transducer to one of the three rightmost transducer receptacle as follows:
A.) Ensure that the transducer twist lock lever to the horizontal position.
B.) Insert the transducer connector on the receptacle guide pin until it touches the receptacle
mating surface.
C.) Twist the transducer twist lock lever to horizontal position to lock it in place. Twist the lever
to the vertical position to disconnect the transducer.

NOTE: It is not necessary to turn OFF power to connect or disconnect a transducer.

3-14 Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-6
System Configuration
3-6-1 System Specifications

3-6-1-1 System Settings

Table 3-1 System Configuration

Configuration Category Description

Enables the user or service personnel to set the


date, time, unit, language, basic information about
Settings
the organization such as the institution name and
department.

1.) Press Insert key on the A/N keyboard to enter the utility menu.
2.) Select Utility > System>General.
3.) Set the Hospital name, Department, Date and Time, Language, and Units.

Figure 3-12 Setting Display

4.) Click on Exit to terminate the utility function.

Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation 3-15


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-6-1-2 Physical Dimensions


The physical dimensions of the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 unit are summarized in Table 3-2 on page 3-16 .
The Size of LOGIQ™ P5/A5, with monitor and peripherals

Table 3-2 Physical Dimensions of LOGIQ™ P5/A5

Height Width Depth Unit

135/141 43.0 64.0 cm

53.15 - 55.50 16.97 25.2 inches

WEIGHT : 75Kg (165bs)


including Monitor
NOTE : Length is in mm
Variation +/- 10%
1350 / 1410

840 / 900

Figure 3-13 Overall Dimensions

3-16 Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-6-1-3 Weight without Monitor and Peripherals

Table 3-3 Weight of LOGIQ™ P5/A5 With Monitor and Without Other Peripherals

Model Weight [kg] Weight [lbs]

LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Approximately 75 Approximately 165

3-6-1-4 Acoustic Noise Output:


Less than 70dB (A) according to DIN 45635 - 19 - 01 - KL2.

3-6-2 Electrical Specifications


Table 3-4 Electrical Specifications for LOGIQ™ P5/A5

System Voltage Current Frequency

1 110 ~ 120 VAC 7 ~ 9A 50~60Hz

2 220 ~ 240 VAC 3.5 ~ 4.5A 50~60Hz

3-6-3 On-Board Optional Peripherals


Table 3-5 List of Recording Devices

Device Manufacturer Model Video Signal


B/W Video Printer SONY UP-D897MD N/A (* USB Interface)

HS-MD3000U
Video Cassette Recorder Mistubishi NTSC/PAL (USB Interface)
HS-MD3000E
DVD Video Recorder Panasonic LQ-MD800 NTSC/PAL (USB Interface)

A6 Color Video Printer SONY UP-D23MD N/A (* USB Interface)

See each option installation instructions for installation and connection procedures.

NOTE: There are no external peripheral options for the LOGIQ™ P5/A5.

3-6-4 External I/O Connector Panel


Located on the rear panel are video input and output connectors, audio input and output, USB,
footswitch connector power connector and control connections for VCR or DVD Recorder, printer, and
service tools.

Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation 3-17


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-6-4 External I/O Connector Panel (cont’d)


This section indicates the pin assignment for each connector.

Figure 3-14 Rear Connector Panel

NOTE: Each outer (case) ground line of peripheral/accessory connectors are protectively grounded.
Signal ground lines are not isolated, except the Service port (3). All of signal lines (include signal
GND) of the Service port are isolated.

3-18 Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-6-4-1 External I/O Pin Outs

Pin No. Signal Pin No. Signal

1 RED 9 N/A

2 GREEN 10 SGND

3 BLUE 11 N/A

4 N/A 12 N/A

5 GND 13 HSYNC

6 RGND 14 VSYNC

7 GGND 15 N/A

8 BGND

Table 3-6 Pin Assignments of DB15 connector for External VGA

Pin No. Signal Pin No. Signal

1 +5 VDC 3 DATA +

2 DATA - 4 GND

Table 3-7 Pin Assignments of USB

Pin No. Signal Pin No. Signal

1 TX+ 5 NC

2 TX- 6 RX-

3 RX+ 7 NC

4 NC 8 NC

Table 3-8 Pin Assignments of Ethernet

Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation 3-19


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-6-5 Video Specification


Video specifications may be needed to be able to connect the VCR or DVD Video Recorder to the
LOGIQ™ P5/A5.

Table 3-9 Video Specifications

640x480 800x600 800x600 1024x768


Timing Parameter NTSC PAL 60Hz 60Hz 75Hz 60Hz
Horizontal Rate [kHz] 60.02 31.25 31.47 37.88 46.88 48.36

Horizontal Period [µs] 16.66 32.00 31.78 26.40 21.33 20.68

Pixel Clock [MHz] 78.75 29.50 24.55 40.00 49.50 65.00

H Blank Width [µs] 3.66 5.97 5.70 6.40 5.17 4.92

H Sync Width [µs] 1.22 2.34 2.36 3.20 1.62 2.09

H Front Porch [µs] 0.20 0.75 0.73 1.00 0.32 0.37

Active Horizontal Period [µs] 13.00 26.03 26.07 20.00 16.16 15.75
Vertical Rate [Hz] 75.03 50.00 59.94 60.32 75.00 60.00

Vertical Period [ms] 13.33 20.00 16.68 16.58 13.33 16.67

V Sync Width [lines=ms] 32=0.53 49=1.57 45=1.43 28=0.74 25=0.53 38=0.79

V Front Porch [lines=µs] 3=50.00 5=160.00 6=190.70 4=105.60 3=64.00 6=124.10

Equalization Gate [lines=µs] 1=16.66 5=160.0 6=190.7 1=26.4 1=21.3 3=62.00

Lines: Field/Frame 800 625/625 525/525 628 625 806


Active Lines/Frame 768 576 480 600 600 768

3-20 Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-6-6 Setting VCR (Mitsubishi MD3000) USB Interface


1.) Turn off the Power of the VCR.
2.) Open the rear panel of the VCR.
3.) Set dip switches. Off 1~6 pins, On 7 pin, and Off 8 pin.

NOTE: 7 Pin ON = USB Interface, OFF = RS232C Interface.

Figure 3-15 Setting VCR USB Interface

Section 3-5 - Completing the Installation 3-21


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-7
Available Probes
See Specifications in the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 User Manual for probes and intended use.

See Chapter 9, for part numbers to be used when ordering new or replacement probes.

Section 3-8
Software/Option Configuration
refer to the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Basic User Manual, Chapter 16, Customizing Your System for information
on configuring items like Hospital, Department, Language, Units (of measure), Date, Time and Date
Format.

For information on configuring Software Options, refer to the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Basic User Manual,
Chapter 16, Customizing Your System.

For information on configuring DICOM Connectivity, refer to the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Basic User Manual,
Chapter 16, Customizing Your System.

3-22 Section 3-8 - Software/Option Configuration


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-9
Connectivity Installation Worksheet

Site System Information

Floor: Comments:
Site:

Dept: Room:

LOGIQ SN: Type: REV:

CONTACT INFORMATION

Name Title Phone E-Mail Address

TCP/IP Settings

Name - AE Title:

IP Settings Remote Archive Setup

IP Address: Remote Archive IP:


Subnet Mask: Remote Archive Name:
Default Gateway:

Services (Destination Devices)


Device Type Manufacturer Name IP Address Port AE Title
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12

Section 3-8 - Software/Option Configuration 3-23


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-10
Insite IP Address Configuration
This information needed to facilitate the OnLine Center engineers in connecting to the system is found
in the InSite Installation Manual.

Section 3-11
Loading Base System Software
3-11-1 Loading Base system Software
For more information on loading base system software, refer to Chapter 8.

Section 3-12
Warnings
3-12-1 Warnings

3-12-1-0-1 USB HDD


External USB type Hard drive may be used to back up the data. But not all kinds of USB type can
be supported .

Never use USB types which require additional power source.

3-12-1-0-2 Starting Echoloader in Maintenance mode


If Echoloader never started once, starting Echoloader in the maintenance mode will not work. In
other words, in order to be able to start Echoloader in maintenace mode, Echoloader should have
been started at least once.

3-24 Section 3-11 - Loading Base System Software


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 3-13
Paperwork
NOTE: During and after installation, the documentation (i.e. User Manuals, Installation Manuals...) for the
peripheral units must be kept as part of the original system documentation. This will ensure that all
relevant safety and user information is available during the operation and service of the complete
system.

3-13-1 Product Locator Installation


NOTE: The Product Locator Installation Card shown may not be same as the provided Product Locator
card.

Figure 3-16 Product Locator Installation Card

3-13-2 User Manual(s)


Check that the correct User Manual(s) for the system and software revision, is included with the
installation. Specific language versions of the User Manual may also be available. Check with your GE
Sales Representative for availability.

3-13-2-1 Reference off-board peripherals and options


None.

Section 3-12 - Warnings 3-25


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3-26 Section 3-12 - Warnings


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Chapter 4
Functional Checks

Section 4-1
Overview
4-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 4
This chapter provides procedures for quickly checking major functions of the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 scanner
diagnostics by using the built-in service software, and power supply adjustments.

Table 4-1 Contents in Chapter 4

Section Description Page Number


4-1 Overview 4-1

4-2 Required Equipment 4-1


4-3 General Procedure 4-2

4-4 Software Configuration Checks 4-22

4-5 Peripheral Checks 4-23

4-10 Site Log 4-48

Section 4-2
Required Equipment
• An empty (blank) DVD-R or CD-R Disk.
• At least one transducer.

Section 4-1 - Overview 4-1


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 4-3
General Procedure

CAUTION SYSTEM REQUIRES ALL COVERS


Operate this unit only when all board covers and frame panels are securely in place. The
covers are required for safe operation, good system performance and cooling purposes.

NOTICE Lockout/Tagout Requirements (For USA only)


Follow OSHA Lockout/Tagout requirements by ensuring you are in total control of the Power Cable
on the system.

TAG
&
LOCKOUT

Signed Date

4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up


NOTE: After turning off the system, wait at least ten seconds before turning it on again. The system
may not be able to boot if power is recycled too quickly.

4-3-1-1 Scanner Power On


1.) Connect the Main Power cable to an appropriate mains power outlet.
2.) Switch ON the Main Circuit Breaker at the rear of the System.

Figure 4-1 Circuit Breaker

When power is applied to the Scanner, and the Rear Circuit breaker is turned ON, Power is distributed
to the DC Power supply unit and power control assy in the AC power assy. When the Power ON/OFF
key is pressed once, the DC power supply is enabled and feed each DC power to board assemblies.
and system run the software

4-2 Section 4-3 - General Procedure


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-1-1 Scanner Power On (cont’d)


3.) Press the ON/OFF key at the front of the System once.

Figure 4-2 Power On/Off Standby Switch Location

4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown


NOTE: After turning off a system, wait at least ten seconds before turning it on again. The system may not be
able to boot if power is recycled too quickly.

4-3-2-1 Scanner Shutdown


1.) Press the On/Off Key at the front of the System once to display the SYSTEM - EXIT menu.
2.) Select Shutdown from the SYSTEM - EXIT menu.

Figure 4-3 System Exit Menu for Power Down

Section 4-3 - General Procedure 4-3


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-2-2 Switch off the System


1.) Switch OFF the Circuit Breaker at the back of the scanner.
2.) Unplug the power cord if necessary. For example : Servicing or relocating the scanner.

4-3-3 System Features

4-3-3-1 Control Panel for LOGIQ™ P5

10
1
2

4 8

Figure 4-4 Control Panel Tour LOGIQ™ P5

1.) Power on/off switch


2.) Alpha Numeric key
3.) Patient Key
4.) TGC
5.) Track Ball
6.) Function Select key
7.) Freeze Key
8.) Gain Knob
9.) User Define Key

4-4 Section 4-3 - General Procedure


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-3-2 Control Panel for LOGIQ™ A5

66

10
1
2

4 8

Figure 4-5 Control Panel Tour LOGIQ™ A5

1.) Power on/off switch


2.) Alpha Numeric key
3.) Patient Key
4.) TGC
5.) Track Ball
6.) Function Select key
7.) Freeze Key
8.) Gain Knob
9.) User Define Key

NOTE: If the LOGIQ™ A5 have been upgrade with Color Upgrade kit, LOGIQ™ A5 have sams keyboard as
LOGIQ™ P5.

Section 4-3 - General Procedure 4-5


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-3-3 Monitor Display for LOGIQ P5

1 2 3 12

22
5 13

6
7

14
8

15

16

17
10

11
18

19 20 21

Figure 4-6 P5 Monitor Display Tour

1. Institution/Hospital Name, Date, Time, 13. Imaging Parameters by Mode.


Operator Identification. 14. Focal Zone Indicator.
2. Patient Name, Patient Identification. 15. TGC.
3. Power Output Readout 16. Body Pattern.
4. GE Symbol: Probe Orientation Marker. 17. Depth Scale.
5. Image Preview. 18. Top Menu
6. Gray/Color Bar. 19. Caps Lock: Lit when On.
7. Cine Gauge. 20. Service Interface icon (wrench), iLinq
8. Measurement Summary Window. icon, and system messages display
9. Image. (not shown on image)
10. Measurement Calipers. 21. Trackball Functionality Status: Scroll,
11. Measurement Results Window. M&A (Measurement and Analysis),
12. Probe Identifier. Exam Preset. Position, Size, Scan Area Width and
Tilt.
22. Sub Menu

4-6 Section 4-3 - General Procedure


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-4 System B/M-Mode Checks


For a basic functional check of the system’s different modes, the Quick Guide will familiarize you with
image optimization for B-Mode, M-Mode, Color Flow, and Doppler.

Table 4-2 B/M-Mode Functions

Optimizes image quality and allows user to reduce beam


Power Output (Acoustic Power)
intensity. 2% increments between 0-100%.

Dynamic Range controls how echo intensities are converted to


Dynamic Range shades of gray, thereby increasing the adjustable range of
contrast.

Increases the number of transmit focal zones or moves the


focal zone(s) so that you can tighten up the beam for a specific
Focus Number and Position
area. A graphic caret corresponding to the focal zone
position(s) appears on the right edge of the image.

Selects a level below which echoes will not be amplified (an


Rejection echo must have a certain minimum amplitude before it will be
processed).

Edge Enhance brings out subtle tissue differences and


boundaries by enhancing the gray scale differences
Edge Enhance
corresponding to the edges of structures. Adjustments to M
Mode's edge enhancement affects the M Mode only.

Temporal filter that averages frames together. This has the


Frame Average
effect of presenting a smoother, softer image.

Enables gray scale image colorization. To deactivate, reselect


Colorize
a Gray Map.

Determines how the echo intensity levels received are


Gray Map
presented as shades of gray.

Rotation (Up/Down) Rotates the image by selecting the value from the pop up menu.

Multi Frequency mode lets you


downshift to the probe's next lower
Frequency
frequency or shift up to a higher
frequency.

Optimizes B Mode frame rate or spatial resolution for the best


Frame Rate/Resolution
possible image.

Provides intuitive representation of non-quantitative


B Flow
hemodynamics in vascular structures.

Sensitivity/PRI Adjusts the sample rate for the flow signal.

Background On lets you view the anatomy roadmap;


Background On/Off
Background Off lets you view just flow information.

Sweep Speed Changes the speed at which the timeline is swept.

Section 4-3 - General Procedure 4-7


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-5 System CFM and PWD Checks

Table 4-3 CFM and PWD Functions

Adjusts the baseline to accommodate faster or slower blood


Baseline
flows to eliminate aliasing.

Velocity scale determines pulse repetition frequency. If the


sample volume gate range exceeds single gate PRF capability,
PRF/Wall Filter
the system automatically switches to high PRF mode. Multiple
gates appear, and HPRF is indicated on the display.

Estimates the flow velocity in a direction at an angle to the


Angle Correct Doppler vector by computing the angle between the Doppler
vector and the flow to be measured

Threshold assigns the gray scale level at which color


Threshold
information stops.

Allows a specific color map to be selected. After a selection has


Map
been made, the color bar displays the resultant map.

Allows blood flow to be viewed from a different perspective, i.e.


Invert red away (negative velocities) and blue toward (positive
velocities). The real-time or frozen image can be inverted.

Controls the number of samples gathered for a single color flow


Packet Size
vector.

Quick Angle Correct Quickly adjusts the angle by 60 degrees

Display layout can be preset to have B-Mode and Time-motion


side-by-side or over-under.
In the side-by-side layout, there are three display alternatives
Doppler Display Formats defined: equal priority, time-motion priority or time-motion with
B-Mode reference.
In the over-under layout, there are three display alternatives
defined: time-motion priority, B Mode priority or equal priority.

Sample Volume Gate Length Sizes the sample volume gate

Slants the B-Mode or Color Flow linear image left or right to get
Scan Area
more information without moving the probe

4-8 Section 4-3 - General Procedure


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-6 Basic Measurements


NOTE: The following instructions assume that you first scan the patient and then press Freeze.

4-3-6-1 Distance and Tissue Depth Measurements


1.) Press MEASURE once an active caliper displays.
2.) To position the active caliper at the start point (distance) or the most anterior point (tissue
depth), move the TRACKBALL.
3.) To fix the start point, press Set. The system fixes the first caliper and displays a second active
caliper.
4.) To position the second active caliper at the end point (distance) or the most posterior point
(tissue depth), move the TRACKBALL.
5.) To complete the measurement, press SET. The system displays the distance or tissue depth
value in the measurement results window.
Before you complete a measurement:

To toggle between active calipers, press MEASURE.

To erase the second caliper and the current data measured and start the measurement again, press
CLEAR once.

NOTE: To rotate through and activate previously fixed calipers, turn CURSOR SELECT.

NOTE: After you complete the measurement, to erase all data that has been measured to this point,
but not data entered onto worksheets, press CLEAR.

4-3-6-2 Circumference/Area (Ellipse) Measurement


1.) Press MEASURE once; an active caliper displays.
2.) To position the active caliper, move the TRACKBALL.
3.) To fix the start point, press SET. The system fixes the first caliper and displays a second active
caliper.
4.) To position the second caliper, move the TRACKBALL.
5.) Turn the ELLIPSE control; an ellipse with an initial circle shape appears.

Section 4-3 - General Procedure 4-9


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-6-2 Circumference/Area (Ellipse) Measurement (cont’d)

NOTE: Be careful not to press the Ellipse control as this activates the Body Pattern.

6.) To position the ellipse and to size the measured axes (move the calipers), move the
TRACKBALL.
7.) To increase the size, turn the ELLIPSE control in a clockwise direction. To decrease the size,
turn the ELLIPSE control in a counterclockwise direction.
8.) To toggle between active calipers, press MEASURE.
9.) To complete the measurement, press SET. The system displays the circumference and area
in the measurement results window.
Before you complete a measurement:

- To erase the ellipse and the current data measured, press CLEAR once. The original caliper
is displayed to restart the measurement.
- To exit the measurement function without completing the measurement, press CLEAR a
second time.

4-3-6-3 Worksheets
Measurement/Calculation worksheets are available to display and edit measurements and calculations.
There are generic worksheets as well as Application specific worksheets.

4-3-7 Probe/Connectors Usage

4-3-7-1 Connecting a probe


1.) Place the probe's carrying case on a stable surface and open the case.
2.) Carefully remove the probe and unwrap the probe cable.
3.) DO NOT allow the probe head to hang free. Impact to the probe head could result in irreparable
damage.
4.) Turn the connector locking handle counterclockwise.
5.) Align the connector with the probe port and carefully push into place.
6.) Turn the connector locking handle clockwise to secure the probe connector.
7.) Carefully position the probe cable in the probe cord holder spot so it is free to move, but not
resting on the floor.

4-3-7-2 Activating the probe


Select the appropriate probe from the probe indicators on the monitor screen. The probe selection
scrren will be come up when the application key is enabled.

The probe activates in the currently-selected operating mode. The probe's default settings for the mode
and selected exam are used automatically.

4 - 10 Section 4-3 - General Procedure


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-7-3 Deactivating the probe


When deactivating the probe, the probe is automatically placed in standby mode.

1.) Press the Freeze key.


2.) Gently wipe the excess gel from the face of the probe. (refer to the Basic User Manual for
complete probe cleaning instructions.)
3.) Carefully slide the probe around the right side of the keyboard, toward the probe holder.
Ensure that the probe is placed gently in the probe holder.

4-3-7-4 Disconnecting the probe


Probes can be disconnected at any time. However, the probe should not be selected as the active
probe.

1.) Move the probe locking handle counterclockwise. Pull the probe and connector straight out of
the probe port.
2.) Carefully slide the probe and connector away from the probe port and around the right side of
the keyboard. Ensure the cable is free.
3.) Be sure that the probe head is clean before placing the probe in its storage box.

4-3-8 Using Cine

4-3-8-1 Activating CINE


Press FREEZE, then roll the TRACKBALL to activate CINE. To start CINE Loop playback, press Run/
Stop. To stop CINE Loop playback. press Run/Stop.

4-3-8-2 Quickly Move to Start/End Frame


Press FIRST to move to the first CINE frame; press LAST to move to the last CINE frame.

4-3-8-3 Start Frame/End Frame


Turn the START FRAME dial to the left to move to the beginning of the CINE Loop. Turn the dial to the
right to move forward through the CINE Loop.

Turn the END FRAME dial to the right to move to the end of the CINE Loop. Turn the dial to the left to
move backward through the CINE Loop.

Section 4-3 - General Procedure 4 - 11


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-8-4 Adjusting the CINE Loop Playback Speed


Turn the LOOP SPEED dial right/left to increase/decrease the CINE Loop playback speed.

4-3-8-5 Disconnecting B-Mode CINE from Timeline CINE


To review the B-Mode CINE Loop only, press CINE MODE SELECTION and select B ONLY.

To review the Timeline CINE Loop only, press CINE MODE SELECTION and select TL ONLY.

To return to linked B-Mode and Timeline CINE Loop review, press CINE MODE SELECTION and select
B/TL.

4-3-8-6 Moving through a CINE Loop Frame By Frame


Turn FRAME BY FRAME to move through CINE memory one frame at a time.

4-3-9 Image Management (QG)


For Image Management functionality refer to the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Quick Guide. It talks about several
topics:

• Clipboard
• Printing Images
• Browsing and Managing an Exam’s Stored Image
• Connectivity, and Dataflow Concept and Creation
• Starting an Exam
• Configuring Connectivity
• TCP/IP
• Services (Destinations)
• Buttons
• Views
Verifying and Pinging a Device

4 - 12 Section 4-3 - General Procedure


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-10 Using the DVD-R

4-3-10-1 Using the DVD-R

NOTICE Never move the unit with a disk in the DVD-R because the drive actuator will not be locked
and the DVD-R could break.

1.) Go to the Utility->Connectivity->Removable Media.


2.) Insert CD/DVD media.
3.) Press Verify
4.) The properties will be like below.
a.) Capacity, Free space depends on media type.
b.) Formatted / Finalized : No

Figure 4-7 Removable Media

5.) Go to Patient.
6.) Press Data Transfer (located at the upper-left side of Patient screen)
7.) Select Export task.

Section 4-3 - General Procedure 4 - 13


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-10-1 Using the DVD-R (cont’d)


8.) Select the type of Removable CD/DVD on the [To] combo box.
9.) It will do auto-formatting.

Figure 4-8 Formatting

10.)After auto-formatting, select some patients on the upper list area and then press the [Transfer]
button.
11.)it will do transferring to CD/DVD.

Figure 4-9 Transferring

4 - 14 Section 4-3 - General Procedure


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-10-1 Using the DVD-R (cont’d)


12.)The selected data is transferred correctly.

Figure 4-10 Transfer

13.)Press F3 and select the [Yes and Verify files].


14.)It will do finalizing.

Figure 4-11 Finalzing

Section 4-3 - General Procedure 4 - 15


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-10-1 Using the DVD-R (cont’d)


15.)It will do Verifying.

Figure 4-12 Verifying

16.)It will eject the CD/DVD and Go to Utility and reinsert the CD/DVD.
17.)Go to Utility->Connectivity->Removable Media.

Figure 4-13 Removable Media

18.)Press Verify
19.)The properties will be like below.
a.) Capacity is the size of transferred data.
b.) Free space is 0.
c.) Formatted / Database Present / Finalized : Yes
(DICOMDIR Present : depends on setting)

NOTICE Avoid mechanical ejection whenever possible. Mechanical ejection leaves the actuator
unlocked. If forced to use this method, reboot the system, then insert and eject a known good
disk using one of the other methods.
4 - 16 Section 4-3 - General Procedure
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-11 Backup and Restore Database, Preset Configurations and Images

4-3-11-1 Formatting Media


1.) To format the backup media, CD-R or DVD-R, select the UTILITY key on the Front Panel.
2.) Select CONNECTIVITY, then RERNOVABLE MEDIA. Properly label and Insert the backup
media.
3.) Select the media type from the drop down menu.
4.) Enter the label for the media as shown in Figure 4-7. It is best to use all capital letters with no
spaces or punctuation marks.

Media Verify Format


Selection
Media Label Format

Figure 4-14 Format and Verify Media

5.) The Ultrasound system displays a pop-up menu, as shown in Figure 4-8. When the formatting
has been completed, press OK to continue.
6.) If desired, verify that the format was successful by returning to
Utility>Connectivity>Rernovable Media and selecting VERIFY as shown in Figure 4-7.

Figure 4-15 Format Successful Pop-up Menu

Section 4-3 - General Procedure 4 - 17


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-11-2 Backup System Presets and Configurations

NOTE: Always backup any preset configurations before a software reload. This ensures that if the presets need
to be reloaded, after the software update, they will be the same ones the customer was using prior to
service.

1.) Insert a formatted CD-R or DVD-R into the drive.


2.) Press UTILITY key
3.) Select SYSTEM. on the monitor screen
4.) On the monitor display, select BACKUP/RESTORE.
5.) In the Backup list, select Patient Archive, Report Archive, System Configuration and User Defined
Configuration.
6.) In the Media field, select DVD-R.
7.) Select BACKUP.
The system performs the backup. As it proceeds, status information is displayed on the Backup/Restore
screen.

Check here to
backup presets
and configurations

Figure 4-16 Backup/Restore Menu

4 - 18 Section 4-3 - General Procedure


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-11-3 Restore System Presets and Configurations

CAUTION The restore procedure overwrites the existing database on the local hard drive. Make sure to insert
the correct CD-R or DVD-R.

1.) Insert the Backup/Restore CD-R or DVD-R into the drive.


2.) Press the UTILITY. key
3.) Select SYSTEM.menu on the monitor screen
4.) On the monitor display, select BACKUP/RESTORE.
5.) In the Restore list, select Patient Archive, Report Archive, System Configuration and User Defined
Configuration.
6.) In the Media field, select the Backup/Restore DVD-R.
7.) Select RESTORE.
d.) The system performs the restore. As it proceeds, status information is displayed on the
Backup/Restore screen.

Figure 4-17 Backup/Restore Menu

Section 4-3 - General Procedure 4 - 19


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-11-4 Archiving Images


To export an exam(s) to a compatible Ultrasound system:

1.) Format the removable media (CD-ROM/DVD-R). Label the removable media. Answer Yes/OK
to the messages.Press Patient. Deselect any selected patient(s) in the search portion of the
Patient screen. Press Exam Data Transfer (located at the upper, left-hand corner of the Patient
menu).

Figure 4-18 Exam Data Transfer

2.) Select Export task Button.

Figure 4-19 Task button

3.) The [From] combo box is not active. It displays Local Archive. The [To] combo box is active.
Select the type of removable media CD R/DVD-R. Then please wait until the patient list is
visible.

Figure 4-20 To Combo Box

4 - 20 Section 4-3 - General Procedure


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-11-4 Archiving Images (cont’d)


4.) In the patient list at the top of the Patient menu, select the patient(s) you want to export. You
can use Windows commands to select more than one patient. To select a consecutive list of
patients, click the cursor on the first name, move the cursor to the last name, then press and
hold down the Shift+right Set key to select all the names. To select a non-consecutive list of
patients, click the cursor at the first name, move the cursor to the next name, then press and
hold down the Ctrl+right Set key, move the cursor to the next name, then press and hold down
the Ctrl+right Set key again, etc. You can also search for patients via the Search key and string.
Or, Select All Button from the Patient Menu:

Figure 4-21 Source Section

NOTE: You need to use your best judgment when moving patients' images. If there are lots of images
or loops, then only move a few patients at a time.

5.) Once you have selected all of the patients to export, press Transfer Button as shown in Figure
4-18 from the Patient Menu.
6.) The progress bar appears as the copy is taking place. Once transfer completed, the exported
patient list will be shown as Figure 4-22.

Figure 4-22 Destination Section of Patient Screen

7.) Press F3 to eject the media. Specify that you want to finalize the CD-ROM.

Section 4-3 - General Procedure 4 - 21


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-3-12 ECG Check Out


Connect the ECG Harness and check:

Table 4-4 ECG Harness Check

Step Task to do Expected Result(s)

1. Connect the ECG at the Connector on the Front of the It will display a curve along the bottom edge of the image
scanner. sector

Section 4-4
Software Configuration Checks

Table 4-5 Software Configuration Checks

Step Task to do Expected Result(s)


1. Check Date and Time setting Date and Time are correct

2. Check that Location (Hospital Name) is correct Location Name is correct

3. Check Language settings Desired Language is displayed

4. Print1, 2 Keys and User define Keys are assigned as


Check assignment of Printer Keys and User Define Keys
desired by the customer
5. Check that all of the customer’s options are set up correct All authorized functions are enabled

4 - 22 Section 4-4 - Software Configuration Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 4-5
Peripheral Checks
Check that peripherals work as described below:

Table 4-6 Peripheral Checks

Step Task to do Expected Result(s)


1. Press (FREEZE) Stop image acquisition.

2. The image displayed on the screen is printed on B&W or Color printer,


Press (P1) or (P2) on the Keyboard
depending on the key assignment configuration

3. Press RECORD on the Keyboard. To start the video counter at a different point:

4. Press UPDATE MENU in the Trackball area. The Video Set Counter / Search Dialog window is displayed

Use the alphanumeric keyboard to enter


5. Number appears
the counter number in the counter field.

6. Press SET COUNTER to save the change. Number is saved

7. Press RECORD on the KEYBOARD to return to the scanning mode

to Start Recording
8. Press REC/PAUSE icon on the screen A red dot is displayed in the VCR status area on the Title bar to indicate
that recording has begun

To Stop recording
9. Press REC/PAUSE icon on the screen.
The video status icon is changed to (Pause)

10. Press RECORD on the KEYBOARD and the


To start, Play back an examination
assignable play

to perform actions on the recorded session, such as stop, pause, rewind


Use the Assignable keys on the Control
11. or fast forward.
Panel
The video status icon in updated accordingly.

While in playback mode, use the


12. TRACKBALL to adjust the video playback To search on the tape
speed and scroll through the record.

13. Press the assignable PAUSE to stop the tape at the desired frame.

part of it can be stored on the computer’s memory as a cineloop.The


14. When playing back an examination cineloop enables the user to perform further operations on the stored
section (see for further information on cineloop operation).

15. Press (FREEZE) while playing back a To store a recorded sequence as a cineloop. The last few seconds are
recorded session. stored as a cineloop.

Section 4-4 - Software Configuration Checks 4 - 23


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 4-6Monitor Function Checks


4-6-1 15" LCDMON II Assy & LCD Panel with filter Function Validation Procedure
1.) Turn on the system.
2.) Select "Utility Key" on the Key board and then choose "Test Pattern" and "Resolution" marked in
the figure below..

Figure 4-23 15” LCDMON Assy Function Check

3.) All the Numbers from 0 to 100 on the figure above should be easily distinguished.

4 - 24 Section 4-4 - Software Configuration Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-6-2 15" OSD Key Assy Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system.
2.) Select "OSD Button" and "Lamp Button" marked below in the figure below.

Lamp Button OSD button for


menu display
Figure 4-24

3.) OSD Menu should be displayed within 5sec and the Lamp should be turned on as soon as Lamp
Button is pushed.
4.) Select "OSD Button " marked below in the figure below and check that contrast value is changed
as soon as the button pushed.

OSD button for adjusting values

Figure 4-25

5) Displayed value should be changed as soon as the button pushed.

Section 4-4 - Software Configuration Checks 4 - 25


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 4-7Keyboard Function Checks


4-7-1 Main Keyboard Assy Function Validation Procedure
1.) Boot up the system.
2.) Insert the Service Dongle and go to the maintenance mode.
3.) Click 'Start' and go to 'Run'.

Figure 4-26 start and run

4.) Click the Run and then you can get the 'Run' dialog box.
5.) Write the 'cmd 'command into 'Run' dialog box and press 'OK' button to display command prompt.

Figure 4-27 Run dialog box

Figure 4-28 command prompt


4 - 26 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-7-1 Main Keyboard Assy Function Validation Procedure (cont’d)


6.) Write the 'scfpapitest.exe' on the command prompt and press 'Enter' button to pop up the
scfpapitest program.

Figure 4-29 scfpapitest program

7.) Press the keyboard button and rotate rotary button. When you press or rotary keys, Log dialog box
displays the key log. Button name and displaying log name is like the table.

Table 4-7 Button and Rotaty Table

Button or Rotary Name The Name displayed in Log Button or Rotary Name The Name displayed in Log

Patient New Patient Button Active Mode Active Mode Button

Probe/Preset Probe Button CF CFM PushEncoder Button

Report Report Button PDI PDI Button

End Exam End Exam Button Dept (Button) Depth PushEncoder Button

Record Record button Dept (Rotary) Depth PushEncoder Rotary

P1 Print or record button1 PW PWD PushEncoder Button

P2 Print or record button2 CW CW Button

Reverse Reverse Button M M Mode PushEncoder

Userdefine 1 Userdefine 1 Button Scan Area ScanArea Button

Userdefine 2 Userdefine 2 Button M/D Cursor MD Cursor Button

Userdefine 3 Userdefine 3 Button Zoom (Button) Zoom/Size PushEncoder Button

Userdefine 4 Userdefine 4 Button Zoom (Rotary) Zoom/Size PushEncoder Rotary

Userdefine 5 Userdefine 5 Button Measure Measure Button

BodyPattern/Ellipse PushEncoder
L (Left) Left Button BodyPattern/Ellipse (Button)
Button

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 27


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Table 4-7 Button and Rotaty Table

Button or Rotary Name The Name displayed in Log Button or Rotary Name The Name displayed in Log

BodyPattern/Ellipse PushEncoder
R (Right) Right Button BodyPattern/Ellipse (Rotary
Rotary

THI Harmonics Button Comment comment Button

AO Auto Right Button Clear Clear Button

B (Button) B PushEncoder Button TGC Slide Slider : n=8 s1 ~ s8

B (Rotary) B PushEncoder Rotary

NOTICE When you can check the name displayed in log as you press or rotate keys, the main keyboard assy
was replaced correctly.
8.) Check the 'Fast' radio button into Indicator box on scfpapitest program and press 'Set All' button.

Figure 4-30 Fast button

NOTICE After pressing Fast radio button, indicators should be blanked on the frontpanel.

4 - 28 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-7-2 Sub Keyboard Assy Function Validation Procedure


1.) Boot up the system and run the scfpapitest program.

NOTICE Follow up the procedure 4-7-1 "Main Keyboard Assy Function Validation Procedure" on page 4-26 to
run the scfpapitest program.

2.) Press and Rotary sub keyboard, and Paddle(up/down, right/left) button.
3.) Check the log dialog box in scfpapitest program

Table 4-8 Button and Rotary Table

Button or Rotary Name The Name displayed in Log

1 (Button/Rotary) PushEncoder 1 of Touchpanel Button/Rotary

2 (Button/Rotary) PushEncoder 2 of Touchpanel Button/Rotary

3 (Button/Rotary) PushEncoder 3 of Touchpanel Button/Rotary

4 (Button/Rotary) PushEncoder 4 of Touchpanel Button/Rotary

5 (Button/Rotary) PushEncoder 5 of Touchpanel Button/Rotary

Up Paddle Up Button

Down Paddle Down Button

Left Paddle Left Button

Right Paddle Right Button

4-7-3 Trackball Assy validation


1.) Boot up the system.
2.) Press the measurement button.
3.) Move the Trackball.
When you move the trackball in measurement mode, the cursor should be moved.

4-7-4 A/N Key assy validation


1.) Boot up the system.
2.) Press 'Comment' button.
3.) Press A/N keyboard.
Each key should be displayed on the monitor display.

4-7-5 Freeze key validation


1.) Follow up the procedure 4-7-1 "Main Keyboard Assy Function Validation Procedure" on page 4-26
to run the scfpapitest program.
2.) Press Freeze button and check up the Log dialog box if the freeze key was release.

NOTICE After pressing Freeze button, Freeze button message should be displayed into Log dialogbox on
scfpapitest program.

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 29


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-7-6 TGC key assay / TGC Knob Set validation


1.) Follow up the procedure 4-7-1 "Main Keyboard Assy Function Validation Procedure" on page 4-26
to run the scfpapitest program.
2.) Slide TGC pot and check up the value.

NOTICE While sliding TGC pot, TGC message should be displayed.

4-7-7 Sub Keyboard Encoder Knob Set validation


Follow up 4-7-2 "Sub Keyboard Assy Function Validation Procedure" on page 4-29.

4 - 30 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 4-8Mechanical Function Checks


4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation
Table 4-9 Cover parts of the FRU

No Item
1 Right and Left cover

2 Front cover

3 Rear cover

4 Middle cover

5 Top cover

6 Top bottom cover

7 Pole cover

8 Neck front cover

9 Neck rear cover

10 Dummy cover L/R

11 EMI cover L/R

12 LCD Std Arm with cover

13 Rear handle

14 Rear hook

15 ECG cable hook

16 Cable Arm hook

17 LP5/LA5 Monitor Cover set

• Check if the FRU parts are assembled tightly by naked eye and hands.
• Check if there are dents, scratches, or cracks on the FRU parts.
• Check if screws are in place.

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 31


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-8-2 LCD plastic filter Function Validation Procedure


Check if LCD plastic filter is fastened so that it won't move.

Figure 4-31

4-8-3 Air filter set Function Validation Procedure


Check if the air filter is placed deep inside.

Figure 4-32

4 - 32 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-8-4 TGC key assy/TGD Knob Set, Sub keyboard encoder Knob Set, Keycap set, Main
Keyboard Encoder Knob set Function Validation Procedure
• Check if the each button operates properly.
• Check if encoder knobs are in the center.
• Check if the keycap set can not be removed easily.

Figure 4-33

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 33


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-8-5 Cup holder Function Validation Procedure


Check if the cup holder can not be removed easily.

Figure 4-34

4 - 34 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-8-6 Front caster/Rear caster Function Validation Procedure


• In case of Bi break caster, check all caster locks and caster swivel locks for proper operation.
• In case of front caster, check caster locks for proper operation.
• In case of rear caster, check caster's motion for proper operation.
• Check if screws are in place.

Figure 4-35

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 35


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-8-7 Probe holder Function Validation Procedure


Check if the probe holers are assembled tightly by naked eye and hands.

Check if the probe holder can not be removed easily.

Figure 4-36

4 - 36 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-8-8 Flexible LCD Arm Function Validation Procedure


• Check if the flexible arm operates properly.(Up-down, rotation and tilting mechanism)
• Check if the flexible arm cover parts can not be removed easily.Check if the lock operates properly.

Figure 4-37

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 37


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 4-9Board Function Checks


4-9-1 CL1TRX Assy / BL1TRX Assy Function Validation Procedure
1.) Turn on the system and check the completion of Echoloader loading.
2.) Do the Service Login. Refer to the 5-10-2-2 "Service Login" on page 5-41.
3.) Select 'Diagnostics' => 'LOGIQ P5 Diagnostics' => 'FRU Test' => 'CL1TRX Assy / BL1TRX overall'.
4.) Execute the diagnostic test.
5.) 5)All diagnostic test item of CL1TRX Assy / BL1TRX should be passed.

Figure 4-38 CL1TRX Diagnostic test

6.) Check the basic function of system's different modes. Refer to 4-3-4 "System B/M-Mode Checks"
on page 4-7 and refer to 4-3-5 "System CFM and PWD Checks" on page 4-8.

4 - 38 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-9-2 ACWD Assy Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system.
2.) Do the service login. Refer to 5-10-2-2 "Service Login" on page 5-41.
3.) Select "Diagnostics" => "LOGIQ P5 Diagnostics" => "FRU Test".
4.) Select "ACWD" => "ACWD Overall"
5.) After All diagnostic function check of ACWD should be Passed. Refer to Table 7-5, “FRU Test,
ACWD Diagnostics Menu,” on page 18.Reboot up the system.

Figure 4-39 ACWD Diagnostic Test

6.) Reboot up the system.


7.) Insert Probe in Probe port (Sector or Pencil Probe).
8.) After system boot up, enter the CWD mode.
9.) check the display Image. Refer to 8-4-1-1 "System Checks" on page 8-126 and 4-3-5 "System CFM
and PWD Checks" on page 4-8.

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 39


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-9-3 SYSCONML Assy Function Validation Procedure

4-9-3-1 L1SYSCON diagnostic Test


1.) Turn on the system and check the completion of echoloader loading.
2.) Do the Service Login. Refer to 5-10-2-2 "Service Login" on page 5-41.
3.) Select 'Diagnostics' => 'LOGIQ P5 Diagnostics' => 'FRU test' => 'L1SYSCON' => 'L1SYSCON
Overall'.
4.) Execute the diagnostic test.
5.) All diagnostic test item of L1SYSCON should be passed.

Figure 4-40 L2SYSCON Diagnostic Test

6.) Check the basic function of system's different modes. Refer to 4-3-4 "System B/M-Mode Checks"
on page 4-7 and refer to 4-3-5 "System CFM and PWD Checks" on page 4-8.

4-9-3-2 Peripheral Test


Refer to Section 4-5 "Peripheral Checks" on page 4-23.

4 - 40 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-9-4 APS Assy PCB Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system.
2.) Do the Service Login. Refer to 5-10-2-2 "Service Login" on page 5-41.
3.) Select 'Diagnostics' => 'LOGIQ P5 Diagnostics' => 'FRU test' => 'APS' => 'APS Overall'.
4.) Execute the diagnostic test.
5.) All diagnostic test item of APS should be passed.

Figure 4-41 APS Diagnostic Test

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 41


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-9-5 P3RLY,P2RLY and P2RLY with Dummy Assy function check procedure
1.) Turn on the system.
2.) After completion of echoloader loading, connect probe on port 1. Refer to 4-3-7-1 "Connecting a
probe" on page 4-10.
3.) Log into "Service Login". Refer to 5-10-2-2 "Service Login" on page 5-41.
4.) Click "Diagnostics" on top menu.
5.) On left folder window, select 'LOGIQ P5 Diagnostics' => 'FRU test' => 'P3RLY'
6.) Select 'P3RLY Overall' and execute test
7.) All diagnostic test items must be passed.

Figure 4-42 P3RLY diagnostic test

8.) Return to Echoloader and activate probe. Refer to 4-3-7-2 "Activating the probe" on page 4-10.
9.) Check the system basic functions. Refer to 4-3-4 "System B/M-Mode Checks" on page 4-7 and refer
to 4-3-5 "System CFM and PWD Checks" on page 4-8.
- For LA5 system, omit CFM test
10.)Disconnect probe. Refer to 4-3-7-4 "Disconnecting the probe" on page 4-11.
11.)Connect probe on port 2 and repeat step 8) ~ 10)
12.)Connect probe on port 3 and repeat step 8) ~ 10)
- For LA5 system, omit port 3 test
13.)All basic functions must show correct operation as described.

4 - 42 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-9-6 SOM Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system.
2.) Press the 'del' key in A/N key within 3 sec. to enter BIOS setting mode.
3.) Set the system time and the system Date.
4.) Check the SOM version (HW version & BIOS version)

3.)

4.) BIOS version

4.)HW version

Figure 4-43 Set the system time and the system Date and Check SOM version on BIOS setting mode

5.) Press the 'F10' key to save configuration changes and exit bios mode. The system will restart.
6.) Check the basic function of system's different modes. Refer to 4-3-4 "System B/M-Mode Checks"
on page 4-7 and refer to 4-3-5 "System CFM and PWD Checks" on page 4-8.

4-9-7 RFC Assy Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system
2.) Check the basic function of system's different modes.
Refer to 4-3-4 "System B/M-Mode Checks" on page 4-6 and Refer to 10-5-2-1 "System Checks" on
page 10-8.

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 43


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-9-8 BackPlane Assy Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system
2.) All of attached ASSY should be tested.
3.) Refer to the 4-9-3 "SYSCONML Assy Function Validation Procedure" on page 4-40.
4.) Refer to the 4-9-6 "SOM Function Validation Procedure" on page 4-43.
5.) Refer to the 4-9-1 "CL1TRX Assy / BL1TRX Assy Function Validation Procedure" on page 4-38.
6.) Refer to the 4-9-5 "P3RLY,P2RLY and P2RLY with Dummy Assy function check procedure" on page
4-42.
7.) Refer to 4-9-4 "APS Assy PCB Function Validation Procedure" on page 4-41.
8.) Refer to 4-9-2 "ACWD Assy Function Validation Procedure" on page 4-39.(Optional)

4 - 44 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-9-9 Nest fan Function Validation Procedure


1.) After replace Nest fan assy, turn on the system. Refer to 3-5-1 "Power On/Boot Up" on page 3-10.
2.) Confirm the fan rotating with naked eye and check the fan operating by rotating sound. No strange
sound should be heard.

Figure 4-44 Checking Nest fan rotating

NOTE: Do not close the right EMI bracket and right plastic cover before check the fan operation.

4-9-10 Transbox Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system. Refer to 3-5-1 "Power On/Boot Up" on page 3-10 for power up sequence to
check Transbox Assy function. The system must show correct operation as described on sequence.
2.) Check the peripheral operation. Refer to Section 4-5 "Peripheral Checks" on page 4-23 to confirm
the peripheral operation. All peripheral must work correctly as described Section 4-5.

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 45


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-9-11 DTRX Cooler with heatsink Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system
2.) Check the basic function of system's different modes. Refer to 4-3-4 "System B/M-Mode Checks"
on page 4-6 and refer to 4-3-5 "System CFM and PWD Checks" on page 4-7.
Refer to 10-5-2-1 "System Checks" on page 10-8 and Section 10-6 "Using a Phantom" on page 10-11.

4-9-12 ACPC Assy set Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system. Refer to 3-5-1 "Power On/Boot Up" on page 3-10 for power up sequence to
check Transbox Assy function. The system must show correct operation as described on sequence.
2.) Check the peripheral operation. Refer to Section 4-5 "Peripheral Checks" on page 4-23 to confirm
the peripheral operation. All peripheral must work correctly as described Section 4-5.

4 - 46 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4-9-13 AP950 Transbox Assy Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system. Refer to 3-5-1 "Power On/Boot Up" on page 3-11 for power up sequence to
check AP950 Assy function. The system must show correct operation as described on sequence.
2)Check the peripheral operation. Refer to Section 4-5 "Peripheral Checks" on page 4-23 to confirm the
peripheral operation. All peripheral must work correctly as described Section 4-5.

4-9-14 Fuse set Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system. Refer to 3-5-1 "Power On/Boot Up" on page 3-10 for power up sequence to
check Transbox Assy function. The system must show correct operation as described on sequence.
2.) Check the peripheral operation. Refer to Section 4-5 "Peripheral Checks" on page 4-23 to confirm
the peripheral operation. All peripheral must work correctly as described Section 4-5.

4-9-15 ARP Assy Function Validation Procedure


1.) ARP Assy function can be validated by the result of 'Peripheral Test'. Once ARP Assy is replaced,
do peripheral test in order to confirm the successful installation. Refer to the Section 4-5 "Peripheral
Checks" on page 4-23.

4-9-16 ASIG ASSY Function Validation Procedure


1.) Turn on the system. R
2.) Check the basic function of system's different modes. Refer to 4-3-4 "System B/M-Mode Checks"
on page 4-7 and Refer to 10-5-2-1 "System Checks" on page 10-8.

Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks 4 - 47


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 4-10
Site Log

Table 4-10 Site Log

Date Service person Problem Comments

4 - 48 Section 4-7 - Keyboard Function Checks


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Chapter 5
Components and Functions (Theory)

Section 5-1
Overview
5-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 5
This chapter explains system concepts, component arrangement, and subsystem function of LOGIQ™
P5 and LOGIQ™ A5 . It also describes the Power Distribution System (PDS) and probes.

Table 5-1 Contents in Chapter 5

Section Description Page Number


5-1 Overview 5-1

5-2 General Information 5-2

5-3 Block Diagram 5-3

5-4 Main Board Detail 5-9

5-5 External I/O (Rear Panel) 5-26

5-6 ARP (Rear Panel) 5-33

5-7 Power Diagrams 5-36

5-8 Cable Connection 5-33

5-9 Filters 5-48


5-10 Service Platform 5-50

5-11 RFS (Service For Request) 5-51

Section 5-1 - Overview 5-1


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 5-2
General Information
LOGIQ™ P5/A5 is a phased and linear array ultrasound imaging scanner. It has provisions for analog
input sources like ECG. A Doppler probe may also be connected and used.

The LOGIQ™ P5 can be used for:

- 2D Gray Scale and 2D Color Flow Imaging


- M-Mode Gray Scale Imaging
- Color M-Mode
- Doppler
- Different combinations of the above modes
- 4D(Optional)
And the LOGIQ™ A5 can be used for:

- 2D Gray Scale Imaging


- M-Mode Gray Scale Imaging
- Doppler
- Different combinations of the above modes
- 2D Color Flow Imaging(Optional)
LOGIQ™ P5 and LOGIQ™ A5 is a digital beamforming system.

Signal flow travels from the Probe Connector Panel to the Front End Electronics, to the Back-End
Processor, and finally displayed on the monitor and peripherals. System configuration is stored on the
hard drive and all necessary software is loaded from the hard drive on power up.

Monitor

Speaker

Keyboard

DVD R Drive

Figure 5-1 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Major Components

5-2 Section 5-1 - Overview


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 5-3
Block Diagram
5-3-1 LOGIQ P5 Block Diagram

A S IG A S S Y A

P3R LY ASSY C L1TR X ASS Y

P ro b e P o rt # 1 CTX ASSY

A S IG C o n n e c t io n
R H V d r iv e r X 1 6 TPG 2
E M
P ro b e P o rt # 2 L U
A X
H V d r iv e r X 1 6 TPG 2
Y

P ro b e P o rt # 3
H V d r iv e r X 1 6 TPG 2
R E L A Y C o n tr o l

H V d r iv e r X 1 6 TPG 2
3 2 c h to A C W D

L1BFC ASSY
P G C fro m S Y S C O N P M
TR BC
fp g a

LN A A D C 1 0 b it s
OQX2
R VCA
SDRAM
LN A A D C 1 0 b it s
fo r
A S IG c o n n e c t io n

R VCA
O Q x2 & TP G 2
LN A A D C 1 0 b it s
R VCA OQX2

LN A A D C 1 0 b it s
R VCA

OQX2

LN A A D C 1 0 b it s OQX2
R VCA

R F D a ta to S Y S C O N P M

F E B U S c o n n e c te d to S Y S C O N P M
B
D C P O W E R fr o m A P S

Figure 5-2 LOGIQ™ P5 System Block Diagram

Section 5-3 - Block Diagram 5-3


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-3-1 LOGIQ P5 Block Diagram (cont’d)

A S IG A S S Y F ro m T R A N S B O X
A

ARP ASSY APS ASSY


D C W D conn LAN C onn
( o p t io n )
C ir c u it B r e a k e r
I/ F & C o n t r o l
fo r A C V id e o In / O u t

L V b lo c k H V b lo c k
A C O u t le t
VG A C onn

D 3 .3 V
U S B conn x 6 D 5 .0 V
S H V P (+ 8 0 )
D 12 V
S H V M (- 8 0 )
S O U N D In / O u t A6 P
T H V H P (0 ~ 6 0 )
ACW D ASSY A6 M
USB HUB T H V H M (- 6 0 ~ 0 )
( o p t io n ) A12 P
S - v id e o In / O u t T H V L P (0 ~ 6 0 )
A12 M
T H V L M (- 6 0 ~ 0 )
FAN9
LP5
Foot SW conn H ost U S B conn

P e r ip h e r a l I/ F B ( F la t c a b le )
SYSC O N PM ASSY

PCIBUS

SDRAM
DSP
(3 2 M x 2 ) V id e o
TM S320C 6415
D e c o rd e r

L C D I/ F

FEBC CPDI
FPGA FPGA
E th e r n e t

S O M C P U m o d u le

In t e l P e n t iu m M C P U A u d io
1GB SDRAM w ith A M P
FEBUS

D o p p le r d a t a f r o m A C W D (o p r io n )
R F d a ta fro m C L 1 T R X a n d

P e r ip h e r a l I/ F A

I/ O c o n t r o l
V G A / A u d io

CHACOM I D E I/ F

4 p o rt
USB

PGC
APS V id e o
G en. SDRAM
C o n tr o l encoder
(6 4 M x 2 )

B B a c k p la n e A ssy C

Figure 5-3 LOGIQ™ P5 System Block Diagram (cont’d)

5-4 Section 5-3 - Block Diagram


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-3-1 LOGIQ P5 Block Diagram (cont’d)

TR AN SBO X
E C G m o d u le
( o p t io n )

A C In le t C o r e F ilt e r

H a r d D is k

A C F ilt e r
M o d u le

100 V ~ 240V
DVD RW

AC TR AN S
To AR P
100 V ~ 240V or 100V ~ 120V

APC ASSY

4 D BO X
( o p t io n )

SPEAKER SPEAKER
ASSY ASSY

LP5 k e y b o rd ASSY LP5 LC D M O N ASSY

LP5 Sub K e y b o rd ASSY


LC D PAN EL

L P 5 M a in k e y b o rd ASSY

A /N K E Y
C o n t r o lle r

TR AC K
BALL F u n c t io n
TG C C TR L
KEYs

F ro m S Y S C O N P M

B a c k p la n e A ssy

Figure 5-4 LOGIQ™ P5 System Block Diagram (cont’d)

Section 5-3 - Block Diagram 5-5


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-3-2 LOGIQ A5 Block Diagram


Differences between LOGIQ P5 and LOGIQ A5 are followings :

- CPU Moduel : LOGIQ P5 is Pentium M and LOGIQ A5 Celeron M


- Transmit pulse driver circuit : LOGIQ 5 is dual puse driver for CFM mode, but LOGIQ A5 is
singl pulse driver. So LOGIQ A5 circuit is more simple and cheap then LOGIQ P5
- Keyboard : LOGIQ A5 keyboard doesn’t have CFM and PDI, CWD button.

A S IG A S S Y

P2RLY ASSY BL1TR X ASSY

P ro b e P o rt # 1 BTX ASSY

R H V d r iv e r X 1 6 TPG 2
E M
P ro b e P o rt # 2 L U
A X
H V d r iv e r X 1 6 TPG 2
Y
P ro b e P o rt # 3

( O p t io n ) H V d r iv e r X 1 6 TPG 2
R E L A Y C o n tro l

H V d r iv e r X 1 6 TPG 2

L1BFC ASSY
P G C fro m S Y S C O N C M
TR BC
fp g a

LN A A D C 1 0 b it s
OQX2
R VCA
SDRAM
LN A A D C 1 0 b it s
fo r
A S IG c o n n e c t io n

R VCA
O Q x2 & TPG 2
LN A A D C 1 0 b it s
R VCA OQX2

LN A A D C 1 0 b it s
R VCA

OQX2

LN A A D C 1 0 b it s OQX2
R VCA

R F D a ta to S Y S C O N C M

F E B U S c o n n e c te d to S Y S C O N C M
B
D C P O W E R fro m A P S

Figure 5-5

5-6 Section 5-3 - Block Diagram


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-3-2 LOGIQ A5 Block Diagram (cont’d)

F ro m T R A N S B O X

ARP ASSY APS ASSY


LAN C onn

C ir c u it B r e a k e r
I/ F & C o n t r o l
fo r A C V id e o In / O u t

L V b lo c k H V b lo c k
A C O u t le t
VG A C onn

D 3 .3 V
U S B conn x 6 D 5 .0 V
S H V P (+ 8 0 )
D 12 V
SH VM (- 80)
S O U N D In / O u t A6 P
T H V H P (0 ~ 6 0 )
A6 M
USB HUB TH VH M ( - 60~0)
A12 P
S - v id e o In / O u t T H V L P (0 ~ 6 0 )
A12 M
TH VLM (- 60~0)
FAN9
LP5
Foot SW conn H ost U S B conn

P e r ip h e r a l I/ F B ( F la t c a b le )
SYSCONC M ASSY

PCIBUS

SDRAM
DSP
(3 2 M x 2 ) V id e o
TM S320C 6415
D e c o rd e r

L C D I/ F

FEBC CPDI
FPGA FPGA
E th e r n e t

S O M C P U m o d u le

In t e l C e le r o n M C P U A u d io
512 M B SD R AM w ith A M P
FEBUS

R F d a ta fr o m B L 1 T R X a n d

P e r ip h e r a l I/ F A

I/ O c o n t r o l
V G A / A u d io

CHACOM ID E I/ F

4 p o rt
USB

PGC
APS V id e o
G en. SDRAM
C o n tr o l encoder
(6 4 M x 2 )

B B a c k p la n e A S S Y C

Figure 5-6 LOGIQ A5 Block Diagram

Section 5-3 - Block Diagram 5-7


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-3-2 LOGIQ A5 Block Diagram (cont’d)

TR AN SBO X
E C G m o d u le
( o p t io n )

A C In le t C o r e F ilt e r

H a r d D is k

A C F i lt e r
M o d u le

1 0 0V ~ 2 4 0 V
DVD RW
AC TR AN S
To ARP
1 0 0V ~ 2 4 0 V o r 1 0 0 V ~ 1 2 0 V

APC ASSY D 1 2 V fro m A P S & A C o n


c o n tro l fro m S Y S C O N C M

4D B O X
( o p t io n )

SPEAKER SPEAKER
ASSY ASSY fro m A P S

N E S T F A NA s s y

LA5 k e y b o rd ASSY LA5 LC D M O N ASSY

L A 5 S u b K e y b o rd A S S Y
LCD PANEL

L A 5 M a in k e y b o r d A S S Y
A /N K E Y
C o n t r o lle r

TRACK
BALL F u n c t io n
TG C C TR L
KEYs

F ro m S Y S C O N C M

P e r ip h e r a l I/ F A BAC KPLAN E ASSY


C

Figure 5-7 LOGIQ A5 Block Diagram

5-8 Section 5-3 - Block Diagram


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 5-4
Main Board Detail

Digital Data and Power


TX and RX Signals
P3RLY ASSY

Front End ASIG ASSY CL1TRX ASSY

BACKPLANE ASSY
ACWD ASSY (option)
USB, Audio I/O, Video I/O etc.

SYSCONPM ASSY
Back End

APS ASSY

ARP ASSY 4 D BOX ASSY


(Option)

Figure 5-8 LOGIQ P5 Main board Structure

Digital Data and Power


TX and RX Signals

P2RLY ASSY
ASIG ASSY

Front End BL1TRX ASSY


BACKPLANE ASSY
USB, Audio I/O, Video I/O etc.

SYSCONCM ASSY
Back End

APS ASSY

ARP ASSY 4D BOX ASSY


(Option)

Figure 5-9 LOGIQ A5 Main board Structure

The Front End generates the strong burst transmitted by the probes as ultrasound into the body. It also
receives weak ultrasound echoes from blood cells and body structure, amplifies these signals and
converts them to an digital signal.

The digital representation of this signal is presented to the Mid Processor section.

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5-9


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

• P3RLY (Relay) : This P3RLY is for LOQIG P5 or LOGIQ A5 with 3port upgrade kit. P3RLY Assy
contains 3 connectors for probe interface and arrays of relays for switchable connection. High
voltage multiplexer provide connection between 128 signal of probe and selectable 64 channels
transmit/receive signals.
• P2RLY(Relay) : This P2RLY is for LOGIQ A5. P2RLY Assy contains 2 connectors for probe
interface and arrays of relays for switchable connection. High voltage multiplexer provide
connection between 128 signal of probe and selectable 64 channels transmit/receive signals
• CL1TRX (Color single acquisition Tx and Rx) : This board is for LOGIQ P5 and LOGIQ A5 with Color
upgrade. This consists of two main board, L1BFC(Single acquisition Beam Forming Control) and
CTX(Color TX) ASSY. L1BFC has transmit/receiving switch to isolate rx signal circuit from transmit
pulse. The preamplifier on L1BFC amplifies 64 small echo signals. The amplified receiving signals
are converted to digital and sent to the delayed summing block. CTX board has 64 channel
Transmit pulse generator, bipolar pulse drivers and delay controller.
• SYSCONPM (System Control board with Pentium M module): SYSCONPM is for LOGIQ P5 or
LOGIQ A5 with color upgrade kit. SYSCONPM controls scan operation and transfer the scan
parameters to other boards like P3RLY, CL1TRX, ACWD(option). Proper signal processing for
tissue and Doppler are done in SYSCONPM.
• SYSCONCM (System Control board with Celeron M module): SYSCONCM is for LOGIQ A5.
SYSCONPM controls scan operation and transfer the scan parameters to other boards like P2RLY,
BL1TRX. Proper signal processing for tissue and Doppler are done in SYSCONCM.
• APS(Advanced Power Supply) : Includes Low voltage power and High voltage power in one
module. It generates 3.3V, 5V, and 12V for digital parts and 6V, -6V, 12A, -12V for analog parts.
Additionally, It generate THV(Transmit High Voltage) and SHV(Static High Voltage) for transmit
pulse driver and High voltage MUX.
• ASIG(Signal) : Transfers the TX pulse signals from CL1TRX(BL1TRX) to the probe port on
P3RLY(P2RLY). Receives echo signals from P3RLY(P2RLY) are transfer to CL1TRX(BL1TRX)
through this ASIG. For ACWD, the pre-amplified received signals go to the ACWD though ASIG.

5-4-1 P3RLY and P2RLY

RELAY SHV
SHV RELAY
PORT A RELAY
128 PORT A
128
To CL1TRX
128 HV MUX
To CL1TRX 128 64
PORT B HV MUX PORT B
128 128 64 128

PORT C
128

Control Control Temperature Control Control


Circuit FPGA Sensor Circuit FPGA

Probe ID Interface Probe ID Interface

FEBUS FEBUS

Figure 5-10 P3RLY & P2RLY Block Diagram

P3RLY ASSY contains of 3 probe connectors and provides switchable connection between probes and
64ch transmitters/receivers. P2RLY contains 2 probe connector

The main function of P3RLY ASSY and P2RLY ASSY is as follows.

5 - 10 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

- 3-to-1 selectors with three probe ports for P3RLY board.


- 2 to 1 selector with two probe ports for P2RLY board
- Interface with FEBUS (control bus)
- Supply/Cut control and failure detection of supply voltage for Mux circuit in a Probe.
- Device: Mechanical Relay.

5-4-1-1 Interface to Probe


• Probe Status detection
- Detects whether or not a probe is connected.(POPEN)
- Detects ID code of a connected probe.(PCODE)
• Mux Interface
- Transfers control data of Mux to a probe.(CONSYS,CONSTA)
- Enables/Disables control of data.
- Detects whether Mux data setting is finished or not.
• Power Supply for Mux
- Supply/Cut control:
+5V and +12V on a connector are supplied while a probe is connected to the connector.

+/-SHV are supplied only while a probe is selected.

• LED Blinking
- The LED in a probe blinks when the probe is selected.

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 11


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-4-2 CL1TRX and BL1TRX

5-4-2-1 Overview
CL1TRX have two PWAs. Both are CTX PWA and L1BFC PWA. CTX generates the TX pulse and
L1BFC receives the echo signal to amplify it and convert the amplified echo signal into digital signal.
These RF digital signals delayed and summed by beam-forming in OQx2 ASICs.

BL1TRX have aldso two PWAs, BTX PWA and L1BFC PWA. The difference between BTX and CTX is
trasntmit pulse firver circuit. BTX have single pulse driver per each channel, but the CTX have dual
pulse dirver circuit per each channel for high performance in B/CFM mode

The CL1TRX ASSY or BL1TRX ASSY is located in the Nest box

5-4-2-2 Limiter in CL1TRX and BL1TRX

+V bias
R

To P3RLY
board
R

From
TX _Block To RX_Block

Coupling
Diode
Isolation
Diode

-V bias

Figure 5-11 LMT Block Diagram

The main functions are as follows.

• 64ch transmit/receiving switches protect a Pre-amp from a high voltage transmit pulse

5 - 12 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-4-2-3 Preamp in CL1TRX/BL1TRX

ch0
LNA A D C 1 0 b it s
VCA
ch1
LNA A D C 1 0 b it s
VCA
ch2
LNA A D C 1 0 b it s
VCA
ch3
LNA A D C 1 0 b it s
VCA

ch63
LNA A D C 1 0 b it s
VCA

Figure 5-12 Pre Amp Block Diagram For a Channel

The Pre-Amplifier receives and amplifies each 64 echo signals. Then, all 64 echo signals (from 0 to
63ch) are outputted to the Analog to Digital converter to delay and sum. Following 32 echo signals (from
32 to 63ch) are simultaneously outputted to the ACWD ASSY via the ASIG ASSY.

The preamp module have main three blocks: Pre-amp and Gain Control and Mode control block.

The preamp module amplifies the echo signals. The mode control block selects a maximum gain code
via dedicated control signals from SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM). The analog signal provided by Gain
Control block gives total amplified gain. The block diagram above of the preamp module for a received
signal is given. Actually, there are 64 channels equivalent to figure above for a preamp module.

The Pre-amp block consists of Low Noise Amplifier (LNA) and Variable Gain Amplifier (VGA). A

received signal is amplified by LNA (fixed gain), then amplified by VGA (variable gain).

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 13


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-4-2-4 Delayed Sum Module

C l1 T R X

A D C 1 0 b it s O Q X2
SDRAM
A D C 1 0 b it s fo r
O Q x2 & T P G 2
A D C 1 0 b it s
O Q X2
A D C 1 0 b it s
F
E
B
O Q X2 U
S

A D C 1 0 b it s O Q X2
RF_SUM

BACKPLANE ASSY

Figure 5-13 DELAYED SUM Block Diagram

The Delayed Sum is the receive beam former and consist of 4 OQx2 ASICs. Each OQx2 ASIC has 16
receiving channels. The each digital beamforming output data of the OQx2 transferred to the next OQx2
and the output of final OQx2 transferred to the SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM)to make it into image data
through some digital signal processing.

Delay control data for receive beam forming are contained in SDRAM. Typically only 1 selected probe
data are saved in SDRAM. If new probe is connected, additional probe data will be downloaded from
HDD to SDRAM.

Main items are

• TRBC FPGA : Provide interfaces with SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM)through FE Bus. This fpga control
all OQx2 asic for receive beamforming. All of parameter information for ASIC operation are loaded
into OQX2 ASIC from SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) through this fpga.
• OQX2 :Digital receive beamforming ASIC. Each OQX2 have capability of 16 channel receiving data
inputs. Each input data can be 12 bits. Operation clock is 40 MHz. 4 OQX2 ASICs are used in a
Delayed Sum module and each OQX2 summed output are cascaded to next OQX2 ASIC. So, the
last summed output of the last OQX2 are transferred to SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) to make a
meaningful image data. The receive beamforming control logic in OQX2 ASIC need delay
information data for each channel's control logic. This delay information data are downloaded into
ASIC from SDRAM by TRBC fpga.
• SDRAM(TD and RD Memory) : SDRAM keeps the receive delay data for OQX2 ASIC. During scan
time, these data are downloaded into OQX2 ASIC by TRBC fpga. Memory capacity is 32Mbytes for
a probe.

5 - 14 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-4-2-5 Transmit Pulse Generation Block

TPG2 64ch
T X s ig n a l
fo r H V L
T X D rive r_ H V L
(C T X O n ly)

P ro b e In te rfa c e B o a rd
S e le c tio n B u ffe r
TPG2

TPG2 64ch
T X s ig n a l
fo r H V H
T X D rive r_ H V H

TPG2

TPG2 B u ffe r e n a b le s ig n a l
C o n tro l S ig n a l to s e le c t T X D rive r

Figure 5-14 Tx pulse Generation Block Diagram

The CTX in CL1TRX generate bipolar transmit pulse and have dual driver for each scan mode, for
example, low voltage driver for PWD or CFM and high voltage for B. This board has 64 channels
transmit signal drivers, Transmit Pulse Generator ASIC, control FPGA and so on. Transmit pulse are
generated by TPG2 ASIC. Each TPG2 ASIC makes 16 channels signals, so total 4 ASIC are used in
CTX in CL1TRX. All of control informations for pulse generation, pulse width, time delay of each channel
are come from SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) in real time via Backplane. The control FPGA, TRBC FPGA
provide interface between SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) and TPG2 ASICs and control operation
condition of CTX in CL1TRX Main items are

• TPG2 ASIC: A TPG2 ASIC can generate 16 channels logic level transmit pulse signal. This ASIC
use 2 phase 40MHz clocks for transmit delay control and pulse generation. 40Mhz operation clocks
are come from L1SYSCON assy via Backplane.
• Transmit Pulse Driver : TPG2 ASIC generated logic level signal for transmit pulse. So this signal
need to be expanded to high voltage signal. Driver circuit make logic level signal to high voltage
level signal.
• THV Switch : LOGIQ™ P5 system use dual transmit high voltage for transmit driver because B
mode and CFM mode use different voltage level of transmit pulse. So in duplex of triplex mode, B/
CFM or B/DOP, Low THV and High THV are switched in CTX in CL1TRX in real time.
• TRBC FPGA : This FPGA is located on L1BFC board interfacing with SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM)
and updating the TPG data in real time.

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 15


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-4-3 SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM)

Figure 5-15 SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) Block Diagram

5-4-3-1 Overview
SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) ASSY includes Mid processor and Back End Processor. DSP generate the
scan control data and the FEBC FPGA adjust the time and manipulate the FEBUS to control Front End
boards and APS. CPDI transfer the Image or Doppler data to the Image Ring buffer through DSP. Finally
the data goes to the SOM module to make displaying image or sound.

5-4-3-2 SYSTEM ON MODULE(SOM)


The SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) Assy has System On Module PC(SOM) and PWA which is able to dock
SOM. In LOGIQ™ P5 system and LOGIQ™ P5 system, PWA is used the same one. But the System
On Module, which computes received Scan data, and interfaces the external peripheral devices (ex. B/
W printer, Digital Video Recorder etc) are divided high grade for LOGIQ™ P5 and low grade for LOGIQ
A5 by it's CPU performance.

5-4-3-3 PERIPHERAL BLOCK


• IDE Interface :
SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) Assy has SATA bus for HDD and PATA bus for DVD-R drive interface.

- Primary Master SATA: HDD


- Secondary Master PATA: DVD-R Drive
• DISPLAY (VGA, DVI, TV input) BLOCK
Basically SOM support 2 kinds of display output. One is LVDS level for Plat panel display, and other is
analog RGB for CRT monitor.

To obtain advanced and stable quality image, SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) Assy convert LVDS signal to
Digital Video Interface(DVI) and transport TMDS signal to main display of system.

5 - 16 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-4-3-3 PERIPHERAL BLOCK (cont’d)


• ETHERNET BLOCK
SOM on the SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) has one integrated Ethernet port : Intel 82562 10/100 Mbps
Fast Ethernet controller

• SOM supply four USB 1.1/2.0 port. Each USB ports are used for the keyboard, BW digital printer,
USB prot for usb memory stick, etc.
• VCR INPUT
For Video play back, SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) has Video Decoder device. It support NTSC/ PAL
mode both. It transfers encoded data to SOM through PCI bus.

- Supports capture resolutions up to 768x576(Full PAL mode)


- CCIR 656 Interface
- S-Video & composite input interface

5-4-3-4 FPGA BLOCK


• FEBC FPGA(FEBUS Control):
A major function of FEBC is that generate FEBUS to control scan sequence, access register on the each
other front end assy, and interface to DSP through EMIFB bus. Other roles are below

- Generates a stable PGC curve for getting better image quality.


- Gathers the diagnostic information: LV, HV, Probe temperature, Nest temperature.
- Supervises the system safety
- Manages the each ASSY information with IIC Bus: SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM), CL1TRX,
P3RLY(P2RL), ACWD(option) and Probes
- Controls HV Voltage output level: Transfer the voltage reference data from DSP to APS via
IIC interface.
• CPDI FPGA(CHACOM Processing Data Interface):
The major function of CPDI is that transfer mid processed data from CHACOM to DSP local process.
CPDI has 2EA 8x1024 Dual port as one scan line image data buffer. Address sequencer indicates to
DSP that buffered data is full one scan line. then DSP can transfer a scan line data to one's SDRAM.
For debugging, CPDI generate test pattern image data. It will be able to check CHACOM run normally.

5-4-3-5 CLOCK DISTRIBUTION BLOCK


Each operation clock is divided from 160MHz. Also ECL logic is used to remove clock skew for all clock
distribution.

Required clocks is following:

• 40MHz In-phase and 40MHz Quad-phase for ACWD, CL1TRX assy


• 40MHz In-phase for P3RLY assy

5-4-3-6 POWER CONTROL BLOCK


ON/OFF power sequence control is needed to prevent system to boot up abnormally, and protect to
loose important diagnostic information of patient from unexpected power failure.

• Live power
: Whenever main AC power is supplied, Microprocessor on the SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) must live
always by live power supplied by APS Assy.

• System boot-up sequence

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 17


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-4-3-6 POWER CONTROL BLOCK (cont’d)


Peripheral power -> LV power -> SOM(Main PC) on the SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM).

• Software shut down sequence


Because not ATX power, Main Operation System(Windows XP) have to inform about time to shutdown
to DSP by interrupt. So DSP can allow FPGA to assert shutdown signal to MICOM.

• Abnormal shut down sequence


SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) can force to shutdown system abnormally by pressing power button during
15 second. But live power for MICOM has to alive.

5-4-3-7 CHACOM BLOCK


This ASIC have two main function. One is the CHAF, which have functions of coded excitation decorder
and 2nd harmonic filter. The other is COMSO, which has functions of detector, B/M mode edge
enhance, Log compression, and dynamic range control.

5-4-3-8 PGC and TEST SIGNAL GENERATION BLOCK


SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) generate Power Gain Control signal in order to get better quality scan
image from CL1TRX. This signal goes into a preamp on the CL1TRX(BL1TRX) Assy . Additionally,
SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) generate test signal used to test analog path of CL1TRX(BL1TRX) Assy.
These signals are converted to analog from 8bit digital data from FEBC FPGA , and DSP could update
digital PGC and Test data table whenever needed.

5 - 18 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-4-4 SOM Module


The SOM means System On Module which integrates the PC motherboard and CPU and memory and
periheral device for BEP(Back End Process)functionality into a small size PWA. Therare are 2 knids of
SOM module for LOGIQ P5 and LOGIQ A5. One is PM SOM Assy with high performance Pentium M
CPU and the other is CM SOM Assy with lower performance Celeron M CPU.

PM SOM PWA include moble Pentium M CPU and 915GM chipset and 1G DDR2 memory on small size
form factor PCB(3.75 inch x 4.5 inch). CM SOM PWA include mobile Celeron M CPU 915GM chipset
and 512MB DDR2 memory

This SOM module is attached on the SYSCON PWA. So SYSCONPM Assy include PM SOM module
and SYSCONCM Assy include CM SOM module

Figure 5-16 PM SOM and CM SOM Block Diagram

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 19


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-4-4-1 PM SOM and CM SOM


The difference on both module is BIOS boot screen and label on the module. The label include fru
number

• PM SOM FRU number is 5178410 and CM SOM FRU number is 5178834

Figure 5-17 Different Label on PM SOM and CM SOM

• BIOS diaply screen are different. The BIOS boot screen come up when power on the system. The
number on the screen is FRU number of each SOM assy. The system with PM SOM assy show
5178410 and thesystem with CM SOM assy shows 5178834. Refer Figure 5-18 on page 5-20

Figure 5-18 BIOS Boot Screen of PM SOM and CM SOM

5 - 20 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-4-4-2 BIOS Content


• To login to Bios mode, press “Del” key in AN keyboard when bios boot screen comes up after
system power on
• The password for bios login is “arirang"
• PM SOM and CM SOM both has same BIOS contents. Only difference is CPU description in main
bios screen and CPU configuration menu in advanced menu
• PM SOM BIOS screen shows the Pentium M CPU configuration. But the CM SOM BIOS screen
shows the Celeron M CPU configuration

BIOS SET UP UTILITY BIOS SET UP UTILITY


Main Advanced Boot Security Power Exit Main Advanced Boot Security Power Exit
System Time [HH:MM:SS] System Time [HH:MM:SS]
System Date [xxx MM:DD:YYYY] System Date [xxx MM:DD:YYYY]
BIOS ID : P915RXXX BIOS ID : P915RXXX
OEM Version : GEUKXXXX OEM Version : GEUKXXXX
Processor : Intel® Pentium® M Processor 1.8 Processor : Intel® Celeron® M Processor 1.5
CPU Frequency : 1800MHz CPU Frequency : 150MHz
System Memory : 1016MB System Memory : 508MB
Board Information Board Information
Product Revision : x.x Product Revision : x.x
Serical Number : xxxxx Serical Number : xxxxx
BC Firmware Rev : xxx BC Firmware Rev : xxx
Boot Counter : xxx Boot Counter : xxx
Running Time : xxxh Running Time : xxxh

Figure 5-19 Main BIOS Screen of PM SOM and CM SOM

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 21


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

BIOS SET UP UTILITY BIOS SET UP UTILITY


Advanced Advanced
ACPI Settings Advanced PCI/PnP Settings

ACPI Aware O/S [Yes] Plug & Play OS [No]


ACPI 2.0 Feature [No] PCI Latency Timer [64]
ACPI APIC Support [Enabled] Allocate IRQ to PCI VGA [Yes]
Suspend Mode [S1 (POS)] Allocate IRQ to SMBUS HC [Yes]
USB Device Wakeup from S3/S4 [Disabled]
Active Cooling Trip Point [Disabled] PCI IRQ Resource Exclusion
Passive Cooling Trip Point [90℃]
Critical Trip Point [110] PCI Interrupt Routing
Watchdog ACPI Event [Shutdown]
GPE1 Function [No Function]
GPE2 Function [No Function]

BIOS SET UP UTILITY BIOS SET UP UTILITY


Advanced Advanced
Graphics Configuration Configure advanced CPU settings
Module Version : xxx
Primary Video Device [Internal VGA]
Internal VGA Mode Select [Enabled, 8MB] Manufacturer : Intel
Aperture Size Select [256MB] Brand String : Intel® Pentium® M Processor 1.8
DVMT Mode Select [DVMT Mode] Frequency : 1.80GHz
DVMT/FIXED Memory [128MB] FSB Speed : 400MHz
Boot Display Device [CRT + LFP]
Boot Display Preference [LEP SDVO-B SDVO-C] Cache L1 : 32KB
Local Flat Type [Customized EDID] Cache L2 : 2048KB
Local Flat Type Scaling [Expand Text & Grap]
SDVO Port B Device [None] Intel® Speedstep™ tech [Automatic]
SDVO Port C Device [None] Max. CPU Frequency [1800Mhz]
Backlight Control [100%]
TV Standard [VBIOS-Default]

BIOS SET UP UTILITY BIOS SET UP UTILITY


Advanced Advanced
Advanced Chipset Settings I/O Interface Configuration
Memory Hole [Disabled]
Onboard Audio Controller [AC97]
IOAPC [Enabled] Onboard Ethernet Controller [Enabled]
APIC ACPI SCI IRQ [Disabled] Onboard Floppy Controller [Disabled]
C4 on C3 [Disabled] Floppy A [Disabled]
DMI Power Management [Disabled] Serial Port 1 Configuration [Disabled]
Serial Port 2 Configuration [Disabled]
PCI Express Configuration Parallel Port Address [Disabled]
PCI Express Port 1 [Disabled]
PCI Express Port 2 [Disabled]
PCI Express Port 3 [Disabled]
PCI Express Port 4 [Disabled]
VC1 for Azlia & Root Ports [Disabled]

Figure 5-20 Advanced menu in BIOS

5 - 22 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

BIOS SET UP UTILITY BIOS SET UP UTILITY


Advanced Advanced
IDE Configuration USB Configuration
ATA/IDE Configuration [Compatible] USB Devices Enabled :
Legacy IDE Channels [SATA Pri, PATA Sec] 1 Keyboard
Primary IDE Master [Hard Disk] USB Functions [6 USB ports]
Primary IDE Slave [Not Detected] USB 2.0 Controller [Enabled]
Secondary IDE Master [ATAPI CDROM] Legacy USB Support [Enabled]
Secondary IDE Slave [Not Detected] USB Keyboard Legacy Support [Enabled]
Third IDE Master [Not Detected] USB Mouse Legacy Support [Enabled]
Third IDE Slave [Not Detected] USB Storage Device Support [Disabled]
Fourth IDE Master [Not Detected] Port 64/60 Emulation [Disabled]
Fourth IDE Slave [Not Detected] USB 2.0 Controller Mode [HiSpeed]
Hard Disk Write Protect [Disabled] BIOS EHCI Hand-off [Enabled]
IDE Defect Time Out (Sec) [35] USB Beep Message [Enabled]
ATA(PI) 80Pin Cable Detection [Host & Device] USB Stick Default Emulation [Hard Disk]
USB Mass Storage Reset Delay [20 sec]

BIOS SET UP UTILITY BIOS SET UP UTILITY


Advanced Advanced
Keyboard/Mouse Configuration Configure Remote Access type and parameters
Boot up Num-Lock [On] Remote Access [Disabled]
Typematic Rate [Fast] Serial Port BIOS Update [Disabled]
PS/2 Mouse Support [Auto]

BIOS SET UP UTILITY BIOS SET UP UTILITY


Advanced Advanced
Hardware Health Configuration Configure Watchdog Parameters
H/W Health Function [Enabled] POST Watchdog [Disabled]
Hardware Health Event Monitoring
Board Temperature : xx/xxx Runtime Watchdog [Disabled]
CPU Temperature : xx/xxx

VcoreA : 1.3xxV
VcoreB : 1.0xxV
+3.3 In : 3.3xxV
+5 VIn : 4.8 ~ 5V
Vbat : 3.3xxV

Figure 5-21 Advanced Menu in BIOS(cont’d)

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 23


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

BIOS SET UP UTILITY


Main Advanced Boot Security Power Exit
Boot Device Priority
Boot Priority Selection [Type Based]

1ST Boot Device [Secondary Master]


2nd Boot Device [Primary Master]
3rd Boot Device [Disabled]
4th Boot Device [Disabled]
5th Boot Device [Disabled]
6th Boot Device [Disabled]
7th Boot Device [Disabled]
8th Boot Device [Disabled]

Boot Settings Configuration


Quick Boot [Enabled]
Quiet Boot [Enabled]
Boot Display [Clear]
Automatic Boot List Retry [Disabled]
AddOn ROM Display Mode [Keep Current]
Halt On Error [Disabled]
Ht "Del" Message Display [Disabled]
Interrupt 19 Capture [Disabled]
PXE Boot to LAN [Disabled]
Power Loss Control [Remain off]

Figure 5-22 Boot menu in BIOS

BIOS SET UP UTILITY


Main Advanced Boot Security Power Exit

Security Seetings
Supervisor Password : Installed
User Password : not Installed
Change Supervisor Password
User Access Level [No Access]
Change User Password
Password Check [Setup]
Boot Sector Virus Protection [Disabled]
Hard Disk Security
Hard Disk Security User Passwords
Hard Disk Security Master Passwords
BIOS Update & Write Protection [Disabled]
END-KEY Loads CMOS Default [Yes]

Figure 5-23 Security Menu in BIOS

5 - 24 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

BIOS SET UP UTILITY


Main Advanced Boot Security Power Exit

Configure power management and control


Power management/APM [Enabled]
Suspend Time Out [Disabled]
Video power Down Mode [Disabled]
Hard Disk Power Down Mode [Disabled]
Keyboard & PS/2 Mouse [Monitor]
FDC/LPT/COM Ports [Monitor]
Primary Master IDE [Monitor]
Primary Slave IDE [Monitor]
Secondary Master IDE [Monitor]
Secondary Slave IDE [Monitor]
Resume On Ring [Disabled]
Resume On PME# [Disabled]
Resume On RTC Alarm [Disabled]
Power Button Mode [On/Off]

Figure 5-24 Power Menu in BIOS

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 25


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 5-5
Top Console
5-5-1 Keyboard

M a in K e y b o a r d
RAM EEPROM
(3 2 K ) (3 2 K )
A /N K ey
M a t r ix

T r a c k B a ll
USB

USB C PLD
M ic r o c o n t r o lle r
M ode Key
POW ER

E n c o d e rs

T G C S lid e

M IC O M
L ig h t in g L E D

S u b k e y b o a rd
4 A rro w
POW ER E n c o d e rs K eys
B u tto n

Figure 5-25 Keyboard Block Diagram

LOGIQ P5 and LOGIQ A5 Keyboard assy consist of 2 assy, one is main keyboard assy and the other
is sub keyboard assy.

• Main keyboard : Has alpha numeric key, Trackball, Encoders, Mode key, TGC controller and
lighting components.
• Sub keyboard: Have five encoder with push function and 4 arrow keys. These keys are used for
operation menu selection normally.
• Difference between LOGIQ P5 keyboard and LOGIQ A5 keyboard is that the LOGIQ A5 keyboard
does’n have the CFM key, CWD key, PDI key since the LOGIQ A5 doesn’t support CFM,CWD,PDI
mode. But if the LOGIQ A5 has been upgrade with Color Upgrade kit, LOGIQ A5 should have same
keyboard as LOGIQ P5.

5 - 26 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-5-1-1 KEYBOARD Signal I/O


Main keyboard assy have two main external I/O connectors. One is for USB connection to scan system
for main control signal interface, the other is for 5V power supply and momentary switch of scan system
with hard drive operation indicator.

(a)Sub keyboard

CON1

USB

(b)Main Keyboard

Figure 5-26 Main Keyboardand Sub Keyboardconnection to system

Table 5-1 CON1 Connector Signal I/O

Pin Nember Pin Name Signal Path


1 HDD- L1SYSCON > Backplane > Main Keyboard> Sub Keyboard

2 HDD+ L1SYSCON > Backplane > Main Keyboard> Sub Keyboard

3 Mementary S/W L1SYSCON > Backplane > Main Keyboard> Sub Keyboard

4 GND

10 GND

11 GND
12 GND

13 KBD PWR APS > Backplane > Mani Keyboard > Sub Keyboard

14 KBD PWR APS > Backplane > Main Keyboard> Sub Keyboard

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 27


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-5-2 LOGIQ P5 Monitor and LOGIQ A5 Monitor


LOGIQ P5 and LOGIQ A5 system has 15 inch LCD monitor with DVI-I interface. Monitor have also task
lamp to light up the A/N key on keyboard assy.

Both monitor of LOGIQ P5 and LOGIQ A5 have completely same function and same hardware
assembly. Difference is front bezel color. LOGIQ P5 bezel color is dar steel bule, and LOGIQ A5 bezel
color is white gray color.

Figure 5-27 LOGIQ™ P5 Monitor and LOGIQ A5 Monitor

5-5-2-1 MONITOR Signal I/O


Monitor assy has two main I/O connectors, One is for DVI-I connection to scan system to display the
scan image, the other is for 110V/220V power supply.

PWR DVI

Figure 5-28 LCDMON connection in system


5 - 28 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-5-2-2 LCDMON control button function


LCDMON assy has four control buttons; Lamp Power button, Left button, Menu button, Right button.

1 2 3 4

Figure 5-29 LCDMON control buttons

Table 5-2 main functions of control key buttons

No Name Main Functions


1 LAMP POWER Turns ON/OFF the Task Lamp in loacted bottom of LCDMON

- Moves the highlight icon UP to the function that wants


2 LEFT
- Increases the adjustment of the selected function

- When the OSD menu is off, press once


: Performs "Contrast-adjustment" function
- When the OSD menu is off, press twice
: Performs "Brightness-adjustment" function
- When the OSD menu is off, press thee times
3 MENU
: Performs "Dim-Brightness-adjustment" function
- When the OSD menu is off, press more than 5 seconds
: Performs "OSD-adjustment" function
- When the OSD menu is on
: Selects the function that user wants

- Moves the highlight icon Down to the function that wants


4 RIGHT
- Decreases the adjustment of the selected function

Push "Menu" button to select the mode between Contrast, Brightness, and Dim Brightness mode. Then
hold down "Left" and "Right" button until the value you want is set. The default values are 80% for the
contrast, 80% for the Brightness, and 50% for the Dim-Brightness.

Figure 5-30 Contrast, Brightness and Dim-Brightness adjustment


Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 29
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 5-6
ARP (Rear Panel)
The LOGIQ™ P5 and LOGIQ™ A5 system has the I/O interfaces for peripherals in rear panel. ARP
(Arirang Rear Panel) assy has connectors for peripheral. Composite in/out and S-VHS in/out is for the
analog video interface for recording and playback of the VCR or DVD recorder. Audio in/out is for audio
interface for audio recording and audio playback of the VCR or DVD recorder. The ARP assy also has
a USB hub device for expending the USB ports which provide additional USB ports. The analog VGA
signal also provide display interface for external VGA monitor .

Figure 5-31 AEXP Block Diagram

5 - 30 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-6-1 Input/Output Signals for peripheral


Table 5-3 Input and Output signals for peripherals

Signal Name Description Connection from/via/to


Ethernet Standard TCP/IP Ethernet Syscon -> ARP -> 7P LAN Connector

Syscon -> ARP -> LG Connector -> 15P DSUB


External VGA VGA signal output for external VGA monitor
Connector

Foot Switch is mechanical switch that


Foot Switch connect a signal to ground Foot Switch connector -> ARP(USB HUB)

Composite out for DVD Recorder Compositer video signal output for DVDR Syscon -> ARP -> BNC Connector

Composite in for DVD Recorder Compositer input from DVDR BNC Connector -> ARP -> Syscon

S-VHS out for DVD Recorder S-VHS output signal for DVDR Recording Syscon -> ARP -> S-VHS Connector

S-VHS in for DVD Recorder S-VHS input signal for DVDR playback S-VHS Connector -> ARP -> Syscon

Audio out L/R for DVD Recorder Stereo audio output for DVDR Recording Syscon -> ARP -> RCA Jack

Stereo audio input from DVDR for DVDR


Audio In L/R for DVD Recorder RCA Jack -> ARP -> Syscon
playback

USB Port for BW Printer Syscon -> Backplane -> USB Connector(dual
USB Port for BW Printer
R_A type) -> Front/BW Printer

ARP(USB HUB) -> USB Connector(R_A type)


USB Port for ECG USB Port for ECG
-> ECG

ARP(USB HUB) -> USB Connector(R_B type)


USB Port for 4D USB Port for 4D
-> 4D

USB Port for Color Printer ARP(USB HUB) -> USB Connector(S_A type) -
USB Port for Digital Color Printer
> Color Printer

ARP(USB HUB) -> USB Connector(S_A type) -


USB Port for DMC USB Port for DMC
> DMC

ARP(USB HUB) -> USB Connector(S_A type) -


USB Port for USB Device USB Port for USB Device
> USB Device

USB Port for remote control of VCR/DVD ARP(USB HUB) -> USB Connector(S_A type) -
USB Port for Remote
Recorder > VCR

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 31


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 5-7
Power Diagrams
5-7-1 Overview
The AC Power assy's main tasks are to supply powers the various internal subsystems and to isolate
electrically the scanner from the on site Mains Power System. The voltage to peripherals can be
confederated to either 110 VAC or 220 VAC. Internal circuit for AC power have the free voltage
capability basically but, we should separate the group using of low voltage (100V~127V), high voltage
(200V~240V), and mixed voltage (100V~120V for peripheral and 200V ~ 240V for system).

5-7-2 TRANSBOX(AC Power)

Figure 5-32 AC Power Assy Block Diagram

The mains cord has plugs in one side end. A male plug connects to the mains outlet on site. The mains
voltage is routed to the Main Circuit Breaker, located on the rear side of the system. The Main Circuit
Breaker is of the auto fuse type, if for some reason the current grows to high, the switch will
automatically break the power. From the Main Circuit Breaker, the AC power is routed via the Mains
Transformer and the Inrush Current Limiter to internal outlet connector for AC distribution.

The Transformer is the galvanic barrier between the rest of the scanner and the on site AC Mains. Input
voltage to the transformer can be either 220 VAC or 110 VAC. AC output of transformer is supplied to
the APS through Inrush Current Limiter without additional control. AC output of transformer for
LCDMON, 4D BOX(option), and peripheral controlled by the L1SYSCON according to the On/Off status
of the system.

5 - 32 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-7-3 APS(LV Power & HV Power)


DC Powers are supplied by APS and source of all assys in nest and nest fan, etc. To turn on the APS,
the live power is needed as a standby power. This live power is generated from APS when the APS
receive the AC input from the TRANSBOX. When the LP(live power) is supplied to the L1SYSCON and
system momentary switch is pushed on, L1SYSCON make the LV_ON signal level into low to turn on
the APS. After turning on the APS, the ACPC in TRANSBOX assy change the relay path on itself to
supply stable AC power by using of D12V from APS.

DC Output Capacity:

• +D5VLP, 0.42A rms


• +D5V, 6.5A rms
• +D3.3V, 6.48A rms
• +D12V, 3.36A rms
• +D12VFAN, 0.94A rms
• +A6V, 7.92A rms
• -A6V, 1.52A rms
• +A12V, 1.26A rms
• -A12V, 0.6A rms

APS supplies High Voltage power to activate high voltage transmit pulse and static supply bias voltage
on high voltage mux and probe. When L1SYSCON makes the HV_STOP signal to low, the APS
generates the HV module in APS. The SHV supplies +/-80V to the system constantly and the THVH and
THVL supplies 0~+/- 60V individually.

SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) control the level of THVH and THVL through the IIC interface.

HV Output Capacity:

• +SHV, +80V, 0.05A rms


• - SHV, -80V, 0.05A rms
• +THVH, 0V~+60V, 0.5A rms
• - THVH, -60V~0V, 0.5A rms
• +THVL, 0V~+60V, 0.5A rms
• - THVL, -60V~0V, 0.5A rms

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 33


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-7-4 AC Power Outlet for Peripheral


The ARP CONN ASSY and ARP CONN 220V ASSY are the ARP assemblies which interconnect
external signal and power with the LOGIQ™ P5 system. Both of the assemblies are the same except
the circuit breaker's current ratings depending on voltage of the system power source (See 'Safety'
described below).

5-7-4-1 Safety
• Circuit Breaker

Table 5-4 Circuit Breaker Specification

Power Voltage Peripheral Current


Assembly Trip Time Reset Time
Rating (V) Rating (A)

1 hour max. @
ARP CONN 110 4.0 110 second
5.4A, 25 degreeC

1hour max. @
ARP CONN 220V 220 2.0 180 second
3.5A, 25 degreeC

• Electrical Isolation
The ARP's Insite interface is electrically isolated from the system's internal circuit. The isolator's
dielectric strength should be 500VAC RMS or higher within 1 minute (in compliance with IEC60601-1-1).

5 - 34 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 5-8
Cable Connection
5-8-1 Overview
The cable connection can be separated to two group, internal harness and external cable connection
for peripheral equipment.

5-8-2 Internal Cable

Figure 5-33 Cable Connection - Internal

The black box with white character is the label of the connector and the adjacent same label connector
means that the two connectors should be connected each other. The dotted line means optional
connection when the customer uses that option.

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 35


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-8-3 Peripherals and Cable connection


A DVD recorder, a Black & White Video Printer and a Color Printer may be installed onboard the
scanner. These devices are connected to the External I/O (Rear Panel) or Front Panel in the case of B/
W Printer. LOGIQ™ P5 do not support analog printer but digital printer.

5-8-3-1 Cable Connection - BW printer


Connect the Power cable and USB cable as shown in Figure 5-21.

Figure 5-34 Cable Connection - Digital BW Printer

5 - 36 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-8-3-2 Cable Connection - Color Printer


Connect USB cable listed below between the compatible Color Printer like SONY UP-D21MD and the
console.

Figure 5-35 Cable Connection - Digital Color Printer

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 37


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-8-3-3 Cable Connection - DVD Recorder


Connect the cable listed below between the SONY DVDR and the console..

Audio cable with RCA Jack

S-Video Cable

S-Video Cable

Audio cable with RCA Jack

Figure 5-36 Cable Connection - DVD Recorder

5 - 38 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 5-9 Filters


5-9-1 Filters
The scanner contains the two filters located at

a.) Right side of TRANSBOX to protect TRANSBOX and NEST from dust.
b.) Left side of TRANSBOX to protect TRANSBOX and NEST from dust.

(a) (b)

Figure 5-37 Location of Air Filter

5-9-2 Fans
The scanner contains the 5 fans at the following positions for producing an air flow.

a.) One fan : On the surface of heat sink for SOM heat.
b.) Two fans : At the top of the APS for APS heat.
c.) Two fans : At the top of the NEST for NEST Assy and AC Power assy.

(a) Cooling Fan on SYSCOMPM(SYSCONCM) (b) Cooling Fans on APS

(c) Cooling FAN Assy for NEST Cooling

Figure 5-38 Location of Fans

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 39


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 5-10
Service Platform
5-10-1 Introduction
The Service Platform contains a set of software modules that are common to all ultrasound and
cardiology systems containing a PC backend. This web-enabled technology provides linkage to e-
Services, e-Commerce, and the iCenter, making GE’s scanners more e-enabled than ever. The Service
Platform will increase service productivity and reduce training and service costs.

5 - 40 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-10-2 Global Service User Interface (GSUI)

5-10-2-1 Internationalization
The user interface provided by the service platform is designed for GE personnel and as such is in
English only. There is no multi-lingual capability built into the Service Interface.

5-10-2-2 Service Login


1) Touch Utility > Service. It will take about 1p seconds for activationg

2) make sure that CAPS is OFF for password entry performed later.

3) The Service Login window for Service Platform will be shown on the monitor dispaly.

Figure 5-39 Login Screen for Global Service User Interface

5-10-2-3 Access / Security


The service interface has different access and security user levels. Each user is only granted access to
the tools that are authorized for their use.

NOTE: A Service Dongle is necessary for use by GE Service when performing proprietary level diagnostics.
OnLine Center access to the scanner requires the password and they must have ‘Disruptive’
permission and customer input to run diagnostics.

Table 5-5 Service Login User Levels

User Level Access Authorization Password


Operator uls
Authorized acccess to specified diagnostics, error logs and utilities. Same
Administrator uls
acquisition diagnostic tests as GE Service.
External Service gogems

Knowledge of a service level password. rotating security


GE Service
A physical Service Key (Dongle) required password

NOTE: For a GE Field Engineer, the password changes at specific intervals. Access with the password is tied
to the service key.

Every access request, whether successful or not, will be logged into a service access log that is
viewable to authorized users.

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 41


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-10-3 Service Home Page


When the Service Interface is started, the Service Home Page appears. The Home Page contains the
software revision along with the hardware inventory and the results of the latest System Health
Information. The navigation bar at the top of the screen allows the user to select from several tools and
utilities.

Figure 5-40 GE Service Home Page

5 - 42 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-10-4 Error Logs Tab


From the Error Logs Tab the Log Viewer displays four categories with pull-down sub-menus and an Exit
selection. The Service Interface allows scanner logs to be viewed by all service users.

The Filter Error log is keyed to GE Service login access permissions and is not available to customer
level analysis.

The log entries are color-coded to identify the error level severity at a glance.

Table 5-6 Log Entry Key

Severity Error Level Color Code


1 Information Green

2 Warning Blue

3 Error Red

The Service Interface supports the transfer of these logs to local destinations such as the MOD, and
CD-ROM drive.

Figure 5-41 Log Viewer / Logs / Log Entries

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 43


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-10-4-1 Logs
The seven sub-menus of the Logs category are System, Infomatics, Temperature, Probe, Board, and
DICOM.

NOTE: Figure 5-41 provides a graphical example of the log entries for the System Logs.

Log table headings for the different logs are as follows:

• System
Log entry headings include Time Stamp; Error Level; Package; and Error Message.

• Infomatics
Log entry headings include TimeStamp, Revision, PtID, PtDOB, PtSex, PtWeight, PtHeight,
ExamID, Exam Category, ExamCurDate, and ExamStartTime.

• Temperature
Log entry headings include Time Stamp; Error Level; Package; L1SYSCON temperature sensor.

• Probe
Log entry headings include Time Stamp; Error Level; Package; Error Message; Severity; Revision;
and three (3) new labels that have not yet been named.

• DICOM
Log entry headings include Time Stamp; Error Level; Package; and Error Message.

5-10-4-2 Exit
The sub-menu, Exit Log Viewer, returns the user to the Service Desktop home page.

Figure 5-42 Exit Log Sub-Menu

5 - 44 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-10-5 Diagnostics
Detailed Diagnostic information is found in Diagnostics/Troubleshooting.

Figure 5-43 GE Service Diagnostic Page

NOTE: After finishing Diagnostic test, the system should be rebooted.

5-10-5-1 Diagnostics Execution


Diagnostic tests are executable by both local and remote users. The Service Platform provides top-level
diagnostic selection based on the user’s level and login access permissions. Remote access will require
disruptive diagnostic permissions to run Acquisition diagnostics.

5-10-5-2 Diagnostic Reports


Diagnostic tests return a report to the Service Platform. The platform retains the report and allows for
future viewing of the diagnostic logs.

5-10-5-3 Proactive Diagnostics


A system of self-monitoring is largely supported with the integration of iLinq. The scheduler, executive,
user interfaces, and some of the proactive diagnostic functions are provided by iLinq. Other tasks should
be provided by the product team.

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 45


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-10-6 Image Quality


The Image Quality page is intended to contain tools for troubleshooting image quality issues.

Figure 5-44 Image Quality Page

5-10-7 Calibration
The Calibration page is intended to contain the tools used to calibrate the system.

Figure 5-45 Calibration Page

5 - 46 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-10-8 Configuration
The Configuration page is intended to be used to setup various configuration files on the system.

The Service Platform is the access and authorization control for remote access to the configuration
subsystem.

The enable/disable of software options can be done from this Configuration page.

Figure 5-46 Configuration Page

5-10-8-1 Questra Agent Configuration


These feature that allow the customer to register the system to the GE OnLine Center are available for
Warranty and Contract customers only.

5-10-8-1-1 Device Information


Divce name and CRM No. are displayed by default.

5-10-8-1-2 Advanced Configuration


Select Enterprise Server to check out to

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 47


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-10-8-1-3 Proxy Configuration.


If Proxy is used in the site, it should be filled proper Proxy Server Address and Proxy Server Port.
And Press “Submit Changes” button to finish check out process

Figure 5-47 Proxy Configuration

NOTE: The system is needed to reboot to apply settings.

5-10-9 Utilities
The Utilities page contains several miscellaneous tools.

Figure 5-48 GE Service Utilities Page

5 - 48 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-10-9 Utilities (cont’d)

Figure 5-49 Customer Utilities Page

5-10-10 Replacement
The Replacement page is intended to contain the tools used to track replacement parts used in the
system.

Figure 5-50 Part Replacement Page

5-10-11 PM
The PM page is intended to contain the tools used in periodic maintenance of the system.

Figure 5-51 Planned Maintenance Page


Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 49
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-10-12 Remote Software/Option Installation and Updates


The Service Platform provides for remote software downloads. Any file transferred to the scanner will
be in the form of an installation package. The actual content of the installation package is dependent on
each product.

Software installation is simple and automated with a Graphic User Interface (GUI), where applicable.

Supports software upload via remote transmission

Supports software upload via Service Platform

Options can be activated permanently

Options can be activated for a timed period

Options can be limited to a number of uses

Options that expire must give notice to the user that the option has expired

5-10-12-1 Remote System Shutdown and Restart


The Service Platform provides the ability to restart the system as per standard shutdown/startup
procedures. Remote shutdown will only be provided if a software-controlled shutdown exists on the
scanner. Scanner system restart is always accessible from the OLC.

5-10-12-2 File and/or Image Transfer


The Service Platform supports file transfers and archived image transfers to the OnLine Center. The
Service Platform provides interfaces of the displayed images for transfer to the OLC.

5 - 50 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 5-11RFS (Service For Request)


5-11-1 General
This describes general RFS functionality.

1.) RFS function is a call for service to be used by customer or FE directly from the system instead of
calling GE Cares

5-11-2 System Checkout Procedure


If the system is checked out already, skip 5-8-2) System Checkout Procedure and proceed from 5-8-
3) Sending RFS Procedure.

1.) Check if the system is connected to the network.


2.) Go to “Utility”
3.) Press “Service”
4.) Log on to the Service Platform with a password.
5.) Press “Configuration”
6.) Press “InSite ExC Agent Configuration”

Figure 5-52 Agent Configuration

All bold fields should be filled

7.) Device Name and CRM No are pre-populated and can not be changed.
8.) Verify that "Send" button is enabled.
9.) Select Continent and Country
10.)Put City, State, and Institution
11.)Select “Product” for the Enterprise.
12.)If Proxy needs to be configured, select “Enable” for the Proxy filed and input IP address and Port
number.

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 51


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

13.)Press “Submit Changes”. “Please Wait” message is displayed while the system is checking out.
Figure 5-53

Figure 5-53 Please Wait

14.)Wait until following screen displays. (Figure 5-54)

Figure 5-54 Configuration done

15.)Configuration is complete.
16.)Close the Service Platform.

5 - 52 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5-11-3 Sending RFS Procedure


Service Platform should be turned off in order to open RFS window.

System must be connected to network, configured and checked out to be able to send the RFS

1.) Right Click on “Connect to GE” icon.

Figure 5-55 Contact GE Icon

All the fields that are marked with asterisk * are mandatory and should be filled in order to send
the RFS request to On Line Center.

2.) Fill out the Last name, First name, and Phone number. (Figure 5-56)
3.) Extension, Email, and Other system ID fields are optional.
4.) Select Problem Type.
If Problem is about “No Boot”, “No Image”, “Error message”, “Lock up”, “Probe”, “Peripherals”, select
“Service” for the Problem Type.

If Problem is about “Presets”, “Reports”, “Measurements”, or “Probe not recognized”, select


“Applications” for the Problem Type.

5.) Select the Problem Area.


6.) Write the detailed problem description in the Problem Description field.

Figure 5-56 RFS window

Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail 5 - 53


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7.) Then the “Send” button is enabled.(Figure 5-57)

Figure 5-57 RFS send enabled

8.) Click “Send” button and wait for confirmation window with reference number on the screen.
9.) Verify that "confirmation message" pops up in the screen.
10.)RFS request is completed.
11.)On Line Center will contact the customer shortly by phone.

5 - 54 Section 5-4 - Main Board Detail


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Chapter 6
Service Adjustments

Section 6-1
Overview
6-1-1 Purpose of this chapter 6
This section describes how to test and adjust the scanner. These tests are optional. You may use them
to check the system for errors.

Table 6-1 Contents in chapter

Section Description Page Number

6-1 Overview 6-1

6-2 Regulatory 6-1

6-3 Monitor Adjustments 6-2

Section 6-2
Regulatory
Verify, where applicable, that any regulatory information or tests required by national law are present
and accounted for, and any regulatory tests required by national law are performed and documented.

Section 6-1 - Overview 6-1


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 6-3
Monitor Adjustments
6-3-1 Rotate and tilt the monitor
The monitor position can be adjusted for easy viewing.

- The monitor can be rotated around its central pivot point.


- The monitor can be tilted for the optimum viewing angle.
- the monitor can be flipped up and down.
NOTE: When moving the system, flip down the monitor to its lowest possible position to improve
stability.

Figure 6-1 LCD monitor Flip up and down

6-2 Section 6-3 - Monitor Adjustments


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6-3-2 Brightness and Contrast


Adjusting the monitor's contrast and brightness is one of the most important factors for proper image
quality. If these controls are set incorrectly, the Gain, TGC, Dynamic Range and even Power Output
may have to be changed more often than necessary to compensate.

The proper setup displays a complete gray scale. The lowest level of black should just disappear into
the background and the highest white should be bright, but not saturated.

To adjust the contrast:

1.) Press the Toggle button on the display monitor once.


2.) Press the Adjustment (+) button to increase contrast. Press the Adjustment (-) button to decrease
contrast.
3.) The amount of contrast is shown on a slide bar on the screen.
To adjust the brightness:

4.) Press the Toggle button on the display monitor twice.


5.) Press the Adjustment (+) button to increase brightness. Press the Adjustment (-) button to decrease
brightness.
6.) The amount of brightness is shown on a slide bar on the screen.t

Figure 6-2 Brightness and Contras

1. Contrast Indicator
2. Brightness Indicator
3. Dim Brightness Indicator
4. Light Button
5. Adjustment (-) Button
6. Toggle Button
7. Adjustment (+) Button

Record any changes to the final brightness and contrast settings and leave this information with the
system. Generally speaking, do not change the controls once they have been set. Once set, the display
then becomes the reference for the hard copy device(s).

NOTE: After readjusting the monitor's Contrast and Brightness, readjust all preset and peripheral
settings.

Section 6-3 - Monitor Adjustments 6-3


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6-3-3 LCD Plastic filter

6-3-3-1 Tools
• Common philips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench
• Stubby screwdriver (Flat tip and Cross tip)

6-3-3-2 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the LP6 Monitor cover set. Refer to 8-2-5 "Monitor cover set" on page 8-17 and the figure
below.
2.) Remove the LCD Plastic filter. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 6-3 Removing the LCD plastic filter

3.) Put the LCD plastic filter on the LCD monitor after detaching the tape of the LCD plastic filter. Refer
to the figure below.

Figure 6-4 Putting the LCD plastic filter on the LCD monitor
6-4 Section 6-3 - Monitor Adjustments
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6-3-3-2 Removal procedure (cont’d)


4.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 6-2 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 2+, 6-3-3. Equipment passed all
Section 4-8-2 LCD plastic filter validation Procedure required tests and is ready for use. “

10-5-5 Physical Inspection

6-3-3-3 Mounting Procedure


1.) Install the LCD monitor cover parts in the reverse order of removal procedure. Refer to 8-2-5
"Monitor cover set" on page 8-17.
2.) Put the label on the rear of the LCD monitor. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 6-5 Putting the label on the rear of the LCD monitor

Section 6-3 - Monitor Adjustments 6-5


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6-3-4 Flexible LCD arm - locking mechanism


Flexible LCD arm’s rotation movement can be adjusted by using the LCD arm’s locking mechanism.

To unlock the LCD arm:

1.) Pull the LCD arm toggle knob and turn clockwise to unlock the LCD arm.

Figure 6-6 Unlocking the Flexible LCD arm

To lock the LCD arm :

1.) Turn counter clockwise and push the LCD arm toggle knob and to lock the LCD arm.

Figure 6-7 Locking the Flexible LCD arm

6-6 Section 6-3 - Monitor Adjustments


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 6-4
Trackball Cleaning
The trackball on the keyboard need to be cleaning periodically

1.) Open the trackball

Figure 6-8 Open Trackball

Remove dust inside of bucket

Figure 6-9 Trackball Hole

Section 6-4 - Trackball Cleaning 6-7


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6-8 Section 6-4 - Trackball Cleaning


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Chapter 7
Diagnostics/Troubleshooting

Section 7-1
Overview
7-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 7
This section describes how to setup and run the tools and software that help maintain image quality and
system operation. Basic host, system, and board level diagnostics are run whenever power is applied.
Some Service Tools may be run at the application level.

NOTE : Be sure to disable ECG function before performing Diagnostic function.


NOTE : Make sure that convex or linear probe is connected before the sytem starts. (sector probe is not
applicable for the service diagnostics)

Table 7-1 Contents in Chapter 7

Section Description Page Number


7-1 Overview 7-1
7-2 Network Connectivity Troubleshooting 7-1

7-2 Gathering Trouble Data 7-2

7-3 Screen Captures 7-4


7-4 Diagnostics 7-8

7-5 Common Diagnostics 7-9

7-6 LED Descriptions 7-20


7-7 Trouble Shooting Tree 7-21

Section 7-1 - Overview 7-1


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 7-2
Gathering Trouble Data
7-2-1 Overview
There may be a time when it would be advantageous to capture trouble images and system data (logs)
for acquisition through remote diagnostics (InSite) or to be sent back to the manufacturer for analysis.
There are different options to acquire this data that would give different results.

7-2-2 Collect Vital System Information


The following information is necessary in order to properly analyze data or images being reported as a
malfunction or being returned to the manufacturer:

- Product Name = LOGIQ™ P5/A5


From the Utility>System>About screen:

Applications Software

- Software Version
- Software Part Number
System Image Software

- Image Part Number


- Image Date

7-2 Section 7-2 - Gathering Trouble Data


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-2-3 Collect a Trouble Image with Logs


If the system should malfunction, press the Alt-D keys simultaneously. This will collect a screen capture
of the image monitor, system presets and the following logs:

- Keyboard Shadow Log


- Error Logs
- Crash Log
- Power Supply
- Temperature

NOTE: Power Supply and Temperature logs are not currently being updated by the LOGIQ™ P5/A5.

This Alt-D function is available at all times.

Figure 7-1 ALT-D Dialog Box

When Alt-D is pressed, a menu box appears that allows for:

- A place to enter a description of the problem


- A choice to store to a pre-formatted CD-R/DVD, USB or Network storage.
The subsequent file is compressed and time stamped. The screen capture is a bitmap which eliminates
the possibility of artifacts from compression.

Section 7-2 - Gathering Trouble Data 7-3


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 7-3
Screen Captures
There may be times when the customer or field engineer will want to capture a presentation on the
screen so it may be recovered by the OnLine Center through InSite. This is accomplished by first saving
the image(s) to the clipboard using a Print Key.

The P2 key is the factory default print key to accomplish a secondary screen capture. However, the
default is for the video area only or the customer may have customized the P2 Key function. Therefore,
screen capture should involve the following steps:

1.) Check and record any custom settings for the Print2 button.
2.) Set the Print2 button to Whole Screen, Secondary Capture.
3.) Capture the required screens to the Hard Drive or CD-R / DVD-R.
4.) Restore the Print2 button to it’s original settings.

7-3-1 Check and Record the P2 Key Function


Check the function of the Print2 Key in the event that the customer may have made some custom
settings.

1.) Select Utility from the FrontPanel.


2.) Select Connectivity from the Menu.
3.) Select the Buttons tab on the Connectivity screen.
4.) In the Button field, select Print2.
The Connectivity/Buttons Screen will be displayed like the one shown in Figure 7-2.

Figure 7-2 Buttons Set Up Screen

P2 is the factory default Screen Capture Key. If it is not set to Whole Screen or Screen Capture, as
shown in Figure 7-2, proceed to step 5 to record the customer’s custom settings.

7-4 Section 7-3 - Screen Captures


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-3-1 Check and Record the P2 Key Function (cont’d)


5.) In the “Physical Print Buttons”box, record the followings.
* Format
* Image Frames
* Capture Area
* Compression
6.) In the “Printflow View”, record the print flow associated with the Print2 Button.

7-3-2 Setting the P2 Key to Screen Capture


If the P2 Key is not set to screen capture:

1.) While on the Connectivity screen, with the Buttons tab displayed, go to the drop down selection
menu in the Destinations section.
2.) Ensure that Capture Area is set to Whole Screen, secondary Capture and None Image
Compression.
3.) The P2 Key should now be set up for whole screen capture, sending the screens to the image
buffer (clipboard).

Section 7-3 - Screen Captures 7-5


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-3-3 Capturing a Screen


The following is a generic process to capture any screen from the scanner:

1.) Navigate to and display the image/screen to be captured.


2.) Press P2. This will place a snapshot of the screen on the “clipboard” displayed at the bottom
of the scan image display.

Clipboard
Thumbnails Menu

Figure 7-3 Select Image to Capture

3.) Highlight the snapshot to be stored to the system hard drive or CD-R / DVD-R.
4.) Select Menu on the right side of the image screen, then highlight and select SAVE AS.

Save As

Figure 7-4 Menu > Save As

7-6 Section 7-3 - Screen Captures


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-3-3 Capturing a Screen (cont’d)

Figure 7-5 Save Dialog Box

5.) A Save dialog box will be opened. Choose the destination as the archive location to save the
image on the CD-R/DVD-R, USB or network storage.

7-3-4 Reset the P2 Key to Customer’s Functionality


If the customer had programmed the P2 Key to a function other than screen capture, restore that
functionality recorded in section 7-3-1 on page 4. refer to Figure 7-2.

1.) Select Utility from the Keyboard.


2.) Select Connectivity from the Menu.
3.) Select the Buttons tab on the Connectivity screen.
4.) In the Button field, select Print2.
5.) In the “Physical Print Buttons”box, select the options recorded in step 5, Section 7-3-1. :
* Format
* Image Frames
* Capture Area
* Compression

Section 7-3 - Screen Captures 7-7


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 7-4
Diagnostics
As described in - Components and Functions (Theory), the service platform uses a web-based user
interface (UI) to provide access to common service components.

The Diagnostic home page displays a listing of test categories consisting of Common Diagnostics, and
LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Diagnostics. Expand the desired main category to select groups or individual tests.

Figure 7-6 Global Service User Interface Diagnostic Screen

7-8 Section 7-4 - Diagnostics


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 7-5
Common Diagnostics
Common Diagnostics is the first main heading under the GSUI heading of Diagnostics.

Figure 7-7 shows the top level menu choices under Common Diagnostics. The subheadings and their
respective diagnostic/troubleshooting menu choices are called out and described in the sections below.

Figure 7-7 Common Diagnostics

7-5-1 Utilities
Provides two selections:

7-5-1-1 Disruptive Mode


Allows you to enable or disable disruptive mode troubleshooting. If you are accessing through InSite,
this can only be enabled with the customer/operator confirmation.

7-5-1-2 System Shutdown


Allows for system shutdown from the diagnostic menu. Select to retain Disruptive Mode or Not.

After submitting to or shutdown a confirmation screen gives one last chance to confirm or cancel the
request.

Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics 7-9


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-5-2 PC Diagnostics (Non-Interactive Tests)

7-5-2-1 CPU Tests


• CPU Test (All) - This diagnostic performs a battery of tests on your CPU to ensure it is working
properly. The following tests are a complete list of the tests performed on the PC's CPU.
• CPU: Registers - The CPU registers are tested using the default test patterns defined above. On
32 bit CPUs, the extended registers are also checked. If errors are detected, the failed registers are
listed.
• CPU: Arithimetics - Tests the proper function of arithmetic commands ADC, ADD, DEC, DIV, IDIV,
IMUL, INC, MUL, SBB and SUB with 16 and 32-bit operands. If errors are detected, the failed
commands and operands are listed.
• CPU: String Operations - Tests the proper operation of string commands LODS, MOVS, SCAS
and STOS with 8, 16 and 32-bit operands. If errors are detected, the failed commands and
operands are listed.
• CPU: Logical Operations - Tests the proper operation of logical operations AND, NOT, OR and
XOR with 16 and 32-bit operands. If errors are detected, the failed operands are listed.
• CPU: Math Registers - Tests coprocessor register stack, pointers and commands FLDLZ, FLDPI,
FLDLN2, FLDLG2, FLDL2T, FLDL2E and FLD1. If errors are detected, the failed steps and
commands are listed.
• CPU: Math Commands - Tests coprocessor commands FBLD/FBSTP, FLD/FST, FXCH, FCOM,
FICOM, FTST, FXAM and FUCOM. If errors are detected, the failed instructions are listed.
• CPU: Math Arithimetics -
• CPU: Transcendental - Tests coprocessor transcendental commands F2XM1, FPATAN, FPTAN,
FYL2X, FYL2XP1, FCOS, FSIN and FSINCOS. If errors are detected, the failed commands are
listed.
• CPU: MMX Arithmetic - Tests MMX commands PADD, PSUB, PMUL and PMADD. If errors are
detected, the failed commands are listed.
• CPU: MMX Logical - Tests MMX commands PAND, PANDN, POR and PXOR. If errors are
detected, the failed commands are listed.
• CPU: MMX Shift - Tests MMX commands PSLL and PSRL. If errors are detected, the failed
commands are listed.
• CPU: MMX Data Transfer - Tests MMX commands MOVD and MOVQ. If errors are detected, the
failed commands are listed.
• CPU: MMX Misc. - Tests MMX commands PCMPEQ, PCMPGT, PACKSS, PACKUS, PUNPCK
and PUNPCK. If errors are detected, the failed commands are listed.

7 - 10 Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-5-2-2 Hard Drive Tests


• Hard Drive Test (All) - The Hard Drive test examines your hard disk drive using a series of tests to
ensure that your drive can perform its functions.
The following tests are performed on your hard drive to ensure the hard disk controller and the drive
mechanism are working correctly. The disk surface itself is also checked.

NOTE: The hard drive test can take over ten minutes.

• Hard Drive: Linear Seek - Hard disk drive heads are moved from track 0 to the maximum track one
track at a time.
• Hard Drive: Random Seek - Hard disk drive heads are moved randomly several hundred times.
• Hard Drive: Funnel Seek - Hard disk drive heads are moved in a funnel fashion, i.e., from the first
track on the drive to the last, then to the second track, then to the second to last track, then to the
third track, and so on.
• Hard Drive: Surface Scan - This test scans for surface defects on the hard disk drive.

7-5-2-3 Memory Tests


• Memory Test (All) - Eighteen test patterns are used to test memory locations. If errors are
detected, the address of the block the error was detected in is shown. During testing, these
diagnostics will also look out for parity errors and other exceptions. These will be added to the Test
Log as errors if encountered.
• Memory: Pattern Test - PC-Doctor uses several test patterns to test as much memory as possible.
• Memory: Parity Test - This test checks for parity errors on the memory bus during intensive string
transfer operations. If an error is detected, the address of the failed block is displayed.

Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics 7 - 11


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-5-2-4 CD/DVD Drive Test

NOTE: Although the global aspect of the diagnostics allow for DVD testing, the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 does not have
a DVD drive.(Option)

• DVD/CD-ROM Test (All) - The CD-ROM/DVD test examines the CD-ROM/DVD drive to make sure
it is working properly. You may use either a data CD-ROM disk or a DVD disk for these tests. You
cannot use an audio CD, such as a regular commercial music CD, with this test.

NOTE: The PC is sometimes slow in recognizing a newly inserted CD-ROM/DVD disk. It is best to wait a few
seconds after inserting a disk into the drive before you run any tests.

There are two types of CD-ROM/DVD tests:

1.) Seek Tests: Ensures the drive can access all locations on a disk, and
2.) Read Tests: Ensures the drive can read all the data.
• DVD/CD-ROM: Linear Seek - Tests that all locations can be accessed on a CD-ROM or DVD disk
in a linear fashion, starting from the first to the last.
• DVD/CD-ROM: Random Seek - Tests that all locations can be accessed on a CD-ROM or DVD
disk randomly.
• DVD/CD-ROM: Funnel Seek - Tests that all locations can be accessed on a CD-ROM or DVD disk
in a funnel fashion, starting from the first then moving to the last, then, at the next pass starting from
the second location then moving to the next to the last, and so on
• DVD/CD-ROM: Linear Read - Reads the data on the CD-ROM or DVD in a linear fashion, starting
from the start to the end.
• DVD/CD-ROM: Random Read - Reads the data on the CD-ROM or DVD randomly.

7-5-2-5 Video Test


• Video Test (All) - This diagnostic tests your system's video capabilities. This involves testing the
video memory with 18 patterns, testing your graphics acceleration, and text output. You will see
these tests being performed on your monitor.
You can cancel this test at any time by hitting the Escape (Esc) key.

The following tests are performed on your monitor:

• Video: Memory - Video memory is tested by filling the video buffer with 18 test patterns, one pattern
at a time. The tests will fill the entire screen with a single color.
• Video: Data Transfer - This tests the graphics acceleration part of your video controller. These
tests will appear on your screen as black and white concentric squares and rectangles of various
sizes and colors. If errors are detected, the locations of the problems are displayed.
• Video: Text Output - This test prints a text string in random sizes and colors to tests your video
device driver and video controller.

7 - 12 Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-5-2-6 USB Test(Not yet supported)


• USB Test (All)
• USB Configuration Test
• USB Devices Test

7-5-2-7 PCI Board Configuration Test


A bus is a set of circuits, wires or connectors which connect the various components of your system. A
PCI (Peripheral Component Interconnect) bus is a fast standard bus which is common in Pentium
systems. Various tests are run on the PCI bus in order to ensure it is working up to speed.

The motherboard is scanned to verify the configuration space and to make sure the diagnostics can
communicate with the board.

7-5-2-8 Network Test

Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics 7 - 13


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-5-3 PC Diagnostics (Interactive Tests)

7-5-3-1 Keyboard Test


1.) Click Keyboard Test from the PC Diagnostics interactive tests menu.
2.) Click the Test button. A keyboard layout is displayed on which you can see the keys of your
keyboard.
3.) Press each key on your keyboard once and make sure that the corresponding keys on-screen are
removed from view. If a key on-screen is not removed, that key may be damaged and you may have
to have your keyboard repaired or replaced.
4.) To reset the keyboard, click the Reset Keys button.
5.) To exit the test, click Close.

7-5-3-2 Audio Test


1.) Click Audio Test from the PC Diagnostic interactive tests menu.
2.) To test the WAV sound reproduction click Left Channel, Right Channel, or Both Channels to test
your speakers. You should hear a guitar chord.
3.) To test MIDI sound reproduction click the button under MIDI. You should hear a few seconds of
recorded music.
4.) Click on the Beep button. You should hear a low "beep" from your PC.
If no sound is produced in these tests, choose the More Info button in the Audio Test dialog box for
information about possible causes and solutions.

7-5-3-3 Mouse Test


1.) Click Mouse Test from the PC Diagnostic interactive tests menu.
The Mouse test dialog box presents you like Figure 7-8.

Figure 7-8 Mouse Test

2.) The Mouse coordinates are displayed when the trackball is moved.
3.) Press the right Button(Set B/Pause Button) on the front panel, the Mouse which is turned to Yellow
7 - 14 Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

on the right side is shown on the monitor. Refer to the Figure 7-9.

Figure 7-9

4.) Left Button is the same as above.

Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics 7 - 15


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-5-4 FRU Test

7-5-4-1 SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM
These programs are provided for testing the SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM board.

Table 7-2 FRU Test, SYSCONPM/SYSCONCMDiagnostics Menu

Descriptions
User
Menu Level Tools

Full Test Performs all of the L1 SYSCON board tests listed below All None

Test EEPROM.
Assy Revision Test Send test pattern to write to EEPROM and read All None
Displays the board revision of the SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM board

The CL1TRX, P3RLY, optional ACWD boards are connected to the SYSCONPM/
SYSCONCM via the USC bus.
USC I/F Test All None
The DSP in SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM accesses the boards above to check if the
USC bus is connected properly to each board.

Checks if The DSP in SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM accessed the boards, CL1TRX/


FEBUS Test All None
BL1TRX and ACWD, via the FEBUS.

TRIG Test Check the trigger max, min and ever interval All None

PCI I/F Test Sends the command to the DSP to check the SDRAM in SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM All None

DSP Memory Test Sends the command to the DSP to check the internal DSP memory All None

Board Temperature Read SYSCON Board Temperature. All None

GE FE
CHACOM I/F Test Sends the command to read / write data from DSP to CHACOM None
Only

7 - 16 Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-5-4-2 CL1TRX/BL1TRX
These programs are provided for testing the CL1TRX /BL1TRZboard.

Table 7-3 FRU Test, CL1TRX/BL1TRX Diagnostics Menu

Descriptions
User
Menu Level Tools

Performs all of the CL1TRX/BL1TRX board tests listed below


Full Test All None

Test EEPROM.
Assy Revision
Send test pattern to write to EEPROM and read All None
Test
Displays the board revision of the CL1TRX/BL1TRX board

Checks if the DSP in SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM can access the CL1TRX/BL1TRX


USC I/F Test All None
boards via USB bus.

Checks if the DSP in SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM can access the CL1TRX/BL1TRX


FEBUS Test All None
board via FE bus.

HV Test Read HV Power All None

Sends the test data High, Mid, Low level to PGC Register, then CL1TRX/BL1TRX
PGC Test All None
read result data and verify it.

Sends the test data High, Mid, Low level to Test wave Register, then CL1TRX/
TEST Wave Test All None
BL1TRX read result data and verify it.

TRX Data
Send the command to read / write to TRX data memory. All None
Memory Test

The DSP in L1SYSCON reads and writes the OQCARD registers in CL1TRX/BL1TRX
OQX2 Test All None
via FE bus.

The DSP in L1SYSCON reads and writes the TPG2 registers in CL1TRX/BL1TRX via
TPG2 Test
FE bus.

Send test wave pattern to the input stage of preamp on CL1TRX/BL1TRX, perform 64
RX Channel Test
channel scanning, Read raw data, and analyze it.

Send test wave pattern to the CL1TRX/BL1TRX, read returned small signal, Read the
TX Channel Test data and analyze it.
Note: APS HV test is requried prior to the TRX TX channel test.

Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics 7 - 17


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-5-4-3 P3RLY/P2RLY
These programs are provided for testing the P3RLY/P2RLY board.

NOTE: A Convex Probe is needed for RLY Channel Test.

Table 7-4 FRU Test, P3RLY Diagnostics Menu

Descriptions
User
Menu Level Tools

GE FE
Full Test Performs all of the P3RLY/P2RLY board tests listed below None
Only

Test EEPROM.
Assy Revision
Send test pattern to write to EEPROM and readDisplays the board revision of the All None
Test
P3RLY/P2RLY board

Checks if the DSP in SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM can access the P3RLY/P2RLY board GE FE


FEBUS Test None
via FE bus. Only

GE FE
SHV Testt Send the command to SHV resister in P3RLY/P2RLY board to read SHV status. None
Only

GE FE
OPEN Test Checks whether probe connected or not on P3RLY/P2RLY. Probe
Only

Checks if the 8 bits of the Probe Code in the probe connector is properly connected.
PROBE CODE
If connected probe is available, display code and Probe name.

7-5-4-4 ACWD
These programs are provided for testing the ACWD board.

Table 7-5 FRU Test, ACWD Diagnostics Menu

Descriptions
User
Menu Level Tools

Full Test Performs all of the ACWD board test listed below All None

Assy Revision Test EEPROM.Send test pattern to write to EEPROM and readDisplays the board
All None
TEst revision of the ACWD board

USC Interface Checks if the DSP in SYSCONPM/SYSCNCM can access the ACWD boards via USB
All None
Test bus.

Allows SYSCONPM/SYSCNCM to access FE bus interface in the ACWD in order to


FEBUS Test
check if FE bus line is normal.

Send the command to perform CW scanning, read IQ data from assigned memory,
IQ Data Read
analyze the data with FFT algorithm.

Probe
Checks whether ACWD probe connected or not.
Connection

Generate test pattern, perform 32 channel scanning in ACWD, read the data and
Channel Test
analyze it.

7 - 18 Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-5-4-5 APS
These programs are provided for testing the APS board.

Table 7-6 FRU Test, APS Diagnostics Menu

Descriptions
User
Menu Level Tools

Full Test Performs all of the APS test listed below All None

HV voltage
Read HV voltage and display HV values. All None
stability

LV voltage
Read HV voltage and display LV values. All None
stability

7-5-4-6 FRONT PANEL


These programs are provided for testing the Front panel.

Table 7-7 FRU Test, ACWD Diagnostics Menu

Descriptions
User
Menu Level Tools

FRONT PANEL
Performs all of the Front Panel tests listed below All None
Overall

FRONT PANEL Test EEPROM.Send test pattern to write to EEPROM and read.Displays the board
All None
Revision revision of the Front Panel.

ROM Makes a check of internal ROM check sum. All None

Writes / reads data over all address of RAM and also makes a check of control
RAM All None
program.

EEPROM Writes / reads data over all address of EEPROM All None

SWITCH Test switch in Front Panel. All None

Rotate or depress any key, Verify that it is displayed on the CRT monitor. To finish the
Echoback All None
test, press "Abort" key and wait until complete message appears.

NOTE: For the EchoBack test, it is highly recommended to press a button less than two times per a
second.

NOTE: When Abort button is pressed to finish EchoBack test, you have to wait until “Completed..”
message is displayed to proceed other tests.

Section 7-5 - Common Diagnostics 7 - 19


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 7-6
LED Descriptions
7-6-1 CL1TRX/BL1TRX Assy
The CL1TRX/BL1TRX Assy is located at the No.1 slot in the NEST Assy.

Table 7-8 LEDs on CL1TRX/BL1TRX Assy

LED Descriptions Normal State

DS1 FPGA configuration OK status Indicator Normally Blinking

7-6-2 P3RLY/P2RLY Assy


The P3RLY Assy is located at the front of the NEST Assy.

Table 7-9 LEDs on P3RLY/P2RLY Assy

LED Descriptions Normal State

D1 MUX embedded Probe Recognition Indicator Normally On

D2 Selected probe connector position number bit 0 Depend on live probe position

D3 Selected probe connector position number bit 1 Depend on live probe position

D4 FPGA Configuration OK status indicator Normally On

7-6-3 SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM Assy


The SYSCONPM/SYSCONCM Assy is located at the No.3 slot of the NEST Assy.

Table 7-10 LEDs on L1SYSCON Assy

LED Descriptions Normal State

DS1 CPDI FPGA configuration OK indicator Normally On

DS2 Frame Start signal. Scan running status indicator Normally blinking on scanning
DS3 FEBC FPGA configuration OK indicator Normally On

DS4 DSP operation OK indicator Normally blinking

7-6-4 APS Assy


The APS Assy is located at the No. 4 slot of the NEST Assy.

Table 7-11 LEDs on APS Assy

LED Descriptions Normal State

DP5 (Top) Digital 5V output indicator Normally On

LP5 Live Power 5V output indicator Normally On

AP6 Analog 6V output indicator Normally On

DP33 Digital 3.3V output indicator Normally On

SHV+ SHV+ output indicator status indicator Normally On

HVL+ HVL+ level indicator Normally On in CFM mode or PW mode

HVH+ (Bottom) HVH+ level indicator Normally On in B mode

7 - 20 Section 7-6 - LED Descriptions


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 7-7Trouble Shooting Tree


7-7-1 System Does Not Power On / Boot Up

Is the scanner NO
plugged in?
Make sure the
scanner is not
plugged into Yes
emergency power
(red outlet);

Is the AC at the NO Check if wall power is alive


wall outlet?

Yes

Is the circuit NO
breaker ON?

Yes

Check if the standby 5V od APS is alive


Make sure AC power connector and con-
Press the on/off switch to trol signal connector is plugged properly
boot the system. Is the NO
on/off switch illuminated
with an green color and
can you listen fan sound
of inside?

Yes

If HDD indicator is blinking after power


Does the scanner NO on, check the monitor cable
boot up? Check BIOS or replace PM SOM module

Yes

Scanner is ON and ready for use.

Figure 7-10 Power On / Boot Up Flowchart

Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree 7 - 21


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-2 System Does Not Boot

System doesn’t boot!

Is the AC power cable


NO
seated to the Scanner and
to the wall power outlet?

Connect the AC power cable


YES between the Scanner and the wall
power outlet in right way.

Is the main breaker turned NO


ON?

Turn ON the main breaker of


YES the Scanner.

Has the ON/OFF


NO
key on the Control Panel
been pressed once?

Press the ON/OFF button on the


YES Control Panel.

Go on to the next page.

Figure 7-11 System does not Boot

7 - 22 Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-3 System Does Not Boot

System doesn’t boot! (cont’d)

Do the fans start to run? NO

Check;
YES 1.) AC Power
2.) AC Transformer

Is the SOM module starting NO


to display start-up screens Check/replace the PM SOM/CM
on the monitor? SOMmodule.

YES

Is the LOGIQ starting NO


display shown on the
monitor?

Turn off the power, wait a few


seconds, and try to turn on the
power again.
Go on to the next page.

Figure 7-12 System does not Boot (contd.)

Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree 7 - 23


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-3 System Does Not Boot (cont’d)

System doesn’t boot! (cont’d)

Are the Control Panel NO


keys lit?

1.) Check the Control


YES Panel cable
connection.
2.) Check/replace
Control Panel.

END

Is regular scan display NO


shown on the monitor?

Press and hold the main switch for


YES five (5) seconds to reboot the
system.

Go to Scan Procedure section.

Figure 7-13 System does not Boot (contd.)

7 - 24 Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-4 Noise in Image

Noise is shown in Image.

Is there any electrical YES


devices that affect the
Scanner?

NO Keep the Scanner away from those


electrical devices.

Check probes.

Figure 7-14 Noise in Image

Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree 7 - 25


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-5 Unable to Scan

Unable to scan!

Are probes connected in NO


right way?

Check the probe connection.


YES

END

Are other operations YES


possible?

NO
Check the HV power supply unit.

Restart the scanner.

Figure 7-15 Unable to Scan

7 - 26 Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-6 Trackball

The trackball is low sensitive!

Does the trackball move at YES


all?

NO Remove the ball from the Trackball,


and clean it.

Replace the trackball unit.

Figure 7-16 Trackball Troubleshooting

Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree 7 - 27


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-7 Monitor Troubleshooting


NOTE: Reset the monitor settings to the factory defaults prior to troubleshooting the monitor.

NOTICE Comments to remember about the 15” monitor.


The monitor is the diagnostic monitor and is connected to AC 110/220 VAC.
The monitor powers down with the console.
Power output from AC Power assy via AC distributor in AC Transbox assy:
When the monitor is not connected to the AC power there is a leakage current which
when measured with a DVM can indicate high voltage.

When a load is applied, the voltage collapses to low voltage if the monitor is not
switched on.

7 - 28 Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-7 Monitor Troubleshooting (cont’d)

Press once the on/off switch.

NO Press and hold on/off switch until


Is the shutdown dialog
system shut down.
box displayed?

Yes

Shutdown the scanner from a software


screen or depress the ON/OFF switch
Depress and hold the ON/OFF switch on
the scanner for approximately 5
seconds.

If the scanner fails to Shut Off, follow the


NO step below.
Did the scanner
Shut off? Check cable connection refer 7-10-5

If the scanner still does not Shut off,


Switch the circuit breaker to the OFF
Yes position.

Switch the breaker to the


OFF position.to
completely Power Down
the scanner.

Figure 7-17

Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree 7 - 29


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-7 Monitor Troubleshooting (cont’d)


• Monitor does not work
- Check AC circuit breaker
- Verify power is present at monitor outlet
- Check if video is present at backplane
• Prints do not match monitor
- Verify factory default settings. Chapter 18 in the User Manual calls out suggested settings for
various exam and lighting conditions.
• Video test patterns are not clear, bright, parallel or square
- Replace the monitor

7 - 30 Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-8 Unable to Record to VCR

Unable to record to VCR!

Is the VCR properly NO


connected?

YES Check that all signal, and power


supply cable connections to the VCR
unit are OK.

Is the VCR tape put into NO


the device?

YES Put the tape into the device and


rewind it.

Is recording unable even NO


by manual operation?

YES - Check the signal cable connections


between VCR and Internal I/O.
- Check the cables between BEP and
Internal I/O

Replace VCR.

Figure 7-18 VCR Troubleshooting

Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree 7 - 31


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-9 Printer Troubleshooting

Unable to use Printer(s)!

Is the printer(s) properly NO


connected?

YES Check that all signal, and power


supply cable connections between
Printer and Scanner are OK.

Are there print papers left? NO

YES Insert the printer papers.

Is proper configuration for NO


the Print key(s) set?

Configure the Print key(s).

See next page.

Figure 7-19 Printer Troubleshooting

7 - 32 Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-9 Printer Troubleshooting (cont’d)

Still unable to use the Printer(s)!

Is printing unavailable
NO
even by manual
operation?

YES Check the USB cables Between


backplane and usb port.

YES
Is there an error message
on the monitor display?

NO Replace SOM module.

Replace the Printer.

Figure 7-20 Printer Troubleshooting (contd.)

Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree 7 - 33


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-10 DVD-RW Troubleshooting

Unable to record to CD-R or DVD -R!

Is a new, unused CD-R NO


disc inserted to the drive?

YES Insert a new, un-used CD-R disc.

Are CD-Rs rated at the proper write NO


speed?

YES
Acquire CD-Rs rated at the proper write
speed.

Replace SOM Module.

Figure 7-21 CD-RW Troubleshooting

7 - 34 Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-11 Network Troubleshooting

7-7-11-1 No Connection to the Network at All


1.) Check that the network cable between the scanner and the wall network is connected and well
seated in both ends.
2.) Try a network cable that is known to be OK.
3.) Check the cable between the SYSCONPM(SYSCOMCM) and Rear Panel.
4.) Connect a Crossed network cable between the Scanner and your PC. Try to ping from the scanner
to the IP address on the PC. If OK, the hardware connection inside the scanner is OK.

7-7-11-2 No Contact With Server, But Connection to Network is OK


Check Network setup on the scanner.

Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree 7 - 35


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7-7-11 Network Troubleshooting (cont’d)

No Connection to the Network

Is the
TCP/IP Cable between
LOGIQ™ P5/A5 and NO
network outlet connected
and well

YES Connect the cable and verify that it is


well seated in both ends.

Try a network cable that is known to


be OK

YES
Is the connection OK now?

NO Replace the AEXP cable between


SYSCON and Rear panel.

Is the
cable between SYSCON NO
and Rear Panel OK?

Replace the Rear Panel.


YES

Connect a Crossed Network Cable


between the Scanner and your PC/
Laptop.
Try to ping from the PC/Laptop to
LOGIQ™ P5/A5.
If OK, the hardware connection
inside LOGIQ™ P5/A5 is OK.

Figure 7-22 Network Troubleshooting

7 - 36 Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

This page was intentionally left blank.

Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree 7 - 37


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7 - 38 Section 7-7 - Trouble Shooting Tree


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Chapter 8
Replacement Procedures

Section 8-1
Overview
8-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 8
This chapter describes replacement procedures for the following modules and subsystems.

Section Description Page Number

8-1 Overview 8-1

8-2 DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8-2

8-3 Software Loading Procedure 8-111

8-4 Installing Base Software Load Image 8-121

8-5 Full backup/Restore procedure 8-143

8-6 Software Reloading 8-148

Table 8-1 Contents in Chapter 8

Section 8-1 - Overview 8-1


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 8-2 DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY

WARNING ONLY QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL SHOULD REMOVE ANY COVERS OR


PANELS. ELECTRICAL HAZARDS EXISTS AT SEVERAL POINTS INSIDE. BECOME
THOROUGHLY FAMILIAR WITH ALL HAZARDOUS VOLTAGES AND HIGH CURRENT
LEVELS TO AVOID ACCIDENTAL CONTACT

CAUTION Do not wear the ESD wrist strap when you remove a part of power supply unit. Turn OFF power
and unplug the power cord before removing a part of power supply unit. However be sure to turn
off power and wear the strap before you remove a circuit boards.

WARNING DO NOT SERVICE OR DISASSEMBLE PARTS UNDER FRU UNIT LEVEL AT ANY
CIRCUMSTANCES.

8-2 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-1 LCD Panel with filter

8-2-1-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench

8-2-1-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.
• Maneuver control console to a suitable position for removing the monitor.

NOTE: Removal procedure for both LCD panel with flexible arm and LCD panel with standard arm are same

8-2-1-3 Removal procedure


1.) Flip down the monitor. Remove the AC connector bracket and unplug the AC power plug and DVI
connector. Refer to Figure 8-1

Figure 8-1 Remove PWR Conn Bracket and Connectors

2.) Unscrew 2 hex screw on the hinge after unplug power connector and DVI connector.

NOTE: During unscrew the hinge hexa screw, keep hold the monitor to prevent drop down.

Figure 8-2 Hexa screw of monitor hinge


Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8-3
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) Place the LCD Monitor assy on the top of the table to remove LCD Panel with filter.

Figure 8-3 Placing the LCD Monitor Assy

4.) Unscrew 4 screws (1-4) on the bracket. Refer to the figure below.

(1) (3)

(2) (4)

Figure 8-4 Unscrews 4 screws

5.) Disconnect the connector located at the OSD PCB panel. Refer to the figure below.

Connector

Figure 8-5 Disconnect the connector

8-4 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-2 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


15" LCDMON II Assy & LCD Panel with filter 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-1. Equipment
Section 4-6-1 Function Validation Procedure passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)

8-2-1-4 Mounting procedure


1.) Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8-5


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-2 LCD Plastic filter

8-2-2-1 Tools
• Common philips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench
• Stubby screwdriver (Flat tip and Cross tip)

8-2-2-2 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the LP6 Monitor cover set. Refer to 8-2-3 "LP5 / LA5 Monitor Cover set (FRU No.101)" on
page 8-8 and the figure below.
2.) Remove the LCD Plastic filter. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-6 Removing the LCD plastic filter

3.) Put the LCD plastic filter on the LCD monitor after detaching the tape of the LCD plastic filter. Refer
to the figure below.

Figure 8-7 Putting the LCD plastic filter on the LCD monitor
8-6 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-2-2 Removal procedure (cont’d)


4.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-3 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


LCD plastic filter Function Validation 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-2. Equipment
Section 4-8-2 Procedure passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-2-3 Mounting Procedure


1.) Install the LCD monitor cover parts in the reverse order of removal procedure. Refer to 8-2-3 "LP5
/ LA5 Monitor Cover set (FRU No.101)" on page 8-8.
2.) Put the label on the rear of the LCD monitor. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-8 Putting the label on the rear of the LCD monitor

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8-7


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-3 Monitor cover set

8-2-3-1 Tools
• Common pilIips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench
• Stubby screwdriver (Flat tip and Cross tip)

8-2-3-2 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the LCD cable cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-9 Removing the LCD cable cover

2.) Unscrew 1 screw (2306565, BH M4x16 WHT) to remove the power cord bracket assembled under
the LCD cable cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-10 Removing the power cord bracket

8-8 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-3-2 Removal procedure (cont’d)


3.) Disconnect power cable and DVI cable. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-11 Disconnecting power cable and DVI cable

4.) Unscrew 2 screws(5177684, HSH M5x20 WHT) to separate LCD monitor. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-12 Separating the LCD monitor

5.) Unscrew 4 screws to remove the LCD rear cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-13 Removing the LCD rear cover

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8-9


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-3-2 Removal procedure (cont’d)


6.) Unscrew 4 screws to remove the OSD key assy and disconnect the connect. Refer to the figure
below.

Figure 8-14 Separating the OSD key assy

7.) Separate the LCD tact knob and LCD lamp window from the OSD key assy. Refer to the figure
below.

Figure 8-15 Separating the LCD tact knob and LCD lamp window

8.) Unscrew 5 screws to remove LCD front cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-16 Removing the LCD front cover

8 - 10 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-3-2 Removal procedure (cont’d)


9.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-4 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


LCD plastic filter Function Validation 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-3. Equipment
Section 4-8-2 Procedure passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-3-3 Mounting Procedure


Install the each of the new part in the reverse order of removal procedure.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 11


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-4 OSD button and lamp set, LCD Plastic Filter

8-2-4-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-4-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.
• Maneuver control console to a suitable position for removing the monitor.

8-2-4-3 Removal procedure


1.) Unscrew 4 screws (1-4) from the LCD front cover. Refer to the figure below.

(1) (2) (3) (4)

Figure 8-17 Unscrews 4 screws

2.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-5 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


15" OSD Key Assy Function Validation 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-4. Equipment
Section 4-6-2 Procedure passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-4-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 12 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-5 LCD Std Arm with Cover

8-2-5-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench

8-2-5-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.
• Maneuver control console to a suitable position for removing the monitor.

8-2-5-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Power Cable, DVI Cable.

POWER CABLE DVI CABLE

Figure 8-18 Removing the Cable

2.) Unscrew 1 screw to remove the LCD arm cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-19 Unscrews 1 screw

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 13


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-6 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


Flexible LCD Arm Function Validation 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-5. Equipment
Section 4-8-8 Procedure passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-5-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 14 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-6 Monitor Assy

8-2-6-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench

8-2-6-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.
• Maneuver control console to a suitable position for removing the monitor.

8-2-6-3 Removal procedure


1.) Detach the monitor assy from arm.
- Open monitor cable cover
- Unscrew a screw of the power connector fixture bracket
- Unplug the power plug and DVI connector
- Flip down the monitor
- Unscrew the 2 hexa screw of the monitor hinge

Figure 8-20 Disassemble Monitor from STD arm

While unscrew the hinge hexa screw from the arm, keep hold the monitor to prevent drop down.

2.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-7 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


15" LCDMON II Assy & LCD Panel with filter 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-6. Equipment
Section 4-6-1 passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Function Validation Procedure

Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)

8-2-6-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 15


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-7 Flexible LCD Arm Removal Procedure

8-2-7-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench
• Stubby screwdriver (Flat tip and Cross tip)

8-2-7-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.
• Maneuver control console to a suitable position for removing the monitor.

8-2-7-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the LCD cable cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-21 Removing the LCD cover

2.) Unscrew 1 screw(2306565, BH M4x16 WHT) to remove the power cord bracket assembled under
the LCD cable cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-22 Removing the power cord bracket

8 - 16 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) Disconnect power cable and DVI cable. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-23 Disconnecting power cable and DVI cable

NOTE: While unscrewing the hinge hexa screw from the arm, keep hold of the monitor to prevent
dropping down.

4.) Unscrew 4 screws(2159634, BH M4x10 WHT) after removing the rubber caps to remove neck front
cover, neck rear cover and LCD arm cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-24 Unscrewing 4 screws from neck cover, neck rear cover and LCD arm cover

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 17


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5.) Unscrew 1 screw (5176629, HSH M6X10). Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-25 Unscrewing 1 screw

6.) Separate the LCD monitor with LCD arm bottom parts. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-26 Separating the LCD monitor

7.) Unscrew 3screws(2327578, HSH M6X16) after removing the op spacer. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-27 Removing the op spacer

8 - 18 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8.) Detach the flex dummy label. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-28 Detaching the flex dummy label

9.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-8 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


Flexible LCD Arm Function Validation 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-7. Equipment
Section 4-8-8 passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Procedure

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 19


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-7-4 Assembly procedure


First, remove LP5/LA5 Main K/B Assy and LP5/LA5 Sub K/B Assy

1.) Change the MON PWR CONN LONG cable and remove the cable tie of the DVI cable for flexible
arm. Refer to the figure below.

MON PWR CONN LONG cable

Figure 8-29 Changing the MON PWR CONN LONG cable

8 - 20 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

2.) Assemble the LCD locking mechanism.


a.) Put the stopper pin inside the spring and then put them inside the spring holder. Fix it with
spring pin. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-30 Assembling the spring holder Assy

b.) Put lock tite 290 on the M16 tap of the spring holder Assy and screw it. Refer to the figure
below.

Figure 8-31 Screwing the spring holder Assy

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 21


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

b-1) Put lock tite 290 on the inside of M16 nut and screw it on the reverse side of spring holder
Assy. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-32 Screwing the spring holder Assy

b-2) Mold die of AL neck frame modified as seen in the figure below does not need a nut.

Figure 8-33 Screwing the spring holder Assy

8 - 22 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

c.) Insert holder grip as seen the picture below and fix it with 2set screws(2327580, M2.6X4).
Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-34 Assembling the holder grip

3.) Insert two of the flexible arm stoppers (A+B) to the Power Cable and DVI cable in the Order
illustrated on the figure below. Make sure that chamfered shape of the flexible Arm stopper should
face inside. Refer to the figure below.

Flexible Arm Stopper

Figure 8-35 Inserting cables to the flexible arm stopper

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 23


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Insert oilless bush into the flexible arm neck pipe and insert two cables into the flexible arm neck
pipe. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-36 Inserting the oilless bush

5.) Insert the flexible arm into the flexible arm neck pipe. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-37 Inserting the flexible arm

6.) Screw 3 screws (2373562, FH M4X10 YEL) to fix the flexible arm stopper after adjusting the holes.
Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-38 Fixing the flexible arm stopper

8 - 24 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7.) Screw 1 screw (2159625, PH M4X8 W/SP) to install OP bracket. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-39 Installing OP Bracket

8.) Screw 3 screws (2327578, HSH M6X16) to install the arm neck pipe. Make sure place DVI cable
be on the right side, power cable on the left side. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-40 Assembling the arm neck pipe

9.) Screw 2 screws (5177684, HSH M5X20 WHT) to assemble the LCD monitor with flexible arm Top
part. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-41 Screwing 2 screws

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 25


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10.)Insert the two cables inside the Flexible arm and Screw 4 screws (2159625, PH M4X8 W/SP) to
assemble the Lower arm cable bracket

Figure 8-42 Screwing 4 screws

9.) Put in the two cables. Refer to the figure below. Make sure place DVI cable be on the right side,
power cable on the left side.

Figure 8-43 Putting in the cables

11.)Screw 2 screws (2159626, PH M4X20) to assemble the Arm stopper. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-44 Installing the Arm stopper

8 - 26 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

12.)Screw 2 screws (2159625, PH M4X8 W/SP) to assemble the Lower arm guide bracket.
Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-45 Assembling the Lower arm guide bracket

13.)Tie the Cables with Cable tie. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-46 Tying the cables

14.)Place the cables inside the slot and connect power cable and DVI cable Refer to the Figure below.

Figure 8-47 Placing the Cables

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 27


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

15.)Assemble the Cable bracket with 1 Screw (2159625, PH M4X8 W/SP)

Figure 8-48 Assembling the Cable bracket

16.)Screw 2 screws (2159634, BH M4X10 WHT) to assemble the Arm Cable Cover. Refer to the figure
below.

Figure 8-49 Assembling the Arm Cable Cover

16.) Place the cables like the figure below.

Figure 8-50 Placing the cables

8 - 28 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

17.)Screw 1 screw (2306565, BH M4X16 WHT) to fix the Power cable. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-51 Assembling the power cord bracket

18.)Assemble the LCD cable cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-52 Assembling the LCD cable cover

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 29


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

19.)Screw 3 screws (2159634, BH M4x10 WHT) after placing the neck front cover and neck Rear cover.
Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-53 Assembling the neck front cover and the neck rear cover

20.)Screw 1 screw (2159625, PH M4X8 W/SP) to assemble the Lock Knob.

Figure 8-54 Assembling the Lock Knob

8 - 30 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

21.)Screw 1 screw (2329677, TAP M4X16) to assemble the Lock Cover.

Figure 8-55 Assembling the Lock Cover

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 31


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

22.)Screw 2 screws (2159632, BH M4X6 WHT) to assemble the Cam Cover L & R.

Figure 8-56 Assembling the Cam Cover L & R

23.)Screw 1 screw (2329677, TAP M4X16) to assemble the Fold Cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-57 Assembling the Fold Cover

8 - 32 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

24.)Screw 2 screws (2337572, FH M3X6 WHT) to assemble the Arm cover L & R. Refer to the figure
below.

Figure 8-58 Assembling the Arm Cover L & R

25.)Screw 4 screws (2159634, BH M4X10 WHT) to assemble the Arm bottom Cover. Refer to the figure
below.

Figure 8-59 Assembling the Arm bottom cover

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 33


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

26.)Completed picture of the Flexible Arm.

Figure 8-60 Flexible Arm

8 - 34 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-8 Main Keyboard Assy

8-2-8-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-8-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-8-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the 3 Probe holders & Cup holder from the keyboard. Refer to the Figure 8-61.

Figure 8-61 Removing holders

2.) Unscrew 4 screws from the bottom front of the keyboard. Refer to the Figure 8-62.

(2) (3)

(1) (4)

Figure 8-62 Unscrews 4 screws

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 35


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) Unscrew 2 screws from the rear side of the keyboard. Refer to the Figure 8-63.

(1) (2)

Figure 8-63 Unscrews 2 screws

4.) Lift the top cover of the keyboard and disconnect 4 cables from the keyboard. Refer to the Figure
8-64.

Figure 8-64 Lifting the top cover & Disconnecting 5 Cables

8 - 36 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-9 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

Main Keyboard Assy Function Validation “Service Manual, Direction


Section 4-7-1 Procedure
5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-8. Equipment
Section 4-3-4 System B/M-Mode Checks passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 4-3-5 System CFM and PWD Checks

Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)

8-2-8-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 37


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-9 Sub Keyboard Assy

8-2-9-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-9-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-9-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Main Keyboard Assy. Refer to 8-2-7 "LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Main Keyboard Assy (FRU
No.200)" on page 8-29.
2.) Unscrew 4 screws (1-4). 2 screws(1-2) are back side or the speaker and 2 screws(3-4) are bttom
of sub keyboard. Refer to the Figure 8-65.

(1) (2)

(3) (4)

Figure 8-65 4 Screw Sub Keyboard Assy

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-10 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown
5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-9. Equipment
Sub Keyboard Assy Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 4-7-2
Procedure

8 - 38 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-9-4 Mounting Procedure


1.) The product emblem is attached on the sub keyboard, so proper emblem should be attached on the
sub keyboard when replace the sub keyboard. The sub keyboard FRU include 3 kinds of emblem
which are silver color font and gold color font and hologram font. Refer to Figure 8-66.

Figure 8-66 3 emblems

2.) Attache proper product emblem as same as install base system before assemble the sub keyboard
assy. Refer to the Figure 8-67.

Figure 8-67 Emblem on Sub Keyboard

3.) Refer Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 39


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-10 Trackball Assy

8-2-10-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-10-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-10-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Main Keyboard Assy. Refer to 8-2-7 "LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Main Keyboard Assy (FRU
No.200)" on page 8-29.

connector

4 screws

Figure 8-68 Screws and connector for Trackball

2.) Unscrew 4 screws (1-4) and disconnect the cable. Refer to the Figure 8-68.
3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-11 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-10. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 4-7-3 Trackball Assy validation

8-2-10-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 40 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-11 English, Greek, Russian, Swedish, Norweigian A/N Key assy

8-2-11-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-11-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-11-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Main Keyboard Assy. Refer to 8-2-7 "LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Main Keyboard Assy (FRU
No.200)" on page 8-29.

Figure 8-69 A/N Key in keboard

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 41


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

2.) Remove USB PCB by unscrewing 6 screws (1-6) and disconnecting the 6 cables. Refer to the
Figure 8-70.

Connectors
1~3 Connector 3
4~ 6

Figure 8-70 USB PCB

3.) Unscrew 6 screws from the back side of the A/N key assy. Refer to the Figure 8-71.

1 2 3

4 5 6

Figure 8-71 Screws on the A/N Key

4.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-12 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-11. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 4-7-4 A/N Key assy validation

8-2-11-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 42 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-12 Freeze key assy

8-2-12-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-12-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-12-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Main Keyboard Assy. Refer to 8-2-8 "Main Keyboard Assy" on page 8-35.

Figure 8-72 Freeze Key in the main keyboard

2.) Remove the 3 screws (1-3) and disconnect 1 cable. Refer to the figure below.

2
1
1

connector

Figure 8-73 Freeze Key connector

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 43


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-13 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-12. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 4-7-5 Freeze key validation

8-2-12-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 44 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-13 TGC key assy / TGC Knob Set

8-2-13-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-13-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-13-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the CFUNCKEY Assy. Refer to 8-2-8 "Main Keyboard Assy" on page 8-35.
2.) Remove the TGC Knobs. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-74 8 TGC Knobs

3.) Unscrew 4 screws (1-4). Refer to figure below.

1 2

3 4

Figure 8-75 TGC PCB Assy in Keyboard

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 45


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Disconnect 1 connector from the PCB. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-76 TGC Key Connector

5.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-14 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-13. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 4-7-6 TGC key assay / TGC Knob Set validation

8-2-13-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 46 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-14 Sub Keyboard Encoder Knob Set

8-2-14-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-14-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-14-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove all the Endoder Knobs from the keyboard.

Figure 8-77 Knob in Sub Keyboard

2.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-15 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-14. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 4-7-7 Sub Keyboard Encoder Knob Set validation

8-2-14-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 47


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-15 Keycap set, Main Keyboard Encoder Knob set

8-2-15-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-15-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-15-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove key caps from the keyboard.

Figure 8-78 Key Caps

2.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-16 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

TGC key assy/TGD Knob Set, Sub keyboard “Service Manual, Direction
encoder Knob Set, Keycap set, Main Keyboard 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-15. Equipment
Section 4-8-4 passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Encoder Knob set Function Validation
Procedure

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-15-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 48 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-16 Side Left Cover

8-2-16-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-16-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-16-3 Removal procedure


1.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2). Refer to the figure below.

(1)

(2)

Figure 8-79 2 screw on Side left cover

2.) Remove the left cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-80 Open Side left cover

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-17 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-16. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-16-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.
Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 49
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-17 Side Right Cover

8-2-17-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-17-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-17-3 Removal procedure


1.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2). Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-81 2 screw on side right cover

2.) Remove the Right cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-82 Open side right cover

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-18 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-17. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-17-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.
8 - 50 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-18 Front Cover

8-2-18-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-18-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-18-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Left, and Right side covers. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49 and 8-2-
17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
2.) Remove the dummy left and right covers. Refer to Figure 8-83.
3.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) from the left side of the front cover.

Figure 8-83 Screws of Dummy Cover

4.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) from the right side of the Front cover. Refer to the Figure 8-84.

Figure 8-84 Screws of the front cover

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 51


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5.) Remove the front cover.

Figure 8-85 Removal of front cover

6.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-19 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-18. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-18-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 52 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-19 Rear Cover

8-2-19-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-19-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-19-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Left, and Right side covers. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49 and 8-2-
17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
2.) Remove 4 rubber caps from the rear cover of the system. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-86 4 rubber caps on Rear Cover

3.) Unscrew 4 screws (1-4) from the rear cover. Refer to the figure below.

(1) (2)

(3) (4)

Figure 8-87 4 screws on rear cover

4.) Remove the Rear Cover

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 53


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-20 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-19. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-19-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 54 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-20 Middle Cover

8-2-20-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Stubby screwdriver (Flat tip and Cross tip)

8-2-20-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-20-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Left, and Right side covers. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49 and 8-2-
17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50. And Remove the Rear Cover. Refer to 8-2-19 "Rear Cover" on
page 8-53.
2.) Remove 2 rubber caps (1-2) from the middle cover of the system. Refer to the figure below.

2
1

Figure 8-88 2 rubber cap of middle cover

3.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) from the middle cover. Refer to the figure below.

1 2

Figure 8-89 2 screws of middle cover

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 55


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-21 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-20. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-20-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 56 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-21 Top Cover

8-2-21-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-21-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-21-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Dummy Cover L/R. Refer to 8-2-26 "Dummy Cover L / R" on page 8-64.
2.) Remove the Top Buttom Cover. Refer to 8-2-22 "Top Bottom Cover" on page 8-58.
3.) Remove 2 rubber caps (1-2) from the top cover of the system and unscrew 2 screws (1-2). Refer to
the figure below.

(1) (2)

Figure 8-90 2 rubber caps of top cover

4.) Unscrew 5 screws (1-5) from the bottom of the top cover.
5.) Remove the Top Cover.
6.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-22 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-21. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-21-4 Mounting Procedure


7.)

8-2-21-5 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 57


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-22 Top Bottom Cover

8-2-22-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Stubby screwdriver (Flat tip and Cross tip)

8-2-22-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-22-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Dummy Cover L/R. Refer to 8-2-26 "Dummy Cover L / R" on page 8-64.
2.) Unscrew 7 screws (1-7) from the bottom of the top cover. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-91 Top bottom cover

3.) Remove the Top Buttom Cover.


4.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-23 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-22. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-22-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 58 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-23 Pole Cover

8-2-23-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-23-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-23-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Dummy Cover L/R. Refer to 8-2-26 "Dummy Cover L / R" on page 8-64.
2.) Remove the Top Buttom Cover. Refer to 8-2-22 "Top Bottom Cover" on page 8-58.
3.) Remove the Top Cover. Refer to 8-2-21 "Top Cover" on page 8-57.
4.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2). Refer to the figure below.

(1) (2)

Figure 8-92 Pole Cover

5.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-24 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-23. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-23-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 59


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-24 Neck Front

8-2-24-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-24-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-24-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove 1 rubber cap. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-93 rubber cap of neck front cover

2.) Unscrew 1 screw and remove the Neck Front. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-94 Open neck front cover

8 - 60 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-25 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-24. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-24-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 61


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-25 Neck Rear

8-2-25-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-25-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-25-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove 2 rubber caps (1-2). Refer to the figure below.

(1)

(2)

Figure 8-95 rubber cap of neck rear cover

2.) Unscrew 2 screws and remove the Neck Rear. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-96 Open neck rear cover

8 - 62 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-26 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-25. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-25-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 63


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-26 Dummy Cover L / R

8-2-26-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-26-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-26-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove 2 rubber caps (1-2). Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-97 rubber cap of dummy cover

2.) Unscrew 2 screws and remove the dummy cover L. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-98 screws of dummy cover

3.) Same process is applied for dummy cover R.

8 - 64 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-27 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-26. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-26-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 65


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-27 EMI Cover L

8-2-27-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-27-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-27-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Side Left Cover. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49
2.) Unscrew 6 screws (1-6). Refer to the Figure 8-99.

Figure 8-99 EMI Cover L

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-28 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-27. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-27-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 66 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-28 EMI Cover R

8-2-28-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-28-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-28-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Side Right Cover. Refer to 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
2.) Unscrew 9 screws (1-9). Refer to the Figure 8-100.

Figure 8-100 EMI Cover R

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-29 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-28. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-28-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 67


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-29 APS Assy

8-2-29-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Nipper

8-2-29-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-29-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Side Left Cover. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49.
2.) Remove the EMI Cover L. Refer to 8-2-27 "EMI Cover L" on page 8-66.
3.) Remove Hard Disk assy to unplug the APS connectors on backplane easily.
- Unplug the HDD power connector on the HDD and the SATA connector from the bottom side
of the backplane. Pull out the connector.
4.) Unscrew 4 screws of the HDD bracket. Refer Figure 8-101.

Figure 8-101 Remove HDD

5.) Unplug the DC power connector from DVD RW drive.


6.) The APS assy have 5 connectors, 3 connectors are pluged on backplane and 1 connector is
connected to nest cooling fan power and 1 connector is AC power connector.

8 - 68 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-29-3 Removal procedure (cont’d)


7.) Unplug 3 connectors from the backplane and disconnect the 3P AC connector near bottom of the
backplane and disconnect the 2P connector near the nest cooling fan. Refer to the Figure 8-102.

Cut the tie wrap

Figure 8-102 APS Connectors of backplane

8.) Remove the Side Right Cover. Refer to 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
9.) Remove the EMI Cover R. Refer to 8-2-28 "EMI Cover R" on page 8-67.
10.)Unplug the J14 connector and unscrew 2 screws (1-2). Pull out the APS assy carefully. During take
oyt the APS assy, the power connector on the backplane side should be passed through the square
hole on the backplane. Refer to theFigure 8-103.

Figure 8-103 Pull out the APS Assy

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 69


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

11.)Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-30 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

Section 4-9-4 APS Assy PCB Function Validation Procedure “Service Manual, Direction
5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-29. Equipment
Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4) passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

Section 10-6 Using a Phantom

8-2-29-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 70 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-30 CL1TRX Assy / BL1TRX Assy

8-2-30-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-30-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-30-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Side Right Cover. Refer to 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
2.) Remove the EMI Cover R. Refer to 8-2-28 "EMI Cover R" on page 8-67.
3.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) and eject the PCB. Refer to the Figure 8-104.

Figure 8-104 Eject ASIG Assy

4.) The CL1TRX(BL1TRX) board is loacted on the most left slot in the nest box.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 71


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5.) Pull the CL1TRX Assy out. Refer to the Figure 8-105.

Figure 8-105 Eject the CL1TRX(BL1TRX) Board

6.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-31 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

CL1TRX Assy / BL1TRX Assy Function


Section 4-9-1
Validation Procedure “Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-4 System B/M-Mode Checks 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-30. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 4-3-5 System CFM and PWD Checks

Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)

Section 10-6 Using a Phantom

8-2-30-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 72 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-31 P3RLY / P2RLY Assy & P2RLY with Dummy

8-2-31-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-31-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-31-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the side right cover. Refer to 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
2.) Remove the side left cover. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49.
3.) Remove the Front Cover. Refer to 8-2-18 "Front Cover" on page 8-51.
4.) Remove the ASIG Board. Refer to 8-2-36 "ASIG Assy" on page 8-83.
5.) Unscrew 8 screws (1-8) and remove the metal cover. Refer to the Figure 8-106.

(2)
(1)

(3)
(8)

(5) (4)
(7)
(6)

Figure 8-106 RLY Cover

6.) Unscrew 6 screws (1-6) and remove the PCB. Refer to the Figure 8-107.

(1) (2) (3)

(4) (5) (6)

Figure 8-107 Screws of the RLY board

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 73


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-32 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

P3RLY,P2RLY and P2RLY with Dummy Assy


Section 4-9-5 function check procedure
“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-4 System B/M-Mode Checks
5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-31. Equipment
Section 4-3-5 System CFM and PWD Checks passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)

Section 10-5-7 Probe Maintenance

Section 10-6 Using a Phantom

8-2-31-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 74 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-32 Backplane Assy

8-2-32-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-32-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-32-3 Removal procedure


1.) To detache the backplane, all pwas in the cardcage should be removed from cardcage.
2.) Open the Side Left Cover and Side Right Cover. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49
and 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
3.) Open the EMI Cover L and EMI Cover R. Refer to 8-2-27 "EMI Cover L" on page 8-66 and 8-2-28
"EMI Cover R" on page 8-67.
4.) Remove all pwas from the nest box. Refer to Figure 8-108.

Figure 8-108 PWAs in the nest box

5.) Open the front cover. Refer to 8-2-18 "Front Cover" on page 8-51.
6.) Remove the P3RLY / P2RLY Board. Refer to 8-2-31 "P3RLY / P2RLY Assy & P2RLY with Dummy"
on page 8-73.
7.) Remove the DVD, HDD. Refer to 8-2-44 "DVD R/W Drive" on page 8-93 and 8-2-48 "SATA HDD
Assy" on page 8-100.
8.) Unplug all the cable connectors all in Backplane Assy.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 75


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

9.) Unscrew 16 screws from the Backplane Assy. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-109 Backplane

10.)Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-33 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

BackPlane Assy Function Validation


Section 4-9-8 “Service Manual, Direction
Procedure
5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-32. Equipment
Section 4-3-4 System B/M-Mode Checks passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 4-3-5 System CFM and PWD Checks

Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)

8-2-32-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 76 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-33 ACWD Assy

8-2-33-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-33-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-33-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Side Right Cover. Refer to 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
2.) Remove the EMI Cover R. Refer to 8-2-28 "EMI Cover R" on page 8-67.
3.) Remove the ASIG Board. Refer to 8-2-36 "ASIG Assy" on page 8-83.
4.) Pull the ACWD assy out from Nest box. Teh ACWD assy is loacted in slot #2. Refer to the Figure
8-110.

Figure 8-110 PWAs in Nest Box

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 77


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-34 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

Section 4-9-8 ACWD Assy Function Validation Procedure


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-5 System CFM and PWD Checks 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-33. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

Section 10-6 Using a Phantom

8-2-33-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 78 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-34 SYSCON PM Assy/SYSCON CM Assy

8-2-34-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-34-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-34-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Side Right Cover. Refer to 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
2.) Remove the EMI Cover R. Refer to 8-2-28 "EMI Cover R" on page 8-67.
3.) Remove the SYSCONPM(SYSCONCM) assy in slot #3 in the nest box.Refer to the Figure 8-111.

Figure 8-111 PWAs in Nest Box

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 79


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-35 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

SYSCONML Assy Function Validation


Section 4-9-3 Procedure

Section 4-3-4 System B/M-Mode Checks


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-5 System CFM and PWD Checks
5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-34. Equipment
Section 4-5 Peripheral Checks passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)

Section 10-5-2-2 Peripheral/Option Checks

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

Section 10-6 Using a Phantom

8-2-34-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 80 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-35 PM SOM Assy with 1G/ CM SOM Assy with 512M

8-2-35-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-35-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-35-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Side Right Cover. Refer to 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
2.) Remove the EMI Cover R. Refer to 8-2-28 "EMI Cover R" on page 8-67.
3.) Remove the SYSCOM PM / CM Assy. Refer to 8-2-34 "SYSCON PM Assy/SYSCON CM Assy" on
page 8-79.
4.) Unscrews 4 screws. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-112 4 screws for SOM on SYSCON

5.) Remove the SOM Assy. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-113 Detache the SOM from SYSCON PWA

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 81


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-36 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

Section 4-9-6 SOM Function Validation Procedure

Section 4-3-4 System B/M-Mode Checks


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-5 System CFM and PWD Checks 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-35. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 4-5 Peripheral Checks

Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)

Section 10-5-2-2 Peripheral/Option Checks

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-35-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 82 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-36 ASIG Assy

8-2-36-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-36-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-36-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Side Right Cover. Refer to 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
2.) Remove the EMI Cover R. Refer to 8-2-28 "EMI Cover R" on page 8-67.
3.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) and eject the PCB. Refer to the Figure 8-114.

(1) (2)

Figure 8-114 Eject the ASIG

4.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-37 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

Section 4-9-16 ASIG ASSY Function Validation Procedure


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-4 System B/M-Mode Checks 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-36. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 4-3-5 System CFM and PWD Checks

Section 10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)

Section 10-6 Using a Phantom

8-2-36-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 83


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-37 Front Caster / Rear Caster


NOTE: Both Front Casters and Rear Casters are swivel type in LOGIQ™ P5 but in LOGIQ™ A5, only
Front Casters are swivel type (Rear Casters are "Fixed" type).

8-2-37-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench

8-2-37-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-37-3 Removal procedure


1.) Unscrew 8 screws (1A-8A) to remove the front caster. Refer to the figure below.
2.) Unscrew 8 screws (1-8) to remove the rear caster. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-115 Casters

8 - 84 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-38 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


Front caster/Rear caster Function Validation 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-37. Equipment
Section 4-8-6 Procedure passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-37-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 85


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-38 Rear Handle

8-2-38-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench

8-2-38-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-38-3 Removal procedure


1.) Unscrew 1 screw. Remove the Handle Dumy brkt.

Figure 8-116 Handle Dummy Bracket

2.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) from the back of the rear handle. Refer to the Figure 8-117..

(1) (2)

Figure 8-117 Rear Handle

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-39 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-38. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-38-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 86 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-39 Rear Hook

8-2-39-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-39-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-39-3 Removal procedure


1.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) and remove Rear hook.

Figure 8-118 Screws on rear hook

2.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) and remove.

Figure 8-119 Screws on the rear hook fix brkt

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 87


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-40 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-39. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-39-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 88 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-40 Probe Holder

8-2-40-1 Tools
• No need tool

8-2-40-2 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the probe holders from the Keyboard. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-120 Probe Holders

2.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-41 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-40. Equipment
Section 4-8-7 Probe holder Function Validation Procedure passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-40-3 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 89


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-41 Cup Holder

8-2-41-1 Tools
• No need tool

8-2-41-2 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the cup holder. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-121 Cup holder

2.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-42 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-41. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-41-3 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 90 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-42 ECG Cable Hook

8-2-42-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-42-2 Removal procedure


1.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) to remove the ECG Cable Hook. Refer to the Figure 8-122.

(1) (2)
Figure 8-122 Screws of cable hook

2.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-43 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-42. Equipment
Section 4-8-1 Cover Parts Function Validation passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-42-3 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 91


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-43 Air Filter Set

8-2-43-1 Tools
• No need tool

8-2-43-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-43-3 Removal procedure


1.) Pull out the 2 Air filters from the bottom left and right side of the system (1-2).Refer to the Figure 8-
123.

(1) (2)

Figure 8-123 Air filters

2.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-44 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-43. Equipment
Section 4-8-3 Air filter set Function Validation Procedure passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-43-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 92 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-44 DVD R/W Drive

8-2-44-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-44-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-44-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the side left cover. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49.
2.) Remove EMI L Cover. Refer to 8-2-27 "EMI Cover L" on page 8-66.
3.) Remove the HDD assy. Refer to the 8-2-48 "SATA HDD Assy" on page 8-100.
4.) Disconnect 1 connector from the back of the DVD RW Drive. Refer to the Figure 8-124.

Figure 8-124 DVD RW Power Connector

5.) Disconnect additional connector from the back of the DVD RW Drive. Refer to the Figure 8-125.

Figure 8-125 EIDE connector of DVD RW

6.) Remove the Front Cover. Refer to 8-2-18 "Front Cover" on page 8-51.
Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 93
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7.) Unscrew the 4 screws on the front of the DVDRW drive.

Figure 8-126 Screws on the DVDRW fixture

8.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-45 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-44. Equipment
Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

8-2-44-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 94 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-45 Nest Fan Assy

8-2-45-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-45-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-45-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the Left Cover. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49.
2.) Remove the EMI Cover Left. Refer to 8-2-27 "EMI Cover L" on page 8-66.
3.) Unplug the Connection. Refer to the Figure 8-127.

Figure 8-127 Power connector of Nest fan

4.) Remove the Right Cover. Refer to 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
5.) Remove the EMI Cover Right. Refer to 8-2-28 "EMI Cover R" on page 8-67.
6.) Unscrews 2 screws. Refer to the Figure 8-128.

Figure 8-128 2 screws on the Nest Fan

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 95


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7.) Remove the Nest fan assy. Refer to the Figure 8-129.

Figure 8-129 Pull out the nest fan

8.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-46 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-45. Equipment
Section 4-9-9 Nest fan Function Validation Procedure passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

8-2-45-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 96 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-46 ARP Assy 110V/220V

8-2-46-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-46-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-46-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove side right cover and EMI cover. Refer ro 8-2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50 and 8-2-
28 "EMI Cover R" on page 8-67.
2.) Remove the Rear Cover. Refer to 8-2-19 "Rear Cover" on page 8-53.
3.) Unscrew 4 screws (1-4). Refer to the Figure 8-130.

(1)
(2)

(3) (4)

Figure 8-130 Screws of the rear panel

4.) Disconnect J15 connector. Refer to the Figure 8-131.

Figure 8-131 AEXP Cable of rear panel

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 97


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5.) Disconnect three (3) USB connectors or 5 USB connectors from the rear panel and 2 AC power
connector. The 4D controller USB and ECG USB connector also connect to this rear paenl PWA.
Refer to the Figure 8-132.

Figure 8-132 Open Rear Panel

6.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-47 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

Section 4-9-15 ARP Assy Function Validation Procedure


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-5 Peripheral Checks
5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-46. Equipment
Section 10-5-2-2 Peripheral/Option Checks passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

Outlet Test - Wiring Arrangement - USA &


Section 10-6-3
Canada

8-2-46-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 98 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-47 Cable Arm Hook

8-2-47-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-47-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-47-3 Removal procedure


Refer to the Mechanical Option Manual described at the end of this chapter.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 99


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-48 SATA HDD Assy

8-2-48-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers

8-2-48-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-48-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the side left cover. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49.
2.) Remove EMI L Cover. Refer to 8-2-27 "EMI Cover L" on page 8-66.
3.) Disconnect HDD power connectors from the back of the hard disk assy and unplug the SATA
connector from the backplane on the bottom of backplane. Refer to the Figure 8-133.

Figure 8-133 HDD in System

4.) Unscrew 4 screws of the HDD fixture bracket


5.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-48 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-48. Equipment
Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

8-2-48-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 100 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-49 ACPC Assy

8-2-49-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench
• Stubby screwdriver (Flat tip and Cross tip)

8-2-49-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-49-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the AC Input Box Assy. Refer to 8-2-50 "Transbox Assy 110V/220V" on page 8-103.
2.) Disconnect 5 connectors. Refer to the Figure 8-134.

Figure 8-134 ACPC in Transbox

3.) Unscrew 5 screws to remove the ACPC Assy. Refer to the Figure 8-135.

Figure 8-135 Screws of ACPC assy

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 101


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-49 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

Section 4-9-12 ACPC Assy set Function Validation Procedure

Section 10-5-2-2 Peripheral/Option Checks

Section 10-5-5 Physical Inspection

Section 10-6-2 GEMS Leakage Current Limits


“Service Manual, Direction
Outlet Test - Wiring Arrangement - USA &
Section 10-6-3 Canada 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-49. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 10-6-4 Grounding Continuity

Section 10-6-5 Chassis Leakage Current Test

Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead


Section 10-6-6
to Ground

Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead


Section 10-6-7
to Lead

Section 10-6-9 Probe Leakage Current Test

8-2-49-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

8 - 102 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-50 Transbox Assy 110V/220V

8-2-50-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench

8-2-50-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-50-3 Removal procedure


- To detache the AC Power assy, All open 4 pcs console cover that are left, right, front, rear
cover
1.) Remove side left cover and right side cover. Refer to 8-2-16 "Side Left Cover" on page 8-49 and 8-
2-17 "Side Right Cover" on page 8-50.
2.) Remove rear side cover and front cover. Refet to 8-2-18 "Front Cover" on page 8-51 and 8-2-19
"Rear Cover" on page 8-53.
3.) Unscrew 2 pcs M4 screw and 2 pcs hexa screw on the front of AC trans box. And unscrew 4 pcs
screw and 2pcs hexa screw on the rear side of Transbox assy and open inlet panel. Refer to Figure
8-136.

2 hexa Screws

Figure 8-136 4 screw on the front of the AC transbox assy

4.) Unplug 4 connectors inside of AC transbox and pull out the transbox assy
5.) Pull out the tranbox assy.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 103


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6.) Unplug 4 connectors inside of AC transbox and pull out the transbox assy.

Figure 8-137 Pull out the Transbox assy

7.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-50 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown

Section 4-9-10 Transbox Function Validation Procedure

Section 10-5-2-2 Peripheral/Option Checks

Section 10-5-3 Input Power

Section 10-5-5 Probe Maintenance

Section 10-6-2 GEMS Leakage Current Limits “Service Manual, Direction


Outlet Test - Wiring Arrangement - USA & 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-2-50. Equipment
Section 10-6-3 Canada passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-6-4 Grounding Continuity

Section 10-6-5 Chassis Leakage Current Test

Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead


Section 10-6-6
to Ground

Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead


Section 10-6-7 to Lead

Section 10-6-9 Probe Leakage Current Test

8 - 104 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-50-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.

When instaling the Transbox assy, the transbox chassis should be inserted into the guide rail which is
under the frame chassis.

Figure 8-138 Insert the Transbox assy

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 105


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-51 Fuse Set

8-2-51-1 Tools
• Common pillips screwdrivers
• Allen/Unbraco wrench
• Stubby screwdriver (Flat tip and Cross tip)

8-2-51-2 Preparations
• Shut down the system and switch off the main breaker.

8-2-51-3 Removal procedure


1.) Remove the AC Transbox assy. Refer to 8-2-50 "Transbox Assy 110V/220V" on page 8-103.
2.) Replace the 2 fuses located on the ACPC assy in the transbox assy. Refer to Figure 8-139.

Figure 8-139 FUSE in Transbox assy

3.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-51 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up

Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown “Service Manual, Direction


5154945, Rev 2+, Section 8-2-51. Equipment
Section 4-9-14 Fuse set Function Validation Procedure passed all required tests and is ready for use. “

Section 10-5-2-2 Peripheral/Option Checks

8-2-51-4 Mounting Procedure


Install the new parts in the reverse order of removal.
8 - 106 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-52 Read and Write Serial Info

8-2-52-1 How to start serial no read/write program


1.) Plug the service dongle on the usb port on rear panel.
2.) Turn on the system.
3.) When the Start Application dialog box appears, press [F2] before it automatically starts
Echoloader.)

Figure 8-140 Start Appllication Dialog Box

4.) When the Maintenance Access dialog box pops up, type in the service password.

Figure 8-141 Maintenance Access Dialog Box

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 107


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-52-1 How to start serial no read/write program (cont’d)


5.) If the win XP screen appears, run the window explorer. Move the cursor to bottom of the screen. If
the task bas appear, click the explorer icon.

Figure 8-142 Windows Explorer

6.) Run the "asn.exe" by double click . This execution file is in "C:\Arirang\target\bin" directory

Figure 8-143 “asn.exe”

8 - 108 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-52-1 How to start serial no read/write program (cont’d)


7.) When asn.exe starts running, Logon windows pops up. Type in maintenance password to start
asn.exe.

Figure 8-144 Execute the “ASN.EXE”

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 109


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-2-52-2 How to read Serial No


1.) Check checkboxes of system boards you want to read or System Serial No checkbox.

NOTE: You can read System Serial No, L1SYSCON board, CL1TRX board, P3RLY board, and ACWD
board information.

Figure 8-145 Reading System Info

8-2-52-3 How to write info on the system


1.) Check checkboxes of system boards you want to write or System Serial No checkbox.
2.) Put the Serial No, Part No, or Rev on the blank box.
3.) Press “Write” Button.

8 - 110 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 8-3
Software Loading Procedure
8-3-1 General
This describes a full system software loading (Base Software Load Image + Arirang Application Load
Image) procedure.

Use this instruction when:

- Performing the HDD with new one (Base Software Load Image + Arirang Application Load Image)

- Performing the system revision-up (Application)

8-3-2 Parts Required


Logiq P5/A5 Base Software DVD

Logiq P5/A5 Application Software CD

Blank CD-Rs ( for patient image backup) or DVDs

Service Dongle

NOTE: Patient Image Data will be deleted when all the drives are ghosted. Back up them on the CD-R
or DVD before starting software loading

NOTE: Insert the service dongle into ths service port located at the rear panel before installing the Base
System Software Load image

8-3-3 TimeRequired
Approximately 2hours

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 111


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-3-4 Software Loading Steering Guide

Figure 8-146 Flow Chart - Installation of Base and Application CD

8 - 112 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-3-5 Before Starting Software Loading

8-3-5-1 Saving Connectivity


Before starting upgrade, write down the Connectivity Setting for back-up.

1.) Go to Utility > Connectivity and click the Tcpip tab.


2.) Write down the following parameters:.

Parameters Descriptions (Entry for Stand-Alone System)

Computer Name

Enable DHCP

IP-Address

Subnet Mask

Default Gateway

Note : For a stand-alone system, preset values of IP address, subnet mask, and default gateway, shown
above, must entered.

Figure 8-147 Connectivity

8-3-5-2 Image Management Guide

NOTE: Before upgrade to R2.X.X software, perform recommended image backup procedure.

Save As to View on any PC - Use this to save images (Dicom or Raw Dicom) in a computer-friendly
format (.avi or .jpeg) so you can view it on any PC.

Export/Import Data/Images Between Systems - Use this to copy both patient data and images for
specified patient(s) from one system to another.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 113


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-3-5-2 Image Management Guide (cont’d)


Save As (Saving Images to CD-ROM or DVD to View on Any PC)

To save images to the CD-ROM:

1.) Insert a blank CD or a balnk DVD.


2.) Go to Utility --> Connectivity --> Removable Media. Select the Media as CD/DVD Recordable.
3.) Press Format to format the CD/DVD.
4.) Select the image(s) to be saved to CD/DVD, press Menu, and select Save As.
5.) The SAVE AS menu appears.

Figure 8-148 Save As Menu

6.) Specify Compression and Save As Type and press Save. The image is saved to the CD/DVD.
7.) When you have put all the images you want on the CD/DVD, press F3 to eject the CD/DVD.
Select CD/DVD Recordable.

Figure 8-149 Eject Media Menu

8.) Finalize the CD/DVD by selecting Yes. The CD/DVD is ejected from the system.

Figure 8-150 Finalize CD-ROM Menu

8 - 114 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-3-5-2 Image Management Guide (cont’d)


Storing Images with More Resolution

To store images with more resolution than is available with the JPEG selection, select Save As and
select AVI as the Save As Type. You can save single images as .avi files.

Table 8-52 Higher Resolution Store Options

Image Type Store as Image Only Store as Secondary Capture

Gives you a single image of the video area.


Gives you a loop of just the image (no title DO NOT DO THIS BECAUSE YOU DO
CINE Loop
bar and scan information). NOT KNOW WHICH IMAGE FROM THE
LOOP THAT YOU ARE GETTING.

Gives you a single image (no title bar and


Still Image Gives you a single image of the video area.
scan information).

Export/Import (Moving Data Between Ultrasound Systems)

To move exams from one Ultrasound system to another, you need to export/import exam information.

NOTE: Both database information and images are exported. No data is deleted from the local archive
when exporting data.

Exporting Data

To export an exam(s) to a compatible Ultrasound system:

1.) Format the removable media (DVD or CD-ROM). Label the removable media. Answer Yes/OK
to the messages.Press Patient. Deselect any selected patient(s) in the search portion of the
Patient screen. Press Data Transfer (located at the upper, right-hand corner of the Patient

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 115


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

menu).

Figure 8-151 Exam Data Transfer

2.) Select Export task Button.

Figure 8-152 Task button

8 - 116 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-3-5-2 Image Management Guide (cont’d)


3.) The [From] combo box is not active. It displays Local Archive. The [To] combo box is active.
Select the type of removable media CD/DVD. Then please wait until the patient list is visible.

Figure 8-153 To Combo Box

4.) In the patient list at the top of the Patient menu, select the patient(s) you want to export. You
can use Windows commands to select more than one patient. To select a consecutive list of
patients, click the cursor on the first name, move the cursor to the last name, then press and
hold down the Shift+right Set key to select all the names.To select a non-consecutive list of
patients, click the cursor at the first name, move the cursor to the next name, then press and
hold down the Ctrl+right Set key, move the cursor to the next name, then press and hold down
the Ctrl+right Set key again, etc.You can also search for patients via the Search key and string.
Or, Select All Button from the Patient Menu:

Figure 8-154 Source Section

NOTE: You need to use your best judgment when moving patients' images. If there are lots of images
or loops, then only move a few patients at a time.

5.) Once you have selected all of the patients to export, press Transfer Button as shown in Figure
8-154 on page 8-117 from the Patient Menu.

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 117


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-3-5-2 Image Management Guide (cont’d)


6.) The progress bar appears as the copy is taking place. Once transfer completed, the exported
patient list will be shown as Figure 8-155.

Figure 8-155 Destination Section of Patient Screen

7.) Press F3 to eject the media. Specify that you want to finalize the CD-ROM or DVD.

Importing Data

To import an exam(s) to another Ultrasound system:

1.) At the other Ultrasound system, insert the CD-ROM/DVD.


2.) Press Patient. Press Exam Data Transfer (located at the upper, left-hand corner of the Patient

8 - 118 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

menu)..

Figure 8-156 Exam Data Trnasfer

3.) Select Import task Button.

Figure 8-157 Task button

Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY 8 - 119


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-3-5-2 Image Management Guide (cont’d)


4.) The [TO] combo box is not active. It displays Local Archive. The [FROM] combo box is active.
Select the type of removable media CD/DVD Rom. Then please wait until the patient list is
visible.

Figure 8-158 From

5.) The Patient menu just shows the patients available for import from the removable media you
just loaded onto the system.
6.) Select the patients to be imported.
7.) Once you have selected all of the patients to import, press Transfer Button.
8.) Please wait for the patient information to be copied to this Ultrasound system. Progress bar
appears while the import is taking place.

8 - 120 Section 8-2 - DISASSEMBLY/RE-ASSEMBLY


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 8-4
Installing Base Software Load Image
8-4-1 Installing Base Software Load Image CD
NOTE: While we do not believe it is necessary, It would not hurt to disconnect the system from the
network and remove all transducers.

NOTE: All digital peripherals, reporting systems connected via the USB ports should be either power
off or disconnected prior to the software installation

1.) Power ON the scanner.


2.) Tap gently the DEL key until the following screen appears.Enter arirang as a password if the
system request a password, then press the Enter key.

Figure 8-159 Enter Current Password

3.) The Setup Utility screen appears. Using arrow keys, Select Advanced Tab and select USB 2.0
Controller Mode and then press the Enter key. Verify that USB 2.0 Controller Mode is HiSpeed.
If it is disabled, using arrow keys, select USB 2.0 Controller Mode and press the Enter key and
change it

Figure 8-160 USB Configuration

4.) To exit USB Configuration, press ESC key

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 121


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-1 Installing Base Software Load Image CD (cont’d)


5.) Select Boot and verify that CD/DVD is selected as a 1st Boot Device. If it is not, select First Boot
Device and press the Enter key using arrow keys. Then select CD/DVD and press the Enter key.

Figure 8-161 First Boot Device to CD ROM

6.) Press the ESC key to return to the Setup Utility screen.
7.) Using arrow keys, select Save & Exit Setup and press the Enter key.

8 - 122 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-1 Installing Base Software Load Image CD (cont’d)


8.) Insert the disk labeled “Base System Software Load Image Disk” into the CD/DVD ROM drive.
9.) After restarting the system, when the following screen appears, press the Enter key to continue, to
abort remove the CD-ROM from the drive and press CTRL-C.

Figure 8-162 Warning Screen

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 123


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-1 Installing Base Software Load Image CD (cont’d)


10.)The following screen appears. Refer to Figure 8-163.

Figure 8-163 Screen

NOTICE Select 1 when installing the new HDD .


Select 2 when replacing C:\Partition only. It means all customer data are NOT deleted. The Ghost pro-
cedure is performed with data of the drives D, E, and F left.

Table 2-53 Drive Partition

Drive Partition Usage


(no name) Grub partition
C System Files and Application
D User Defined and Preset
E Patient Archive data
F Swap
Z Repository partition

8 - 124 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-1 Installing Base Software Load Image CD (cont’d)


11.)Approx. twenty(20) minutes later, the following screen appears. Eject the Base Software DVD from
the drive

Figure 8-164 Screen

12.)After removing the DVD from the drive, Press ALT + CTRL + DEL key
13.)Turn on the system and then go to .8-4-1-1 "System Checks" on page 8-126.

NOTE: After installation LP5/A5 Software Load Image DVD, the “General failure reading drive A ..
Abort, Retry, Fail?” message can be appeared, but Ignore it! All procedure would be
successfully done

NOTE: Remove theDVD from the drive. Otherwise you will be repeating the Base System Software
Load process.

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 125


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-1-1 System Checks


1.) Approx. two minutes later, the windows XP desktop appears. Then one minutes later, the following
screen appears. Clisck on Yes using right button of the trackball to restart the system

Figure 8-165 System Setting Change

NOTE: If the window above is not displayed, go to next step

2.) Driver Checks:


a.) On the window XP desktop, left click on My Computer then right click on Properties

b.) The System Propertiers window appears. Select Hardware > Device Manager

c.) Verify that ?, X, or ! is not displayed

Figure 8-166 Device Manager

If X or ! is displayed:

- Left-click on the device with X mark, then right -click on Enable

- Left-click on the device with ! mark, then right click on Properties to perform the device driver
recognition. When some files are required, designate the file in the directories of C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32
or C:\WINNT\SYSTEM32\DRIVERS. If they are not found, search them using a window search function
8 - 126 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-1-2 USB Printer Checks (USB Printer User Only)


Without any newly additional user invention, LOGIQ™ P5/A5 will recognize the below 9 kinds of USB
printer

Printer Name Comment

Sony UP-D895/D897 Digital BW Printer

Mitsubishi CP30DW Digital Color Printer

Sony UP-D23MD Digital Color Printer

HP 5550 Standard Printer

HP 5650 Standard Printer

HP 6122 Standard Printer

HP 6540 Standard Printer

HP 990cxi Standard Printer

HP DeskJet 1000 Standard Printer

HP DeskJet 1200 Standard Printer

HP Office jet Pro K550 Standard Printer

LexMark Z65 Standard Printer

Xerox Phaser 8400 Standard Printer

This procedure assumes that the P5 software is installed and is functioning properly.

1.) Attach the USB cable from the printer to the USB port on assigned position

Table 8-54 USB Port Position

USB Port Position Peripheral

Right USB Port on Rear Connector Panel Standard Printer

Left USB Port on Rear Connector Panel: Digital Color Printer

USB Port on OP Printer Bracket Back Panel Digital BW Printer

NOTICE If you plug in USB printer for the first time to the system, restart the system.

NOTICE Once a USB printer is conected to one of the USB ports, don't take out the USB printer and plug it in
another USB port.

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 127


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-1-2 USB Printer Checks (USB Printer User Only) (cont’d)

Figure 8-167 USB Port - Rear Panel Connector

Figure 8-168 USB Port - OP Printer Bracket Back Panel

2.) Make sure that printer properties are proper. (Image orientation and size). Refer to the latest
Release Notes.

8 - 128 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-1-3 DMC Checks (DMC User Only)

NOTE: DMC Cable is supplied only as an option.

1.) Check DMC Cable (USB to Serial Bridge).


2.) Plug in the Cable as shown on the right side of the USB port. Refer to Figure 8-169.

DMC Cable
Plug on the right

Figure 8-169 DMC Cable

3.) Ensure USB to Serial Bridge port is recognized by the system.


4.) Trackball to My computer icon and left click
5.) Right click on Properties.
6.) Right click on the Hardware tab.
7.) Right click on the device manager in the middle right of the hardware tab window.

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 129


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8.) Make sure“USB to Serial Bridge” is displayed as shown Figure 8-170

Figure 8-170 Device Manager Windows

8 - 130 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-2 Installing Application Software(R2.x.x)


NOTICE First time SW installation with peripherals on can cause the BlueScreen.
When connecting peripherals to the system, make sure to turn off the system first in order to avoid the
BlueScreen.

1.) Place the “Application Software” CD into the DVD drive.


2.) Press the Start button on the tool bar at the bottom of the LCD screen and select “Run…”.
Enter “G:\LoadSoftware” into the dialog box as shown in Figure 8-171.

Figure 8-171 Run Load Software

3.) You will see a screen that warns you that you are about to load software, press the Y key to
continue. Then the program requests confirmation “Are you sure ?”, Press the Y key again.
4.) You will see a Command (CMD) window open as shown in Figure 8-172.

Figure 8-172 Command Window

5.) Press the "Y" key to continue. Then the program requests confirmation - "Are you sure?" then Press
the "Y" key again.

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 131


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-2 Installing Application Software(R2.x.x) (cont’d)


6.) Choose the type of application.Select reset by region, select one of the below options.
7.) The installation process will be started. it will take about 20 minutes.
8.) To apply the preset by region, select one of the below options. Refer to Figure 8-173.

Figure 8-173 Region selection

9.) Disk defragmentation wil take place.


10.)After the installation is completed the system will power off automatically.

NOTE: Some of systems doesn’t power off automatically. In this case, press and hold power button
more than 5 sec. to power off.

NOTE: Do not operate with using mouse or keyboard during installation procedures.

11.)Turn on the system and immediately eject the button on the DVD drive to eject the CDROM
Verify that the system boots up no error.(It will take a few minutes)

8 - 132 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3 Standard Confirmation & Functional Checks


Configure the system settings and perform functional checks after installation of software.

Items for configuration and functional checks include:

- Confirmation of the software version


- Preset Data (if necessary)
- Patient Image Data (if necessary)
- Functional Checks for Service Platform (Diagnostic Program)

8-4-3-1 Confirmation of Software Version


1.) Touch the Utility button on the Touch Panel
2.) Click on About tab. The software version will be shown on the monitor as shown. Confirm the
following: Refer to Figure 8-174.

Figure 8-174 Confirmation of software version

3.) Make sure that Software Version: R1.x.x (for BT06), R2.x.x(for BT08)and Software Part Number is
described on the Application CD-ROM.

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 133


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3-2 Setting Computer Name


1.) Click on Utility, then select Connectivity.
2.) Click on TCP/IP tab.

Figure 8-175 TCPIP tab

3.) Type Computer Name

NOTICE The Computer name is unique. Check the scanner serial number printed on the label located
at the rear lower side of the scanner. For example, when 12345SU1 is printed, P5-12345SU1
must be entered as a computer name.
NOTICE If Enable DHCP checkbox is checked and LAN cable is disonncted from the system, the
system bootup time mihgt slow down.

4.) Verify that Enable DHCP has no check mark. If checked, remove the mark.

NOTE: If Enable DHCP mark is checked, the system cannot checkout by VOLC.

5.) Check if Computer Name, IP Address, Subnet Mask, and Default Gateway are proper ones
which you wrote down in section 8-3-5-1Saving Connectivity.

NOTE: If the "Save" is NOT performed, you can NOT enter Patient screen and NOT perform
Export/Import

6.) Click on Save button


7.) Click OK for confirmation dialog box
8.) The system will power OFF automatically.
Turn on the system for functional checks

8 - 134 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3-3 Functional Checks for Service Platform (Diagnostic Program)


The Service platform uses a web-based user interface(UI) to provide access to common service
components.

NOTE: After perform diagnostics, shut down and restart to make the system working properly.

1.) Go to Utility and press Service to launch Service Platform. It will take some seconds for activating.
2.) Make sure that CAPS is not selected (should be dimmed) for password entry performed later.

Figure 8-176 Utrlity -> Service

3.) The Service Login window for Service Platform will be shown on the monitor display.

Figure 8-177 Log in screen

CAUTION If the Login window for Service Platform is not displayed on the monitor, the installation of the
Service Platform has failed. Reload the application software or Base System Software (OS) +
application software. Contact a Technical Support for details.

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 135


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3-3 Functional Checks for Service Platform (Diagnostic Program) (cont’d)


4.) Select GE Service at the “Select User Level” field.
5.) Enter the password for the Service Platform.
6.) Click on Okay.

Figure 8-178 Select User Level

7.) Verify that the following screen (Service Platform) is displayed on the monitor.

NOTICE When the service platform is NOT displayed, check if CAPS lock is selected. The CAPS should not be
selected.

8.) Click on x located at the upper right corner of the service platform screen to close the Service
Platform and return to the scan panel.

Figure 8-179 Service Platform screen


8 - 136 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3-4 Setting the VCR (if necessary)


1.) Select Utility > System>Peripheral tab
2.) Under Video Settings, PAL or NTSC.
3.) Under VCR, select Composite or S-Video.
4.) Under VCR, select Panasonic LQ-MD800 or Mitsubishi MD3000, as appropriate.

Figure 8-180 Utility > System>Peripherals

5.) Click on Save.


6.) Shut down the scanner, then restart the scanner.
7.) Verify that the VCR can be properly operated..

NOTICE Be sure to connect the converter and cablebefore booting up the system. Otherwise the LOGIQ™ P5/
A5 system does not recognize the peripheral devices

8.) Perform the following functional tests. If all are successful, include the debrief script provided below.

Table 8-55 Functional Tests

Service Manual
Section Functional Test / Diagnostic Test Debrief Script

Section 4-3-1 Power On/Boot Up


“Service Manual, Direction
Section 4-3-2 Power Off / Shutdown 5154945, Rev 4+, Section 8-4-3. Equipment
passed all required tests and is ready for use. “
Section 4-5 Peripheral Checks

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 137


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3-5 Verifying the VCR (if necessary)


1.) Press Record button, VCR menu shows up at the bottom of the screen.

Figure 8-181 VCR Menu

2.) Click Counter Reset, then Press Record menu to start recording.

Figure 8-182 For BT08

Figure 8-183 For BT06

Displays a red dot in the VCR status area on the Title bar to indicate that recording has begun.

Figure 8-184 VCR Status

3.) Press Stop to stop recording the tape at the desired moment.
4.) Press Search to adjust the starting time for video playback.
5.) Press Play to start VCR playback.

8 - 138 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3-6 Setting the Printer (if necessary)


1.) Select Utility -> Connectivity -> Service tab
2.) Select Standard Printer, and Add

Figure 8-185 Utility > Connectivity > Service

3.) Under Properties, select desired Printer, and Save.

Figure 8-186 Select the Printer

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 139


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3-7 Print Key Assignment and Checkout(if necessary)


1.) Select Utility-> Connectivity-> Button tap.
2.) Choose the desired print button(for example, Print1) under Physical Print Button.

Figure 8-187 Physical Print Button

3.) Select Standard Print ,and press > >Standard Print is added under printflow View.

NOTICE Press << to delete a existing Standard Print.

Figure 8-188 Standard Print

4.) Press the print key just configured.


The screenshot prints to the destination printer.

8 - 140 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3-8 Regional Setup Procedure for Japanese


You can set up the keyboard for Japanese. If you select Japanese, the following items display or may
be entered in Japanese.

• Patient Name
• Exam Comment (on Patient screen and Worksheet)
• Annotation (Comments)
• Error/Warning Messages
• DICOM/Worklist
1.) In Utility--> System--> General, set the Language as JPN. Save this setting, but do not reboot the
system yet.

Figure 8-189 Changing the System Language to JPN

2.) Press Regional Options, under Standards and Formats select Japanese, under Location select
Japan. Press Apply.

Figure 8-190 Regional Options

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 141


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3-8 Regional Setup Procedure for Japanese (cont’d)


3.) Select the Language tab, press Details, under Installed Services add the Japanese-Microsoft IME
Standard 2002 ver. 8.1 keyboard, under Default input language select Japanese, press Apply,
Press OK.

Figure 8-191 Regional and Language Options—Language Tab

4.) Select the Advanced tab, then select Japanese in the Language for non-Unicode programs pull-
down menu. Press Apply. Answer Yes to use files already loaded on the hard disk, then answer No
to not reboot the system yet, press OK. Press Save and Exit the Utility screen.
5.) Reboot the system. When yur system restarts, the system appears in the selected language.
NOTE: To have the settings take effect, you MUST turn off the system and turn it back on.
6.) In Utility --> System --> General, press Regional Options. Select Language Tab and press Details.
Remove English under Installed Services. Press Apply and OK.
7.) To type in Japanese, press Alt + tilde/accent key (located between the Esc and F1 keys) in order to
start the Input Method Editor (IME).

8 - 142 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-4-3-9 Verifying Your installation

8-4-3-9-1 Verifying whether correct product type was installed


The simplest way to verify that correct product type was installed is to check the state of CF and PW
functions. To figure out the difference between each product type, see the following table.

Product Type CF PW

P5 O O

A5 X O

A5 w/o PW X X

Table 8-56 Comparison Product Type

To verify CF and PW functions follow the next steps described bellow.

1.) Turn on the system. Wait until the screen comes up.
2.) Press the "Utility" key on the A/N Key.
3.) Select Imaging tab at the top menu. Then, check the CF and PW tabs.

Figure 8-192 Checking Utility a Imaging menu

4.) If CF and PW tabs are shown, then P5 application is installed.


5.) If PW is shown but CF is not, then A5 application is installed.
6.) If CF and PW are not shown, then A5 w/o PW is installed.

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 143


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 8-5
Full backup/Restore procedure
8-5-1 General
This describes a Full Backup (Database, Image, User preset, Service Data) procedure.

Use this instruction when you need to save the data :

- before changing a HDD with a new one

- before reinstalling Base Application

- when you just want to save all of the current data.

8-5-2 Parts Required


- USB HDD

8-5-3 Full Backup Procedure


1.) While the Echoloader is running, press ‘Utility’ button and click on the ‘Admin’.
2.) When Title Login window pops up, select an operator with admin authorization.
3.) Type in the password.
4.) press “OK”.
5.) Select “System Admin” page.
6.) press “Execute” button under Full Backup box and the window below pops up.

Figure 8-193 Backup and Restore Window

8 - 144 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-5-3 Full Backup Procedure (cont’d)


7.) Press “Backup”. Then the below window pops up..

Figure 8-194 Emergency Disk Making Wizard

8.) Insert a USB HDD.

NOTE: It might take about 30 seconds for the system to recognize the USB HDD.

9.) Press “Next”.

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 145


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-5-3 Full Backup Procedure (cont’d)


10.)Select USB HDD for backup when Select Drive window is displayed.

Figure 8-195 Dirve select

11.)Verify that USB HDD is in the list.


12.)If USB HDD with enough space is not already plugged in, plug in one.Then press Next

Figure 8-196 Storage Information


8 - 146 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-5-3 Full Backup Procedure (cont’d)


13.)Press next to continue. Then the below windows appear.

Figure 8-197 Emergency Disk Making Preparation

Figure 8-198 Emergency Disk Making in Progress

14.)Verify that "Backup was completed!" message is displayed.


15.)Press Finish to complete.
Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 147
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-5-4 Restore procedure


1.) From Figure 8-192, press “Restore” button.
2.) Rest of the procedure is the same with “Backup” procedure.

NOTICE The system should be rebooted after finishing of Restore procedures.

After reboot,

Press "Patient". Verify that Patient data are restored

Press "Utility". Verify that Userdefined data are restored.

8 - 148 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 8-6
Software Reloading
8-6-1 General
This describes general Software Reloading of C:\ partition functionality.

Software Reloading of C:\ partition keeps Patient information and Userdefined settings intact.

8-6-2 Software Reloading Procedure

8-6-2-1 Perform Software Reloading in the Serivce Platform


No media (CD/DVD) is needed to perform this function. This can be done in two ways.

A) By logging on to the Service Platform

B) To access the system remotely.

In case of performing Software Reloading remotely, you will need the assistance of the customer to
switch the system back on and put it in disruptive mode.

The following procedure applies to both Locally and Remotely.

1.) Go to Utility->System->General
2.) Press “Date/Time”

Figure 8-199 Date/Time


Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 149
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) Press “Time Zone”

Figure 8-200 Time Zone

4.) Register the current Time Zone

Current Time Zone

Table 8-1 Current Time Zone

5.) Press “Cancel”.


6.) Log onto the Service Platform.
7.) Go to “Utilites”->”Common Utilites”.

8 - 150 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8.) Select “Reload System SoftwareSelect “Reload System Software”

Figure 8-201 Reload system Software

9.) Press “Reload”.


10.)Confirmation message pops up.
11.)Press “Yes” to proceed.

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 151


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

12.)Progress bar is displayed

Figure 8-202 Reloading setup in progress

13.)Setup is completed successfully


A) If you do s/w reloading from the system directly, please shut down the system now.
B) For remote s/w reloading, please enable Disruptive mode.

Figure 8-203 setup completed message

8 - 152 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

14.)Press “Disruptive mode”

Figure 8-204 Disruptive mode

15.)If “Disruptive Mode Status” is disabled, Press “Yes” to enable disruptive mode.
For the remote reloading, customer has to agree to the diruptive mode. The following window (Figure
8-204) pops up in the system screen and customer has to press “Yes” to enable Disruptive mode.

Figure 8-205 Insite Notification


Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 153
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

16.)“System Shutdown”

Figure 8-206 System shutdown

NOTE: If the service dongle is inserted or the system is logged on to the maintenance mode, “System
shutdown” will not work. Please close programs and reboot the system manually.

17.)Select “Restart System”

Figure 8-207 Restart System

18.)Press “Submit”
19.)Press “Confirm” when confirmation message is displayed.
20.)After a while, the system restarts automatically.

8 - 154 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-6-2-2 Software Reloading


1.) The base s/w load starts automatically immediately after boot up

Figure 8-208 Ghosting C:\ partition

2.) After finishing the ghosting, the system restarts automatically.

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 155


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

3.) When the system restarts, an application installation starts automatically

Figure 8-209 Application installation

4.) When installation is finished, the system shuts down automatically.


5.) Press Power Button to start the system.
6.) When system fully boots up after the software reloading, please shutdown system again

NOTE: For the following procedure, disruptive mode should be approved in order to be in done
remotely.

7.) Start the system.


8.) Go to "Utility"->"System"->"About"
Verify that Software version and software build version are same with the ones before the Software
Reloading.

9.) Press “Patient” button, and verify under Dataflow that “Local Archive” is available. If it's not
available, shut down the unit one more time.
10.)Verify that "Local Archive" is available under Dataflow.
11.)To put the Local Time Zone back, Go to Utility->System->General

8 - 156 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

12.)Click “Date/Time”

Figure 8-210 Date/Time

13.)Press Time Zone

Figure 8-211 Time Zone

14.)Change the time zone to the local time zone from Table 1.
15.)Press “Apply”

Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image 8 - 157


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

16.)Press “Date&Time” tab.

Figure 8-212 Date & Time

17.)Change the Date and Time correctly if needed.


18.)Press “Apply”
19.)Press “OK”
20.)Turn off the system.
21.)Start the system.
22.)Check if the correct date and time are displayed.

Figure 8-213 Date and Time check

23.)Verify that correct date and time are displayed correctly.


24.)The software reloading is completed.

8 - 158 Section 8-4 - Installing Base Software Load Image


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 8-7
Mechanical Option Installation instruction
These service in structions describe the installation procedures of following mechanical options to
LOGIQ™ P5/A5.

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 159


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-1 Endo Probe Holder Installation


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of Endo Probe Holder.
2.) Install Cable Arm Hook. Refer to Figure 8-213.
3.) Check out the 2 screw holes to be used to install Endo Probe Holder. refer to Figure 8-213

Figure 8-214 Endo Probe Holder Installation

4.) Install Endo Probe holder on the bottom side of the the Cable Arm Hook by screwing 2 screws (1-
2). Refer to Figure 8-214.

Figure 8-215 Endo Probe Holder

8 - 160 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-2 Microphone Option fixture Installation


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of the microphone option fixture.
2.) Use 2 holes at the bottom of the keyboard. Refer to Figure 8-215.

Figure 8-216 Microphone option holes

3.) Screw 2 screws to fix the Microphone fixture. Refer to Figure 8-216.

Figure 8-217 installation of Microphone

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 161


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-3 Drawer Option installation


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of the drawer option.
2.) Push the drawer from the front to the rear direction. refer to Figure 8-217

Figure 8-218 Drawer Option Installation

3.) Unscrew 2 existing screws from the middle cover.


4.) Using the bracket, fix the drawer by screwing 3 screws each of left and right side of the drawer.
Refer to Figure 8-218.

Middle Cover

Figure 8-219 Installation of Drawer Option

8 - 162 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-4 Cable Arm Hook installation


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of cable arm hook.
2.) Cable Arm Hook should be installed in prior to installing Probe Cable Hanger, or Endo Probe
Holder.
3.) Unscrew 1 existing screw from the rear side of the keyboard. Refer to Figure 8-219.

Figure 8-220 Cable Arm Hook installation

4.) Screw 2 screws to fix the Cable Arm hook. User longer screw provide on the upper hole, and use
existing screw removed in the step 2 on the . refer to Figure 8-220.

Figure 8-221 Cable Arm Hook installation

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 163


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-5 BW Printer Fixture Keyboard installation


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of BW printer keyboard.
2.) Put loctite 290 on the screw(2159634, BH M4X10 WHT)'s edge. Refer to Figure 8-221.

Figure 8-222 BW Printer Fixture Keyboard installation

3.) Fix the BW printer brkt beneath the keyboard by the (2159634, BH M4X10 WHT). Refer to Figure
8-222.

Figure 8-223 BW Printer Fixture Keyboard installation

8 - 164 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Fix the BW printer base bracket to the BW Printer by screwing 4 screws (1-4) . Refer to Figure 8-
223.

(2)

(1)

base bracket
(4)

(3)

Figure 8-224 BW Printer Fixture Keyboard installation

5.) Slide and place the BW printer with base bracket to the BW printer bracket. and screw 2 screws (1-
2) to fix it. Refer to Figure 8-224.

(1)
(2)

Figure 8-225 BW Printer Fixture Keyboard installation

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 165


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6.) Connect the Power Cable and USB Cable from the printer to the system and tie the cable properly.
Refer to Figure 8-225.

Figure 8-226 BW Printer Fixture Keyboard installation

7.) Install the BW Printer hide bracket to the rear side of the printer and screw 2 screws on each side
to fix it. Refer to Figure 8-226.

Figure 8-227 BW Printer Fixture Keyboard installation

8 - 166 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-6 BW printer Fixture Middle installation


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of BW printer fixture in the middle poisition.
2.) Install BW Printer on the top of the base bracket by screwing 4 screws. Refer to Figure 8-227.

base bracket

Figure 8-228 BW Printer Fixture Middle installation

3.) Unscrew 2 existing screw from the middle cover.


4.) Place the BW printer with base bracket on the middle cover and screw 2 screws to fix it. Refer to
Figure 8-228.

Figure 8-229 BW Printer Fixture Middle installation

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 167


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5.) Connect the USB cable and power cable from the printer to the system. Refer to Figure 8-229.

Figure 8-230 BW Printer Fixture Middle installation

6.) Install BW hide bracket to the rear side of the BW printer and screw 2 screws to fix it. Refer to Figure
8-230.

(2)

Figure 8-231 BW Printer Fixture Middle installation

8 - 168 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7.) Tie the cables using the tie wrap as illustrated in Figure 8-231.

Figure 8-232 BW Printer Fixture Middle installation

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 169


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-7 Color Printer Fixture Middle installation - UP23MD Printer


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of color printer fixture in the middle poisition.
2.) Install color printer on the top of the base bracket by screw 4 screws. refer to Figure 8-232.

Base Bracket

Figure 8-233 Printer VCR DVD Fixture installation top

3.) Unscrew 2 existing screws from the middle cover.


4.) Screw 2 screws on each side of the system to fix the Color printer with base bracket to the system.
Figure 8-233.

Figure 8-234 Printer VCR DVD Fixture installation top

8 - 170 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

5.) Connect the USB cable and Power cable from the color printer to the system as shown in Figure 8-
234.

Figure 8-235 Printer VCR DVD Fixture installation top

6.) Install Color printer hide bracket and screw 4 screws to fix it. refer to Figure 8-235.

Figure 8-236 Printer VCR DVD Fixture installation top

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 171


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7.) Tie the cables using the tie wrap as illustrated in Figure 8-236.

Figure 8-237 Printer VCR DVD Fixture installation top

8 - 172 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-8 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation - UP23MD Printer


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of color printer fixture for UP-23MD printer.
2.) Unscrew 2 existing screws from the top cover. Refer to Figure 8-237.

Figure 8-238 Printer VCR DVD Fixture installation top

3.) Install Fixture Top bracket on the top cover by screwing 2 screws. Refer to Figure 8-238.

Figure 8-239 Printer VCR DVD Fixture installation top

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 173


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Install color printer to the base bracket by screwing 4 screws. Refer to Figure 8-239.

Figure 8-240 Printer VCR DVD Fixture installation top

5.) Screw 2 screws on both sides to fix the color printer with base bracket to the color printer top
bracket. Refer to Figure 8-240.

Figure 8-241 Printer VCR DVD Fixture installation top

6.) Connect the USB cable and Power cable from the color printer to the system. For more wiring
information, refer to the Basic Service Manual.

8 - 174 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7.) Install hide bracket by screwing 2 screws. refer to Figure 8-241.

Figure 8-242 Printer VCR DVD Fixture installation top

8.) Tie the cable properly using the tie wrap.

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 175


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-9 Printer VCR DVD fixture Top installation - CP900 Printer


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of Color Printer fixture for CP-900 printer.
2.) Unscrew 2 existing screws from the top cover. refer to Figure 8-242.

Figure 8-243 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

3.) Install Fixture Top bracket on the top cover by screwing 2 screws. refer to Figure 8-243.

Figure 8-244 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

8 - 176 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Install color printer to the base bracket by screwing 4 screws. refer to Figure 8-244.

Figure 8-245 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

5.) Screw 2 screws on each sides to fix the color printer with base bracket to the color printer top
bracket. refer to Figure 8-245.

(3)
(4)
(1)
(2)

Figure 8-246 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

6.) Connect the USB from the color printer as shown in Figure 8-246.

Figure 8-247 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 177


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

7.) Connect the cable from the color printer to the system. refer to Figure 8-247.

Figure 8-248 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

8.) Install hide bracket by screwing 2 screws. refer to Figure 8-248.

Figure 8-249 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

9.) Tie the cable properly using the tie wrap.

8 - 178 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-10 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top Installation (MD-3000)

8-7-10-1 VCR Remote Port Configuration


1.) LOGIQ P5 control the Mitsubishi MD-3000 VCR through USB. Hence the VCR remote control port
must be configured as USB
2.) Open the remote control module in the VCR. Refer to Figure 8-249

Figure 8-250 VCR Remote Control Panel

3.) Unscrew 2 screws on the VCR remote control port panel and out the remote control module from
VCR. Unscrew 1 screw on the module. Refer to Figure 8-250

Figure 8-251 VCR Remote Control Panel 2

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 179


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Set the DIP switch on the VCR remote control panel. The SW 7 in DIP switch should be set to “ON”
position for the USB remote control . Refer to Figure 8-251

Figure 8-252 DIP Switch on the Panel

5.) Insert the remote control module into the VCR and connect the USB cable between the “Remote”
USB on the console rear panel and USB port of VCR
6.) Plug the service dongle and turn on the VCR and System
7.) Login to maintanance mode and open the device manager
8.) Check if the VCR remote device is identified by OS. Refer to Figure 8-252

Figure 8-253 Remote device in the device manager

8 - 180 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-10-2 Bracket Installation


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of VCR recorder fixture for MD-3000 printer.
2.) Unscrew 2 existing screws from the top cover. refer to Figure 8-253.

Figure 8-254 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

3.) Install Fixture Top bracket on the top cover by screwing 2 screws. refer to Figure 8-254.

Figure 8-255 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 181


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Install VCR recorder to the base bracket by screwing 4 screws. refer to Figure 8-255.

Figure 8-256 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

5.) Screw 2 screws on each side of the system to fix the VCR recorder with base bracket to the VCR
top bracket. refer to Figure 8-256.

Figure 8-257 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

8 - 182 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6.) Connect the cables (Power Cable, USB cable, S-VHS Cable, and Sound cables) from the VCR to
the system. refer to the Figure 8-257.

Figure 8-258 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

7.) Connect the cables to the system on the rear panel. refer to Figure 8-258.

Figure 8-259 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation

8.) Install VCR hide bracket by screwing 2 screws. refer to Figure 8-259.

Figure 8-260 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation


Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 183
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-11 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top Installation (MD-800)


1.) This section describes the installation procedure of DVD fixture.
2.) Unscrew 2 existing screws from the top cover. refer to Figure 8-260.

Figure 8-261 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation (MD-800)

3.) Install Fixture Top bracket on the top cover by screwing 4 screws. refer to Figure 8-261.

Figure 8-262 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation (MD-800)

8 - 184 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Install DVD recorder to the base bracket by screwing 2 screws on each side. refer to Figure 8-262.

Figure 8-263 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation (MD-800)

5.) Connect the USB cable and power cable from the DVD to the system.
6.) Connect the cables to the system on the rear panel.
7.) Install DVD hide bracket by screwing 2 screws. refer to Figure 8-263.

Figure 8-264 Printer VCR DVD Fixture Top installation (MD-800)

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 185


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-12 Rear Handle installation


1.) This desribes installation procedure of Rear Handle.
2.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) and remove Rear hook. refer to Figure 8-264.

Figure 8-265 Rear Handle Installation

3.) Unscrew 2 screws (1-2) and remove the rear handle bracket. refer to Figure 8-265.

(1) (2)

Figure 8-266 Rear Handle Installation

8 - 186 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Screw 2 screws (1-2) from the back of the rear handle. refer to Figure 8-266.

Figure 8-267 Rear Handle Installation

5.) Screw 1 screw and Install handle dummy bracket. Refer to Figure 8-267.

(1)

Figure 8-268 Rear Handle Installation

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 187


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-13 Additional Task Lamp installation


1.) This is the installation instruction of additional task lamp. refer to refer to Figure 8-268.

Figure 8-269 Additional Task Lamp Installation

2.) Connect the USB connector to the location of light bulb mark. refer to Figure 8-269.

Figure 8-270 Additional Task Lamp Installation

3.) Install plastic holder to the task lamp bracket. refer to Figure 8-270.

Figure 8-271 Additional Task Lamp Installation

8 - 188 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

4.) Install task lamp bracket to the rear side of keyboard by screwing 2 screws. refer to Figure 8-271.

Figure 8-272 Additional Task Lamp Installation

5.) Fix the tasklamp light as shown on Figure 8-272.

Figure 8-273 Additional Task Lamp Installation

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 189


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

6.) Install BW hide bracket if it is uninstalled during the installation process. Refer to Figure 8-273.

Figure 8-274 Additional Task Lamp Installation

8 - 190 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-14 Protect Cover Installation


1.) This is the installation instruction of the Protect Cover. Refer to Figure 8-274 the location of the
protect covers to be installed.

Front Protect Cover Rear Protect Cover

Figure 8-275 Protect Cover Installation

2.) Install the protect cover using the double stick tape. Refer to Figure 8-275.

Figure 8-276 Protect Cover Installation

Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction 8 - 191


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

8-7-15 Swivel Lock Caster Installation


NOTE: Both Front Casters and Rear Casters are swivel type in LOGIQ™ P5 but in LOGIQ™ A5, only
Front Casters are swivel type (Rear Casters are "Fixed" type).

1.) This is the installation instruction of the Protect Cover. Refer to the figure below for the location of
the protect covers to be installed.
2.) Unscrew 8 screws (1A-8A) to remove the front caster. Refer to the figure below.

Figure 8-277 Swivel Lock Caster

8 - 192 Section 8-7 - Mechanical Option Installation instruction


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 8-16
Final Procedures
1.) After all peripherals have been installed, ensure that all cables are neatly and properly routed to the
system back and front panel. Use tiewraps, if necessary.
2.) Properly store excess cable in the back panel cavity behind the door.
3.) Fill out the proper customer information on the Product Locator Card. Mail the installation card
“Product Locator” to the address corresponding to your region. Refer to Figure 8-277.

Figure 8-278 Product Locator Card

NOTE: The Product Locator Card indicated in Figure 8-277 may be different from the actually provided
on.

4.) Properly dispose of any excess material in accordance with current GE Medical System policy.
5.) Once all peripherals are installed, ensure that the operation of the system is verified once again by
performing the functional checks. Refer to Functional Checks in Chapter 4, LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Service
Manual.
6.) Ensure that each peripheral operates properly from the LOGIQ™ P5/A5 keyboard, monitor,
peripheral’s own front panel or remote controls. Inform the customer of proper peripheral operation.
7.) Keep this documentation with LOGIQ™ P5/A5 Service Manual. for feature reference.
8.) This completes the installation of the Mechanical Options.

Section 8-16 - Final Procedures 8 - 193


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

This page was intentionally left blank.

8 - 194 Section 8-16 - Final Procedures


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Chapter 9
Renewal Parts

Section 9-1
Overview
9-1-1 Purpose of Chapter 9
This chapter gives you an overview of Renewal Parts for LOGIQ™ P5 and A5.

Table 9-1 Contents in Chapter 9

Section Description Page Number

9-1 Overview 9-1

9-2 List of Abbreviations 9-1

9-3 Renewal Parts Lists 9-2

9-3 MONITOR 9-2

9-4 KEYBOARD 9-4

9-5 COVERS 9-6

9-6 PCB 9-8

9-7 BODY 9-10

9-8 POWER 9-12

9-9 Cables 9-14

9-10 Options 9-15

Section 9-2
List of Abbreviations
• Assy - Assembly
• Ctrl - Control
• FRU 1 - Replacement part available in part hub
• FRU 2 - Replacement part available from the manufacturer (lead time involved)
• Int - Internal
• I/O - Input/Output
• KB - Keyboard
• LCD - Liquid Crystal Display
• MON - Monitor
• PAT. - Patient
• PC - Personal Computer (Back End Processor)

Section 9-1 - Overview 9-1


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-3 MONITOR

Figure 9-1 Monitor

9-2 Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-3 MONITOR (cont’d)

Item Part Name Part Number Description Qty FRU

100 LCD Panel with filter 5144499 1 1

LA5 monitor cover set 5144589-3 LOGIQ A5 only 1 1


101
LP5 Monitor cover set 5144590-3 LOGIQ P5 only 1 1

LP5 OSD button and lamp set 5144591 LOGIQ P5 only 1 1


102
LA5 OSD button and lamp set 5178775 LOGIQ A5 only 1 1

103 LCD Plastic Filter 5176409 1 1

104 LCD Arm with cover 5144507 1 1

LP5 LCD Monitor Assy 5172043-3 LOGIQ P5 only 1 1


105
LA5 LCD Monitor Assy 5176885-3 LOGIQ A5 only 1 1

Table 9-2 MONITOR

Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations 9-3


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-4 KEYBOARD

Figure 9-2 KEYBOARD BLOCK

9-4 Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-4 KEYBOARD (cont’d)

Item Part Name Part Number Description Qty FRU

LOGIQ P5 Main Keyboard Assy 5144536 LOGIQ P5 ONLY 1 1


200
LOGIQ A5 Main Keyboard Assy 5171625 LOGIQ A5 ONLY 1 1

LOGIQ P5 Sub Keyboard Assy 5144538-2 LOGIQ P5 ONLY 1 1


201
LOGIQ A5 Sub Keyboard Assy 5177533-2 LOGIQ A5 ONLY 1 1

202 Trackball Assy 5144543 1 1

English A/N Key Assy 5144533 1 1

Greek A/N Key Assy 5168937 1 1

203 Russian A/N Key Assy 5167845 1 1

Swedish A/N Key Assy 5177708 1 1

Norweigian A/N Key Assy 5176980 1 1

204 Freeze Key Assy 5144540 1 1

205 TGC Key Assy 5144541 1 1

206 TGC Knob Set 5144542 1 1

207 Sub Keyboard Encoder Knob set 5144539 1 1

208 LOGIQ P5 Keycap set 5144547 LOGIQ P5 ONLY 1 1

209 Main Keyboard Encoder Knob set 5177823 1 1

210 Speaker Pad 5224928 1 1

Table 9-3 KEYBOARD

Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations 9-5


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-5 COVERS

Figure 9-3 COVERS

9-6 Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-5 COVERS (cont’d)

Item Part Name Part Number Description Qty FRU

300 Side Left Cover 5144509 1 1

301 Side Right Cover 5144510 1 1

302 Front Cover 5144511 1 1

303 Rear Cover 5144512-2 1 1

304 Middle Cover 5144513 1 1

305 Top Cover 5144514 1 1

306 Top Bottom Cover 5144515 1 1

307 Pole Cover 5144516 1 1

308 Neck Front 5144517 1 1

309 Neck Rear 5144519 1 1

310 Dummy Cover L 5168108 1 1

311 Dummy Cover R 5167096 1 1

312 EMI Cover L 5144520 1 1

313 EMI Cover R 5144522 1 1

Table 9-4 COVERS

Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations 9-7


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-6
PCB

Figure 9-4 PCB BOARDS

9-8 Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-6 PCB (cont’d)

Item Part Name Part Number Description Qty FRU

400 APS Assy 5166108 1 1

LOGIQ P5 or LOGIQ A5 with Color


CL1TRX Assy 5144578 1 1
401 Option

BL1TRX Assy 5172144 LOGIQ A5 ONLY 1 1

LOGIQ P5 or LOGIQ A5 with 3 port


P3RLY assy 5144579-2 1 1
option
402
P2RLY assy 5144580-2 LOGIQ A5 ONLY 1 1

403 P2RLY with dummy 5177273-2 LOGIQ P5 ONLY 1 1

Make sure to check the removal


procedure and notice of "8-2-31
404 Backplane assy 5144581 Backplane Assy (FRU No.404)" on 1 1
page 8-61~8-62" before removing
and installation the Assy.

405 ACWD Assy 5144582-2 1 1

LOGIQ P5 ONLY
Make sure to check the removal
procedure and notice of "8-2-33
SYSCONPM Assy 5144584-2 SYSCON PM Assy/SYSCON CM 1 1
Assy (FRU No.406) on page 8-64"
before removing and installation the
Assy
406
LOGIQ A5 ONLY
Make sure to check the removal
procedure and notice of "8-2-33
SYSCONCM Assy 5177111-2 SYSCON PM Assy/SYSCON CM 1 1
Assy (FRU No.406) on page 8-64"
before removing and installation the
Assy

LOGIQ P5 or LOGIQ A5 with CPU


PM SOM Assy with 1G 5178410 1 1
Upgrade or Color Upgrade Option
407
CM SOM Assy with 512M 5178834 LOGIQ A5 ONLY 1 1

408 ASIG Assy 5144588 1 1

409 ECG Assy 5196517 1 1

Make sure to check the removal


procedure and notice of "8-2-33
SYSCON PM Assy/SYSCON CM
410 L1SYSCON BASE BOARD 5179267-2 1 1
Assy (FRU No.406) on page 8-64"
before removing and installation the
Assy

411 ASIR Assy 5264181 1 1

412 Nest Fan Assy 5144556 1 1

Table 9-5 PCB BOARDS

Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations 9-9


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-7 BODY

Figure 9-5 BODY BLOCK

9 - 10 Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-7 BODY (cont’d)

Item Part Name Part Number Description Qty FRU

Front Caster 5144523 LOGIQ P5 ONLY 1 1


500
Front Caster 5178525 LOGIQ A5 ONLY 1 1

Rear Caster 5144524 LOGIQ P5 ONLY 1 1


501
Rear Caster 5177898 LOGIQ A5 ONLY 1 1

502 Rear Handle 5144525 1 1

503 Rear Hook 5165418 1 1

504 Probe Holder 5165304 1 1

505 Cup Holder 5168950 1 1

506 ECG Cable Hook 5164599 Option 1 1

507 Air Filter Set 5144526 1 1

508 DVD Assy 5267309-2 Only BT08 Products 1 1

Replace Samsung Slim DVD by TS-


509 BT08 DVD Drive 5264920 1 1
T632A Samsung Slim DVD

Replace Plextor/LG DVD by LG


509 LG DVD drive 5269594 1 1
DVD

ARP Assy 110V 5144586-2 1 1


510
ARP Assy 220V 5144587-2 1 1

511 Cable Arm Hook 5178888-2 Option 1 1

512 SATA HDD Assy 5177519 1 1

513 160G HDD for Consip 5264671 Only Italy Consip System 1 1

514 Touch UP paint 5176646 Option 1 1

515 UPS Fixture brkt Kit 5212390 Option 1 1

Table 9-6 BODY BLOCK

Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations 9 - 11


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-8 POWER

602

601
600

Figure 9-6 POWER BLOCK

9 - 12 Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-8 POWER (cont’d)

Item Part Name Part Number Description Qty FRU

600 ACPC Assy 5144559 1 1

LOGIQ P5 Transbox Assy 110V 5144560 LOGIQ P5 ONLY 1 1

LOGIQ P5 Transbox Assy 220V 5144562 LOGIQ P5 ONLY 1 1


601
LOGIQ A5 Transbox Assy 110V 5177417 LOGIQ A5 ONLY 1 1

LOGIQ A5 Transbox Assy 220V 5177276 LOGIQ A5 ONLY 1 1

Fuse Set 110 5168996 1 1


602
Fuse Set 220 5177924 1 1

603 Power Cord for 110v 2389073 110v 1 1

604 1 1

605 Power Cord for China 2389074 Only China 1 1

606 Power Cord for Israel 5189985 1 1

607 Power Cord for Argentina 5189874 1 1

608 Power Code for Italy 5189619 1 1

609 Power Cord for Denmark 5189461 1 1

610 Power Cord for ANZ 5189439 1 1

Power Cord for UK/HK 5189398 1 1

Power Cord for Switzerland 5189311 1 1

Power Cord for India 5189127 1 1

Table 9-7 POWER BLOCK

Section 9-2 - List of Abbreviations 9 - 13


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-9
Cables

Item Part Name Part Number Description Qty FRU

DVI Cable + Speaker Cable + KBD


700 Multi Cable Assy 1 5169853 1 1
Control Cable

Mon Pwr Cable + BW PWR Cable +


701 Multi Cable Assy 2 5168859 1 1
BW USB Cable + KB USB Cable

702 Multi Cable Assy 3 5168797 Front USB Cable + MIC Cable 1 1

703 Mon PWR Conn Cable 5166286 1 1

704 Mon PWR Conn Long Cable 5168941 1 1

705 ACPC Cable 5168846 1 1

706 Prt Cable Assy 1 5177395 1 1

707 Prt Cable Assy 2 5168842

708 EIDE Cable 5168955-2 1 1

709 APS AC PWR Cable 5168913 1 1

710 Peripheral AC PWR Cable 5165244 1 1

711 AEXP Cable 5172066 1 1

712 DCWD Cable Assy 5174403 1 1

713 IEC Type ECG CABLE 5196518 1 1

714 AHA Type ECG CABLE 5196519 1 1

Table 9-8 Cables

9 - 14 Section 9-9 - Cables


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-10
Options

Table 9-9 OPTIONS

Item Part Name Part Number Description Qty FRU


800 Endo Probe Holder 5171933 1 1

801 VCR DVD Fixture Top 5171717-2 1 1

802 BW Printer Fixture Keyboard 5172473-2 1 1

803 BW Printer Fixture Middle 5172353 1 1

804 VCR Color Printer DVD Fixture Middle 5172238-2 1 1

805 Paper Holder 5172484-2 1 1

806 LCD Flexible Arm KIT 5264538 1 1

807 Probe Cable Hanger 5172178 1 1


808 Drawer 5171620 1 1

809 ECG KIT with AHA cable 5172098 1 1

810 ECG kit with IEC cable 5192987 1 1

811 4D KIT 5171709-4 1 1

812 Foot Switch 5172298 1 1

813 Additional Task Lamp KIT 5171582 1 1


814 Microphone 5171727 1 1

815 Protective Cover 5176417 1 1

816 Swivel Lock Caster 5184603 1 1

817 3rd probe Ports kit 5171892-3 1 1

818 CW Doppler kit 5171900-2 LOGIQ P5 ONLY 1 1

Section 9-10 - Options 9 - 15


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-11
Software

Table 9-10 Software

Item Part Name Part Number Description Qty FRU


900 LP5 A5 CD SET 5272499-2 1 1

901 Easy 3D Software Option 5171868 1 1

902 Advanced 3D Software Option 5172204 1 1

903 DICOM Software Option 5171839 1 1

904 LOGIQ View Software Option 5172499 1 1

905 Anatomical M Mode Option 5172006 1 1

906 B-Flow Software option 5171584 1 1

907 CrossBeamSoftware Option 5172248 1 1


908 CHA Software Option 5172087 1 1

9 - 16 Section 9-11 - Software


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 9-12Probes

Table 9-11 Probes

Item Part Name Part Number Description Qty FRU


1 3.5C PROBE 2050357 PROBE 1 1

2 3.5CS PROBE 2051858 PROBE 1 1

3 4C PROBE 5123455 PROBE 1 1

4 8C PROBE 2348094 PROBE 1 1

5 E8C PROBE 2294641 PROBE 1 1

6 BE9C PROBE 2389382 PROBE 1 1

7 8L PROBE 5140738 PROBE 1 1


8 9L PROBE 5149427 PROBE 1 1

9 10L PROBE 2294523 PROBE 1 1

10 12L PROBE 2295377 PROBE 1 1

11 i739 PROBE 2259206 PROBE 1 1

12 t739 PROBE 2259246 PROBE 1 1

13 3S-02 PROBE 2323337 PROBE 1 1


14 5S-02 PROBE 2347469 PROBE 1 1

15 7S-02 PROBE 2347471 PROBE 1 1

16 ERB PROBE 2258309 PROBE 1 1

17 4D3C-L PROBE KTZ195893 PROBE 1 1

18 P2D TE100024 PROBE 1 1

Section 9-12 - Probes 9 - 17


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

This page was intentionally left blank.

9 - 18 Section 9-12 - Probes


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Chapter 10
Care & Maintenance

Section 10-1
Overview
10-1-1 Periodic Maintenance Inspections
It has been determined by engineering that your LOGIQ™ P5 system does not have any high wear
components that fail with use, therefore no Periodic Maintenance Inspections are mandatory. Some
Customers Quality Assurance Programs may require additional tasks and or inspections at a different
frequency than listed in this manual.

10-1-2 Purpose of Chapter 10


This chapter describes Care & Maintenance on the scanner and peripherals. These procedures are
intended to maintain the quality of the ultrasound systems performance. Read this chapter
completely and familiarize yourself with the procedures before performing a task.

Table 10-1 Contents in Chapter 10

Section Description Page Number


10-1 Overview 10-1

10-2 Why do Maintenance 10-2

10-3 Maintenance Task Schedule 10-2

10-4 Tools Required 10-4

10-5 System Maintenance 10-7

10-6 Using a Phantom 10-12

10-6 Electrical Safety Tests 10-12

10-7 When There's Too Much Leakage Current... 10-28

Ultrasound INSPECTION Certificate 10-29

CAUTION Practice good ESD prevention. Wear an anti–static strap when handling electronic parts and
even when disconnecting/connecting cables.

DANGER THERE ARE SEVERAL PLACES ON THE BACKPLANE, THE AC DISTRIBUTION,


AND DC DISTRIBUTION THAT ARE DANGEROUS. BE SURE TO DISCONNECT
THE SYSTEM POWER PLUG AND OPEN THE MAIN CIRCUIT BREAKER
BEFORE YOU REMOVE ANY PARTS. BE CAUTIOUS WHENEVER POWER IS
STILL ON AND COVERS ARE REMOVED.
CAUTION Do not pull out or insert circuit boards while power is ON.

Section 10-1 - Overview 10 - 1


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

CAUTION Do not operate this unit unless all board covers and frame panels are securely in place. System
performance and cooling require this.

Section 10-2
Why do Maintenance
10-2-1 Keeping Records
It is good business practice that ultrasound facilities maintain records of quality checks and corrective
maintenance. The Ultrasound Inspection Certificate (provided on page 10-29) provides the customer
with documentation that the ultrasound scanner is maintained on a periodic basis.

A copy of the Ultrasound Periodic Maintenance Inspection Certificate should be kept in the same room
or near the scanner.

10-2-2 Quality Assurance


In order to gain accreditation from organizations such as the American College of Radiology (USA), it
is the customer’s responsibility to have a quality assurance program in place for each scanner. The
program must be directed by a medical physicists, the supervising radiologist/physician or appropriate
designee.

Routine quality control testing must occur regularly. The same tests are performed during each period
so that changes can be monitored over time and effective corrective action can be taken.

Testing results, corrective action and the effects of corrective action must be documented and
maintained on the site.

Your GE service representative can help you with establishing, performing and maintaining records for
a quality assurance program. Please contact us for coverage information and/or price for service.

Section 10-3
Maintenance Task Schedule
10-3-1 How often should care & maintenance tasks be performed?
The Care & Maintenance Task Schedule (provided on page 10-3) specifies how often your LOGIQ™
P5 should be serviced and outlines items requiring special attention.

NOTE: It is the customer’s responsibility to ensure the LOGIQ™ P5 care & maintenance is performed
as scheduled in order to retain its high level of safety, dependability and performance.

Your GE Service Representative has an in-depth knowledge of your LOGIQ™ P5 ultrasound scanning
system and can best provide competent, efficient service. Please contact us for coverage information
and/or price for service.

The service procedures and recommended intervals shown in the Care & Maintenance Task Schedule
assumes that you use your LOGIQ™ P5 for an average patient load (10-12 per day) and not use it as
a primary mobile unit which is transported between diagnostic facilities.

NOTE: If conditions exist which exceed typical usage and patient load, then it is recommended to
increase the maintenance frequencies.

10 - 2 Section 10-2 - Why do Maintenance


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Table 10-2 Customer Care Schedule


Per Facilities
Service at Indicated Time Daily Weekly Monthly QA Program Notes
Clean Probes •* * or before each use

Clean Probe Holders •


Clean Air Filter • more frequently depending on
your environment

Inspect AC Mains Cable • Mobile Unit Check Weekly

Inspect Cables and Connectors •


Clean Console •
Clean Monitor and Touch Panel •
Inspect Wheels, Casters, brakes and
Swivel Locks
• Mobile Unit Check Daily

Check Control Panel Movement • Mobile Unit Check Daily

Console Leakage Current Checks • also after corrective


maintenance

Peripheral Leakage Current Checks • also after corrective


maintenance

Surface Probe Leakage Current Checks • also after corrective


maintenance
Endocavity Probe Leakage
Current Checks
• also after corrective
maintenance
Transesphongeal Probe Leakage
Current Checks
• also after corrective
maintenance
Surgical Probe Leakage
Current Checks
• also after corrective
maintenance

Measurement Accuracy Checks • also after corrective


maintenance

Probe/Phantom Checks • also after corrective


maintenance

Functional Checks • also after corrective


maintenance

Section 10-3 - Maintenance Task Schedule 10 - 3


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 10-4
Tools Required
10-4-1 Standard GE Tool Kit
The following is a description of the “Standard” GE tool kit in the USA. Not all tools are required for PMs.

Table 10-3 Overview of GE-1 Tool Kit Contents

Tool ID Description Tool ID Description

9-45358 Pliers Retaining Ring 9-XL9971MM Xcelite-hex Blade 1.27mm

9-4078 Scribe 9-XL9972MM Xcelite-hex Blade 1.5mm

9-44572 Wrench Open End 3/8 - 7/16 9-XL9973MM Xcelite-hex Blade 2 mm

9-44579 Wrench Open End 1/2 - 9/16 9-XL9974MM Xcelite-hex Blade 2.5mm

9-44579 Wrench Open End 1/2 - 9/16 9-XL9975MM Xcelite-hex Blade 3mm

9-45385 Pliers, Arc Joint 7 inch 9-XL9976MM Xcelite-hex Blade 4mm

9-45378 Pliers, Slip Joint 9-XL9977MM Xcelite-hex Blade 5mm

9-4518 Pliers, Long Nose, Miniature 9-XL991CM Handle

9-4518 Pliers, Long Nose, Miniature C2356E Screw starter - Kedman Quick Wedge

9-44776 Ignition Wrench Set, 10 pc. BLBO Box - 18 Compartment

9-44601 Wrench, Adj., 4 inch DWL4283T Box - 5 Compartment

9-4151 Screwdriver, Blade, Stubby 9-41322 Pickup Tool, Claw type

9-41421 Screwdriver, Blade, Pocket clip 9-6757 6 pc Needle File Set

9-41594 Screwdriver, Blade 1/8 in. x 4 in. 9-9487 Utility Knife

9-41581 Screwdriver, Blade 3/16 in. x 4 in. 9-45341 Pliers Vice Grip 10 inch

9-39451 20' Steel Tape, locking Spring load 9-3001 Xacto Pen Knife

9-GH807 Ratchet, Offset, Slotted 9-HT62002 Solder Aid, Fork and Hook

68-412 Ratchet, Offset, Phillips 9-4099 Mirror, Round, Telescoping

9-GH130 Tapered Reamer 9-GH3001 Steel Rule Decimal 6 inch

9-41584 Screwdriver, slotted 1/4 in.X 6 in. 9-GH300ME Steel Rule Metric 6 inch

9-4118 Screwdriver, Phillips #2, Stubby 9-XL9920 Xcelite-hex Blade.050 inch

9-41293 Screwdriver, Phillips #0 9-XL9921 Xcelite-hex Blade 1/16 inch

9-41294 Screwdriver, Phillips #1 9-XL9922 Xcelite-hex Blade 5/16 inch

9-41295 Screwdriver, Phillips #2 9-XL9923 Xcelite-hex Blade 3/32 inch

9-46677 Hex Keys, 20 pc., Metric 9-XL9924 Xcelite-hex Blade 1/8 inch

9-34701 1/4 in. Standard.Socket set (19 pc) 9-XL9925 Xcelite-hex Blade 5/32 inch

9-43499 1/2 inch Socket 1/4 inch drive 9-XL9926 Xcelite-hex Blade 3/16 inch

9-4355 Flex Spinner 9-XL99764 Xcelite-hex Blade 7/64

9-43523 Breaker 9-XL99964 Xcelite-hex Blade 9/64

9-43531 6 inch Ext. 9-XLM60 Mini-screwdriver kit

10 - 4 Section 10-3 - Maintenance Task Schedule


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Table 10-3 Overview of GE-1 Tool Kit Contents (Continued)

Tool ID Description Tool ID Description

9-65283 Case 8.5 in. x 4.5 in. x 2 in. Deep 9-45072 Pliers 6 inch Diagonal

9-46696 Hex Keys 9-XL100X Wire Stripper/Cutter 5 inch - 100X

9-39829 Torpedo Level, Magnetic 9-XL87CG Pliers - very fine needle nose-87CG

9-38461 Hammer, Ball Peen, 4 oz 9-WEWDT-07 Weller-Soldering-Replacement Tip(1)

9-4280 Universal Joint 1/4 inch 9-WS175-E Wiss - Surgical Scissors

9-WEW60P3 Weller - Soldering Iron, 3 wire KH174 Hemostat 5 inch Straight

9-WECT5B6 Weller - Soldering Iron Tip KH175 Hemostat 5 inch curved

9-WEWDP12 Weller - Desoldering Pump 9-Z9480121 Alignment tool (red)

93383 Flashlight Mini-Mag Lite (AAA Bat.)

9-GH408 Tweezers

21576 Brush - Bristle

9-4516 Pliers 4 1/4 inch Diagonal

Table 10-4 Overview of GE-2 Tool Kit Contents

GE-2 Sears Kit (#99034)

Tool ID Description Tool ID Description

9-45381 Pliers, Arc Joint 9 1/2 inch 9-44067 Socket 1 1/16 in. for 1/2 in. drive

9-45092 Pliers, Linesman 8 1/2 inch 9-42679 Socket 10MM Hex for 1/2 in. drive (2273333)

9-42882 Punch, Pin 3/32 inch 9-44262 Extension 10 inch for 1/2 in. drive (2273405)

9-42884 Punch, Pin 5/32 inch 9-4258 3/8 inch to 1/2 inch Adapter

9-42886 Punch, Pin 1/4 inch 9-34374 3/8 inch Metric Socket Set - 12 PT

9-42973 Cold Chisel 1/2 inch 9-44311 16mm Socket 12 pt.

9-GH77 Center Punch Automatic 9-33485 Metal Socket Tray

9-GH890 File Handle, Adj. 9-33484 Metal Socket Tray

9-31276 File, Round, Bastard 8 inch 9-33484 Metal Socket Tray

9-31277 File, Half Round, Bastard 8 inch 9-52068 Tap and Drill Set

9-31263 File, Flat Mill 8 inch 9-52722 #6 Tap

21045C Close Quarter Saw 9-52723 #8 Tap

9-44604 Wrench, Adj 10 inch High Speed Drill Set

9-41587 Screwdriver 5/16 inch x 8 inch #36 Drill

9-41586 Screwdriver, Stubby 5/16 inch #29 Drill

9-GH19512 Countersink 1/2 inch 9-44046 3/8 inch Socket Set

9-44741 12 PC Combination Wrench Set

Section 10-3 - Maintenance Task Schedule 10 - 5


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-4-2 Special Tools, Supplies and Equipment

10-4-2-1 Specific Requirements for Care & Maintenance

Table 10-5 Overview of Requirements for Care & Maintenance

Tool Part Number Comments


Digital Volt Meter (DVM)

Electric Safety Analyzer DALE 600 46-285652G1 For 120V Unit

Electric Safety Analyzer DALE


46-328406G2 For 220V Units
600E

Leakage Current Ultrasound Kit 2113015 For 120V and 220V Units

46–194427P231 Kit includes anti–static mat, wrist strap and cables for 200 to 240
46–194427P279 V system
Anti Static Kit 46–194427P369 3M #2204 Large adjustable wrist strap
46–194427P373 3M #2214 Small adjustable wrist strap
46–194427P370 3M #3051 conductive ground cord

46–194427P278 120V
Anti Static Vacuum Cleaner
46–194427P279 230V

Air Filter Section 9-18 air intake

Safety Analyzer 46–285652G1 DALE 600 KIT (or equivalent) for electrical tests

E7010GG 60 minute
SVHS VCR Cassette
E7010GF 120 minute

SVHS VCR Head Cleaner See VCR user manual for requirements

E8381AA blank 128 M disk


E8381AB blank 230 M disk
3.5” MOD MEDIA

5.25” MOD Media

3.5” MOD Media Cleaner 2117811 cleans the diskettes

5.25” MOD Media Cleaner cleans the diskettes

3.5” MOD Head Cleaner Kit 2148392 cleans the drive heads

5.25” MOD Head Cleaner Kit cleans the drive heads

QIQ Phantom E8370RB RMI Grayscale Target Model 403GS

CD-RW Media For LOGIQ™ P5

B/W Printer Cleaning Sheet See printer user manual for requirements

Color Printer Cleaning Sheet See printer user manual for requirements

Disposable Gloves

10 - 6 Section 10-3 - Maintenance Task Schedule


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 10-5
System Maintenance
10-5-1 Preliminary Checks
The preliminary checks take about 15 minutes to perform. refer to the system user documentation
whenever necessary.

Table 10-6 System Checks

Step Item Description


1 Ask & Listen Ask the customer if they have any problems or questions about the equipment.

Fill in the top of the Ultrasound Inspection Certificate (see page 29). Note all probes and system
2 Paperwork
options.

3 Power up Turn the system power on and verify that all fans and peripherals turn on. Watch the displays during
power up to verify that no warning or error messages are displayed.

4 Probes Verify that the system properly recognizes all probes.

5 Displays Verify proper display on the monitor and touch panel.

6 Presets Backup all customer presets on an CD-RW.

Section 10-3 - Maintenance Task Schedule 10 - 7


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-5-2 Functional Checks (See Also Chapter 4)


The functional checks take about 60 minutes to perform. refer to the system user documentation
whenever necessary.

10-5-2-1 System Checks

Table 10-7 System Functional Checks

Chec
k Step Description

Verify basic B-Mode (2D) operation. Check the basic system controls that affect this mode
B-Mode
of operation.

CF-Mode Verify basic CF-Mode (Color Flow Mode) operation. Check the basic system controls that
affect this mode of operation.

Verify basic Doppler operation (PW and CW if available). Check the basic system controls
Doppler Modes
that affect this mode of operation.

Verify basic M-Mode operation. Check the basic system controls that affect this mode of
M-Mode
operation.

*Applicable Software Verify the basic operation of all optional modes such as Multi-Image, 3D, Contrast,
Harmonics, Cine, Stress Echo,... etc. Check the basic system controls that affect each
Options
options operation.

Use the Visual Channel Utility on the 10L probe to verify that all system xmit/recv channels
Xmit/Recv Elements
are functional.

Keyboard Test Perform the Keyboard Test Procedure to verify that all keyboard controls are OK.

Monitor Verify basic Monitor display functions. refer to Chapter 3 of the User Manual.

Touch Panel Verify basic Touch Panel display functions. refer to Chapter 3 of the User Manual.

Scan a gray scale phantom and use the measurement controls to verify distance and area
Measurements calculation accuracy. refer to the User Manual, Chapter 18, for measurement accuracy
specifications.

NOTE: * Some software may be considered standard depending upon system model configuration.

10 - 8 Section 10-3 - Maintenance Task Schedule


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-5-2-2 Peripheral/Option Checks


If any peripherals or options are not part of the system configuration, the check can be omitted. refer to
the User Manual for a list of approved peripherals/options.

Table 10-8 GE Approved Peripheral/Hardware Option Functional Checks

Step Item Description


1 VCR Verify record/playback capabilities of the VCR. Clean heads and covers if necessary.

2 B/W Printer Verify hardcopy output of the B/W video page printer. Clean heads and covers if necessary.

3 Color Printer Verify hardcopy output of the Color video page printer. Clean heads and covers if necessary.

4 DICOM Verify that DICOM is functioning properly. Send an image to a DICOM device.

Verify that InSite is functioning properly. Ensure two-way remote communications.


5 InSite/iLinq
(Warranty & Contract Customers only)

6 Camera Verify hardcopy output of the film camera. Clean as necessary.

7 Footswitch Verify that the footswitch is functioning as programed. Clean as necessary.

8 ECG Verify basic operation with customer

10-5-3 Input Power

10-5-3-1 Mains Cable Inspection

Table 10-9 Mains Cable Inspection

Step Item Description


1 Unplug Cord Disconnect the mains cable from the wall and system.

2 Inspect Inspect it and its connectors for damage of any kind.

3 Verify Verify that the LINE, NEUTRAL and GROUND wires are properly attached to the terminals, and that no
strands may cause a short circuit.

4 Verify Inlet connector retainer is functional.

10-5-4 Cleaning

10-5-4-1 General Cleaning

Table 10-10 General Cleaning

Step Item Description

1 Console Use a fluid detergent in warm water on a soft, damp cloth to carefully wipe the entire system. Be careful
not to get the cloth too wet so that moisture does not enter the console.

2 Probe Holder Clean probe holders (they may need to be soaked to remove excess gel).

Section 10-3 - Maintenance Task Schedule 10 - 9


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-5-4-2 Air Filter Cleaning

Table 10-11 Air Filter Cleaning - frequency varies with your environment

Step Item Description


Remove Filter
1 refer to Chapter 8 for air filter location and removal instructions.
Cover

2 Clean Filter The filters can be cleaned in sprinkling water, or they can be dusted with a vacuum cleaner. If the filter
is metal wash and/or vacuum. If the filter is fiber or plastic vacuum or replace.

3 Install Filter Install the clean filter.

NOTE: For your convenience or of the air filter is too dirty, replacement filters are available. refer to
Chapter 9 for the air filter replacement part number.

10-5-5 Physical Inspection

Table 10-12 Physical Checks

Step Item Description

Verify that all system labeling is present and in readable condition. refer to the LOGIQ™ P5 User
1 Labeling
Manual for details.

2 Scratches & Dents Inspect the console for dents, scratches or cracks.

3 Control Panel Inspect keyboard and control panel. Note any damaged or missing items.

Control Panel Verify ease of control panel (Operator I/O Panel) movement in all acceptable directions. Ensure that
4
Movement it latches in position as required.

5 Wheels & Brakes Check all wheels and casters for wear and verify operation of foot brake, to stop the unit from moving,
and release mechanism. Check all caster locks and caster swivel locks for proper operation.

Cables & Check all internal cable harnesses and connectors for wear and secure connector seating. Pay
6
Connectors special attention to footswitch assembly and probe strain or bend reliefs.

Shielding & Check to ensure that all EMI shielding, internal covers, air flow panels and screws are in place.
7
Covers Missing covers and hardware could cause EMI/RFI problems while scanning.

8 External I/O Check all connectors for damage and verify that the labeling is good.

9 Op Panel Lights Check for proper operation of all operator panel and TGC lights.

10 Monitor Light Check for proper operation of any monitor lights if available.

External
11 Check for proper operation of any external microphones by recording an audio test.
Microphone

10 - 10 Section 10-3 - Maintenance Task Schedule


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-5-6 Optional Diagnostic Checks


Optionally you can access the diagnostic software as described in Chapters 5 or 7. View the error logs
and run desired diagnostics.

10-5-6-1 View the Logs


1.) Review the system error log for any problems.
2.) Check the temperature log to see if there are any trends that could cause problems in the future.
3.) Check the Configuration Log; update if needed.

10-5-7 Probe Maintenance

10-5-7-1 Probe Related Checks

Table 10-13 Probe Related Checks

Step Item Description


1 Probe Holder Clean probe holders (they may need to be soaked to remove excess gel).

Thoroughly check the system probe connectors and remove dust from inside the connector sockets
2 Probes
if necessary. Visually check for bent, damaged or missing pins

10-5-7-2 Basic Probe Care


The system user manuals and various probe handling cards provide a complete description of probe
care, maintenance, cleaning and disinfection. Ensure that you are completely familiar with the proper
care of GE probes.

Ultrasound probes can be easily damaged by improper handling. See the User Manual and probe care
cards for more details. Failure to follow these precautions can result in serious injury and equipment
damage. Failure to properly handle or maintain a probe may also void its warranty.

Any evidence of wear indicates the probe cannot be used.

Do a visual check of the probe pins and system sockets before plugging in a probe.

TEE and Interoperative probes often have special considerations and individual probe user manuals.
For TEE and Interoperative probes also refer to their separate user manuals.

10-5-7-3 Basic Probe Cleaning


refer to the User’s Manual for details on probe cleaning.

NOTE: To help protect yourself from blood borne diseases, wear approved disposable gloves. These are made
of nitrile derived from vegetable starch to prevent allergic latex reactions.

NOTE: Failure to follow the prescribed cleaning or disinfection procedures will void the probe’s
warranty. DO NOT soak or wipe the lens with any product not listed in the User Manual. Doing
so could result in irreparable damage to the probe. Follow care instructions that came with the
probe.

NOTE: Disinfect a defective probe before you return it. Be sure to tag the probe as being disinfected.

Section 10-3 - Maintenance Task Schedule 10 - 11


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 10-6
Electrical Safety Tests
10-6-1 Safety Test Overview
The electrical safety tests in this section are based on and conform to NFPA 99 (For USA) and IEC
60601-1 Medical Equipment Safety Standards. They are intended for the electrical safety evaluation of
cord-connected, electrically operated, patient care equipment. If additional information is needed, refer
to the NFPA 99 (For USA) and IEC 60601-1 documents.

WARNING THE USER MUST ENSURE THAT THE SAFETY INSPECTIONS ARE PERFORMED AT
LEAST EVERY 12 MONTHS ACCORDING TO THE REQUIREMENTS OF THE PATIENT
SAFETY STANDARD IEC-EN 60601-1. ONLY TRAINED PERSONS ARE ALLOWED TO
PERFORM THE SAFETY INSPECTIONS MENTIONED ABOVE.

CAUTION To avoid electrical shock, the unit under test must not be connected to other electrical
equipment. Remove all interconnecting cables and wires. The unit under test must not be
contacted by users or patients while performing these tests.

CAUTION Possible risk of infection. Do not handle soiled or contaminated probes and other components
that have been in patient contact. Follow appropriate cleaning and disinfecting procedures
before handling the equipment.

Test the system, peripherals and probes for leakage current. Excessive leakage current can cause
injury or death in sensitive patients. High leakage current can also indicate degradation of insulation and
a potential for electrical failure. Do not use probes or equipment having excessive leakage current.

To minimize the risk that a probe may shock someone the customer should:

• Not use a probe that is cracked or damaged in any way


• Check probe leakage current:
* Based on your facilities QA program for surface probes
* Based on your facilities QA program for endocavitary probes
* whenever probe damage is suspected

10 - 12 Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-2 GEMS Leakage Current Limits


The following limits are summarized for NFPA 99 (For USA) and IEC 60601-1 Medical Equipment
Safety Standards. These limits are GEMS standards and in some cases are lower than the above
standards listed.

Table 10-14 Chassis Leakage Current Limits—Accessible Metal Surfaces

Country Normal Condition Open Ground Reverse Polarity Open Neutral

USA N/A 0.3 mA 0.3 mA N/A

Other 0.1 mA 0.5 mA 0.5 mA 0.5 mA

Table 10-15 Type BF Applied Part Leakage Current Limits - Non-Conductive (Floating) Surface
and Cavity Probes

Normal
Country Condition Open Ground Reverse Polarity Open Neutral *Mains Applied

USA 0.05 mA 0.05 mA 0.05 mA 0.05 mA N/A

Other 0.1 mA 0.5 mA 0.5 mA 0.5 mA 5.0 mA

Table 10-16 Type CF Applied Part Leakage Current Limits - Surgical Probes and ECG
Connections

Normal
Country Condition Open Ground Reverse Polarity Open Neutral *Mains Applied

USA 0.01 mA 0.05mA 0.05 mA N/A 0.025 mA

Other 0.01 mA 0.05 mA 0.05 mA 0.05 mA 0.05 mA

NOTE: *Mains Applied refers to the sink leakage test where mains (supply) voltage is applied to the
part to determine the amount of current that will pass (or sink) to ground if a patient contacted
mains voltage.

The following tests are performed at the factory and should be performed at the site. These tests are:
grounding continuity, chassis leakage current, probe leakage current, and ECG leakage current. All
measurements are made with an electrical safety analyzer Model 600/600E built by Dale Technology
Corporation or equivalent device.

Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests 10 - 13


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-3 Outlet Test - Wiring Arrangement - USA & Canada


Test all outlets in the area for proper grounding and wiring arrangement by plugging in the neon outlet
tester and noting the combination of lights that are illuminated. Any problems found should be reported
to the hospital immediately and the receptacle should not be used.

Figure 10-1 Typical Outlet Tester

The Dale 600 has self-contained lamps designed for testing the outlet wiring arrangement. Plug the
Dale 600 into each outlet to be tested comparing the lamp status.

Combination
of
Lights

CORRECT REVERSE OPEN OPEN HOT/GROUND


Condition POLARITY GROUND
WIRING HOT REVERSED

Figure 10-2 Dale 600 Outlet Test

NOTE: No outlet tester can detect the condition where the Neutral (grounded supply) conductor and the
Grounding (protective earth) conductor are reversed. If later tests indicate high leakage currents, this
should be suspected as a possible cause and the outlet wiring should be visually inspected.

10 - 14 Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-4 Grounding Continuity


CAUTION Electric Shock Hazard. The patient must not be contacted to the equipment during this test

Measure the resistance from the third pin of the attachment plug to the exposed metal parts of the case.
The ground wire resistance should be less than 0.2 ohms. reference the procedure in the IEC 601-1.1.

Figure 10-3 Ground Continuity Test

10-6-4-1 Meter Procedure


Follow these steps to test the ground wire resistance.

1.) Turn the LOGIQ™ P5 unit OFF.


2.) Plug the unit into the meter, and the meter into the tested AC wall outlet.
3.) Plug the black chassis cable into the meter's “CHASSIS” connector and attach the black chassis
cable clamp to an exposed metal part of the LOGIQ™ P5 unit.
4.) Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to the RESISTANCE position.
5.) Set the meter's “POLARITY” switch to the OFF (center) position.
6.) Measure and record the ground wire resistance.

Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests 10 - 15


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-4-2 Dale 600 - Ground Continuity


The Dale 600 measures line cord resistance from the third pin of the attachment plug to the meter’s
Chassis Cable clamp. Test the grounding continuity of the system to all exposed metal parts in
accordance with the IEC 601-1.1 procedure as above. refer to the Dale 600 Instruction Manual for meter
self tests and operation. Record measured resistance of the grounding continuity. The ground wire
resistance should be less than 0.2 (Use any safety analyzer.)

Outlet Test
Lamps

Functions Normal
Selector Reverse
Polarity

Neutral
Open/Closed
Chassis
Cable
Clamp

Figure 10-4 Dale 600 Ground Continuity Test

10 - 16 Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-5 Chassis Leakage Current Test

10-6-5-1 Definition
This test measures the current that would flow in a grounded person who touched accessible metal
parts of the bedside station if the ground wire should break. The test verifies the isolation of the power
line from the chassis. The meter is connected from accessible metal parts of the case to ground.
Measurements should be made with the unit On and Off, with the power line polarity Normal and
Reversed. Record the highest reading.
.

CAUTION Electric Shock Hazard. When the meter's ground switch is OPEN, don't touch the unit!

CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged.

10-6-5-2 Generic Procedure


The test verifies the isolation of the power line from the chassis. The testing meter is connected from
accessible metal parts of the case to ground. Measurements should be made with the unit ON and OFF,
with the power line polarity Normal and Reversed. Record the highest reading of current.

Figure 10-5 Set Up for Chassis Source Leakage Current,


IEC 601-1 Clause 19 - Continuos Leakage Currents and
Patient, Auxiliary Currents

When using the Microguard or a similar test instrument, its power plug may be inserted into the wall
outlet and the equipment under test is plugged into the receptacle on the panel of the meter. This places
the meter in the grounding conductor and the current flowing from the case to ground will be indicated
in any of the current ranges. The maximum allowable limit for chassis source leakage is shown in
Table 10-14.

Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests 10 - 17


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-5-3 Dale 600 Meter Procedure


When measuring system chassis currents with the Dale 600, always use the CHASSIS selection of the
external/chassis function switch. This requires the ground clip lead and changing the meters switches
in accordance with the IEC 601-1.1. refer to the Dale 600 Instruction Manual for meter self-test and
operation. Record the highest leakage current measured.

Follow these steps to test the unit for leakage current.

1.) Turn the LOGIQ™ P5 unit OFF.


2.) Plug the unit into the meter, and the meter into the tested AC wall outlet
3.) Plug the black chassis cable into the meter's “CHASSIS” connector and attach the black chassis
cable clamp to an exposed metal part of the LOGIQ™ P5.
4.) Set the tester's “FUNCTION” switch to CHASSIS position.

Outlet Test
Lamps

Functions Normal
Selector Reverse
Polarity

Neutral
Open/Closed
Chassis
Cable
Clamp

Figure 10-6 Ground and Chassis Leakage Current Test

5.) Follow the test conditions described for respective test points shown in Table 10-17.

Table 10-17 Chassis Leakage Current Test Condition

TEST CONDITION
1 Mounting screw for probe receptacle

2 caster support

3 Mounting screw for CRT housing

4 Mounting screw for peripheral plugged into unit

5 Mounting screw for other peripheral powered by unit

6.) Keep a record of the results with other hard copies of PM data kept on site.

10 - 18 Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-5-4 Data Sheet for Chassis Source Leakage Current


The test passes when all readings measure less than the value shown in Table 10-14. Record all data
on the PM Inspection Certificate.

Table 10-18 Typical Data Sheet for Chassis Source Leakage Current

Tester Neutral Test 1


Tester Polarity or Ground Probe Test 2 Test 3 Optional Optional
Unit Power Switch Switch Connector caster CRT Test 4 Test 5
Enter Name of tested peripheral here:

ON NORM OPEN

ON NORM CLOSED

ON REV OPEN

ON REV CLOSED

OFF NORM OPEN

OFF NORM CLOSED

OFF REV OPEN


OFF REV CLOSED

10-6-6 Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead to Ground

10-6-6-1 Definition
This test measures the current which would flow to ground from any of the isolated ECG leads. The
meter simulates a patient who is connected to the monitoring equipment and is grounded by touching
some other grounded surface. Measurements should be made with the ground open and closed, with
power line polarity normal and reversed, and with the ultrasound console Off and On. For each
combination the operating controls, such as the lead switch, should be operated to find the worst case
condition.

CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity when the unit is powered ON. Be sure
to turn the unit power OFF before switching the polarity using the POLARITY switch. Otherwise,
the unit may be damaged.

Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests 10 - 19


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-6-2 Generic Procedure


Measurements should be made with the ground open and closed, with power line polarity normal and
reversed, and with the unit Off and On. For each combination, the operating controls such as the lead
switch should be operated to find the worst case condition.

Appliance power switch


(use both "off" and "on" positions) Patient lead selector switch (if any)
The connection is at service entrance (activated as required)
or on the supply side of a separately
Polarity reversing switch
derived system
(use both positions) Patient connected leads
Appliance
H (Black)
H
POWER
N
OUTLET
N (White)
Internal
G
circuitry Between each patient
lead and ground
G (Green)

Building Insulating surface


ground
Current meter
Grounding contact switch (use in both H = Hot
"open" and "closed" positions) N = Neutral (grounded)
G = Grounding conductor

Figure 10-7 Test Circuit for Measuring Non-Isolated


Patient Leads

10-6-6-3 Dale 600 Meter Procedure


The Dale 600 provides five snap type ECG buttons for testing patient leads. Snap on all patient leads
to the meter and assure that the ground clip is connected to the system’s ground terminal. Select the
meter’s LEAD-GND function. Select and test each ECG lead positions (except “ALL”) of the LEAD
selector, testing each to the power condition combinations found in “PATIENT LEAD LEAKAGE” table
in the “PM CHECKLIST”. Record the highest leakage current measured for each Power selection.

CAUTION Line voltage is applied to the ECG leads during this test. To avoid possible electric shock
hazard, the system being tested must not be touched by patients, users or anyone while the ISO
TEST switch is depressed. When the meter's ground switch is OPEN, don't touch the unit!

Follow these steps to test the ECG module for leakage current.

1.) Turn the LOGIQ™ P5 unit OFF.


2.) Plug the unit into the meter, and the meter into the tested AC wall outlet.
3.) Plug the black chassis cable into the meter's “CHASSIS” connector and attach the black chassis
cable clamp to an exposed metal part of the LOGIQ™ P5 unit.
4.) Connect the patient leads to the corresponding snaps located at the upper front of the Dale 600/
600E. Lead nomenclature for this test is not important.

10 - 20 Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-6-3Dale 600 Meter Procedure (cont’d)

ECG
Patient
Cable

ECG
Lead
Selector

ISO
Rocker
Switch

Figure 10-8 ECG Leakage Current Test

5.) Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to LEAD TO GROUND position to measure the patient lead to
ground leakage current.
6.) Select and test each ECG lead positions (except ALL) of the LEAD selector, testing each to the
power condition combinations.

Table 10-19 Testing Power Conditions

ECG Power Meter’s Polarity Switch Meter’s Neutral Switch


ON NORM CLOSED

ON NORM OPEN

ON REVERSE CLOSED

ON REVERSE OPEN

OFF NORM CLOSED

OFF NORM OPEN

OFF REVERSE CLOSED

OFF REVERSE OPEN

Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests 10 - 21


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-6-3Dale 600 Meter Procedure (cont’d)


7.) Record the patient lead to ground leakage current measured on the data sheet.
8.) Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to LEAD TO LEAD position to measure the lead to lead leakage
current.
9.) Select and test each ECG lead positions (except ALL) of the LEAD selector, testing each to the
power condition combinations.
10.)Record the lead to lead leakage current measured on the data sheet.
11.)Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to LEAD ISO position to measure the patient lead isolation
current.
12.)Select and test each ECG lead positions (except ALL) of the LEAD selector, testing each to the
power condition combinations.
13.)Depress the rocker switch to ISO TEST and read the isolation current. To apply the voltage to the
lead safely, the voltage is only applied when the rocker switch is depressed to ISO TEST.
14.)Record the patient lead isolation current measured on the data sheet.

10-6-7 Isolated Patient Lead (Source) Leakage–Lead to Lead


reference the procedure in the IEC 60601-1. When using the Dale 600, switch the meter’s function
selector to the LEAD-LEAD position. Select and test each of the five ECG lead positions (except ALL)
on the LEAD selector, testing each to the power condition combinations found in the table. Record the
highest leakage current measured.

10-6-7-1 Dale 600 Patient Lead Tests


NEUTRAL POLARITY

1.) Closed Normal


2.) Open Normal
3.) Closed Reversed
4.) Open Reversed

10-6-8 Isolated Patient Lead (Sink) Leakage-Isolation Test


reference the procedure in the IEC 60601-1. When using the Dale 600, switch the meter’s function
selector to the LEAD-ISO. Select the ALL position on the lead selector. Depress the rocker switch to
ISO TEST to test lead isolation.

CAUTION Line voltage is applied to the ECG leads during this test. To avoid possible electric shock
hazard, the system being tested must not be touched by patients, users or anyone while the ISO
TEST switch is depressed.

NOTE: It is not necessary to test each lead individually or power condition combinations as required in
previous tests.

10 - 22 Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-8-1 Data Sheet for ECG Leakage Current


The test passes when all readings measure less than the value shown in the table below. Record all
data on the PM Inspection Certificate.

Table 10-20 Maximum Allowance Limit for ECG Leakage Current

Maximum
Allowance Limit

AC Power GROUND
Source GROUND OPEN CLOSED
Patient Lead to Ground Leakage Current Test 115V 10uA 10uA
and
220/240V 500uA 10uA
Patient Lead to Lead Leakage Current Test

Table 10-21 Maximum Allowance Limit for ECG Leakage Current

AC Power Maximum
Source Allowance Limit
115V 20uA
Patient Lead Isolation Current Test
220/240V 5mA

Table 10-22 Typical Data Sheet for ECG Leakage Current

Tester Tester Tester Lead Selector


ECG Polarity Ground
Power Switch Switch RL RA LA LL C
ON NORM CLOSED
ON REVERSE CLOSED

ON NORM OPEN

ON REVERSE OPEN

OFF NORM CLOSED

OFF REVERSE CLOSED

OFF NORM OPEN

OFF REVERSE OPEN

Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests 10 - 23


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-9 Probe Leakage Current Test

10-6-9-1 Definition
This test measures the current that would flow to ground from any of the probes through a patient who
is being scanned and becomes grounded by touching some other grounded surface.

10-6-9-2 Generic Procedure


Measurements should be made with the ground open and closed, with power line polarity normal and
reversed, and with the unit Off and On. For each combination, the probe must be active to find the worst
case condition.

POLARITY REVERSING SWITCH


H (BLACK) PROBE

CONSOLE
POWER N (WHITE)
OUTLET

G (GREEN)

MOMENTARY
SWITCH LEAKAGE TEST
METER

Figure 10-9 Set Up for Probe Leakage Current

NOTE: Each probe will have some amount of leakage current, dependent on its design. Small variations in
probe leakage currents are normal from probe to probe. Other variations will result from differences in
line voltage and test lead placement.

10-6-9-3 Meter Procedure Using Probe Adapter


The Dale 600/600E provides a method for testing probes independently from the system. The meter
utilizes a probe adapter to apply a test potential commonly to all connector pins.

The probe's imaging area is immersed in a saline solution along with a grounding probe from the
meter to complete the current path. Saline solution is a mixture of water and salt. The salt adds a free
ion to the water, making it conductive. Normal saline solution is 0.9% salt or 1/2 gram salt per 1 liter of
water. If saline is not available, a mixture of 1 quart water with one or more grams of table salt, mixed
thoroughly, will substitute.

CAUTION To avoid probe damage and possible electric shock, do not immerse probes into any liquid
beyond the level indicated in the probe users manual. Do not touch the probe, conductive liquid
or any part of the unit under test while the ISO TEST switch is depressed.

Follow these steps to test each transducer for leakage current.

1.) Turn the LOGIQ™ P5 unit OFF.


2.) Plug the unit into the test meter, and the meter into the tested AC wall outlet.
3.) Connect the probe for test with the meter's appropriate adapter.
4.) Plug the saline probe into the meter's “CHASSIS” connector.
5.) Plug the probe adapter into the meter's connector marked “EXTERNAL”.

10 - 24 Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-9-3Meter Procedure Using Probe Adapter (cont’d)

Figure 10-10 Transducer Source Leakage Current Test

6.) Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to EXTERNAL position.


7.) Add the saline probe and the imaging area of the probe into the saline bath.
8.) Have unit power ON for the first part; turn it OFF for the second half.
9.) Depress the ISO TEST rocker switch and record the highest current reading.
10.)Follow the test conditions described in Table 10-23 for every transducer.
11.)Keep a record of the results with other hand copies of PM data.

Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests 10 - 25


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-9-4 No Meter Probe Adapter Procedure

Figure 10-11 Check Without Probe Adapter

Follow these steps to test each transducer for leakage current.

1.) Turn the LOGIQ™ P5 unit OFF.


2.) Plug the unit into the test meter, and the meter into the tested AC wall outlet.
3.) Plug the external probe into the meter's (Dale 600) “EXTERNAL” connector.
4.) Set the meter's “FUNCTION” switch to EXTERNAL position.
5.) Connect the probe for test with the connector of the console.
6.) Add the saline probe and the imaging area of the probe into the saline bath.
7.) Have unit power ON for the first part; turn it OFF for the second half.
8.) Depress the ISO TEST rocker switch and record the highest current reading.
9.) Follow the test conditions described in Table 10-23 for every transducer.
10.)Keep a record of the results with other hand copies of PM data.

10 - 26 Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

10-6-9-5 Data Sheet for Transducer Source Leakage Current


The test passes when all readings measure less than the values shown in Table 10-15 and Table 10-
16. Record all data on the PM Inspection Certificate.

CAUTION Equipment damage possibility. Never switch the Polarity and the status of Neutral when the unit
is powered ON. Be sure to turn the unit power OFF before switching them using the POLARITY
switch and/or the NEUTRAL switch. Otherwise, the unit may be damaged
.

Table 10-23 Typical Data Sheet For Transducer Source Leakage Current

Transducer Tested:

Tester Power Polarity Tester GROUND or


Unit Power Switch NEUTRAL Switch Measurement
ON NORM OPEN

ON NORM CLOSED

ON REV OPEN

ON REV CLOSED

OFF NORM OPEN

OFF NORM CLOSED


OFF REV OPEN

OFF REV CLOSED

Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests 10 - 27


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Section 10-7
When There's Too Much Leakage Current...
CHASSIS FAILS
Check the ground on the power cord and plug for continuity. Ensure the ground is not broken, frayed,
or intermittent. Replace any defective part.

Tighten all grounds. Ensure star washers are under all ground studs.

Inspect wiring for bad crimps, poor connections, or damage.

Test the wall outlet; verify it is grounded and is free of other wiring abnormalities. Notify the user or
owner to correct any deviations. As a work around, check the other outlets to see if they could be used
instead.

NOTE: No outlet tester can detect the condition where the white neutral wire and the green grounding
wire are reversed. If later tests indicate high leakage currents, this should be suspected as a
possible cause and the outlet wiring should be visually inspected.

PROBE FAILS
Test the probe in another connector to isolate if the fault lies with the probe or the scanner.

NOTE: Each probe will have some amount of leakage, dependent on its design. Small variations in
probe leakage currents are normal from probe to probe. Other variations will result from
differences in line voltage and test lead placement. The maximum allowable leakage current for
body surface contact probe differs from inter-cavity probe. Be sure to enter the correct probe
type in the appropriate space on the check list.

If excessive leakage current is slot dependent, inspect the system connector for bent pins, poor
connections, and ground continuity.

If the problem remains with the probe, replace the probe.

PERIPHERAL FAILS
Tighten all grounds. Ensure star washers are under all ground studs.

Inspect wiring for bad crimps, poor connections, or damage.

STILL FAILS
If all else fails, begin isolation by removing the probes, external peripherals, then the on board ones,
one at a time while monitoring the leakage current measurement.

NEW UNIT
If the leakage current measurement tests fail on a new unit and if situation can not be corrected, submit
a Safety Failure Report to document the system problem. Remove unit from operation.

ECG FAILS
Inspect cables for damage or poor connections.

10 - 28 Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

ULTRASOUND INSPECTION CERTIFICATE


Customer Name: System ID: Dispatch Number / Date Performed: Warranty/Contract/HBS

System Type Model Number: Serial Number: Manufacture Date:

Probe 1: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number:

Probe 2: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number:

Probe 3: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number:

Probe 4: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number:

Probe 5: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number:

Probe 6: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number:

Probe 7: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number:

Probe 8: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number:

Probe 9: Frequency: Scan Format*: Model Number: Serial Number:

* Scan Format: Phased Array, Linear Array, Curved Array, Mechanical Array or Other

FUNCTIONAL CHECKS PHYSICAL INSPECTION AND CLEANING


OK? or Physical Inspection and Cleaning
Functional Check (if applicable) N/A (if applicable) Inspect Clean

B-Mode Function Console

Doppler Modes Function Monitor

CF-Mode Function Touch Panel

M-Mode Function Air Filter

Applicable Software Options Probe Holders

Applicable Hardware Options External I/O

Control Panel Wheels, Brakes & Swivel Locks

Monitor Cables and Connectors

GE Approved Peripherals (VCR, CD-RW, MOD,


Touch Panel
Printers)

Measurement Accuracy

GE Approved Peripherals

COMMENTS:
______________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________
______________________________________________________________________________

Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests 10 - 29


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

ELECTRICAL SAFETY
Max Value Value
Electrical Test Performed Allowed Measured OK? Comments

Outlet (correct ground &wiring config.)

System Ground Continuity

Chassis Source Leakage Current - Probe

Chassis Source Leakage Current - Caster

Chassis Source Leakage Current - CRT

Patient Lead Source Leakage


(Lead to Ground)

Patient Lead Source Leakage


(Lead to Lead)

Patient Lead Source Leakage


(Isolation)

Peripheral 1 Leakage Current

Peripheral 1Ground Continuity

Peripheral 2 Leakage Current

Peripheral 2Ground Continuity

Peripheral 3 Leakage Current

Peripheral 3Ground Continuity

PROBES

Probe Number Max Value Max Value


(from previous page) Allowed Measured OK? Comments

Probe 1:

Probe 2:

Probe 3:

Probe 4:

Probe 5:

Probe 6:

Probe 7:

Probe 8:

Probe 9:

Final Check. All system covers are in place. System scans with all probes as expected.

Accepted by: ______________________________________________________________________

10 - 30 Section 10-6 - Electrical Safety Tests


GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

A
Abbreviations, 9-1
AC Box Assy, 8-50
AC Power, 5-12
AC Transformer, 8-56
Acoustic Noise Output, 3-8
Air Filter Cleaning, 10-8
Air Flow Control, 5-21
Archiving Presets, 4-10
Available Probes, 3-14

B
Back End Processor, 5-6
Backend Processor Checks, 4-16
Basic Measurements, 4-15
Block Diagrams, 5-2
Boards in the NEST Assy, 8-32
Boot Up, 4-2
Brake Function Adjustment, 6-4
Brakes and Direction Locks Checks, 4-19

C
Cables, 9-16
Caster Link Assy, 8-66
Casters and Pedals, 9-5
CD-RW Drive, 4-6
CD-RW, MO, or ECG, 8-60
Chassis Leakage Current Test, 10-14
Cine, 4-15
Circuit Board Assemblies, 9-11
Circuit Breaker, 4-2
Common Service Platform, 5-16
CONN Box Assy, 8-36
Connecting Cables, 3-12
Console Requirements, 2-2
Contact Information, 1-13
Contrast and Brightness Adjustment, 6-6
Conventions, 1-3
CPU, 5-6
Customer Assistance, 1-13

D
- A-1
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

DC Power, 5-13
DDBF, 6-10
DICOM Network Function, 2-9
Dimensions, 3-7
Display platform Maneuverability check, 4-17

E
ECG Checks, 4-16
Electrical Requirements, 2-3
Electrical Safety, 1-8
Electrical Safety Tests, 10-10
Electrical Specifications, 3-8
EMC, 1-12
EMI, 1-12
EMI Limitations, 2-4
Environmental Requirements, 2-2
Equipment, 10-4
Equipment Models, 9-2
ESD, 1-12
External I/O, 5-7

F
Facility Needs, 2-6
FAN Assy, 8-54
Fans, 5-22
Front Cover, 8-6
Front End, 5-4
FRU Replacement Procedures, 8-18
Functional Checks, 4-15,, 10-6
Fuse, 8-34

G
General Cleaning, 10-7
General Procedure, 4-2
Global Service User Interface, 5-17
GSUI, 5-17

H
Handle, 8-10
Hazard Icons, 1-4
HDD and Battery, 9-12
A-2 -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Human Safety, 1-7


HV Power, 5-14
HV Unit Assy, 8-48

I
iLinq, 5-16
Image Management, 4-15
Input Power, 10-7
Installation of Option Software, 8-81
Installation of Software, 8-71
Interconnect Cabling, 5-8

J
Jumper and Dip Switch Setting, 6-9

L
Label Locations, 1-9
Leakage Current Limits, 10-11
Loading Presets, 4-11
Lockout/Tagout Requirements, 4-14
Low Voltage, 5-13
LV Unit, 8-52

M
MDBRG, 6-11
MDCON Board, 8-46
Mechanical Safety, 1-7
Mid Processors, 5-5
MOD Drive, 4-7
Monitor, 8-18,, 9-4
Monitor Cover, 8-16
Monitor Shelf Assy, 8-22
Monitor Shelf Cover, 8-12
MOTHER Board, 8-46

O
OP Panel and Keys, 9-10
Operation Panel Assy, 8-28
Operation Panel Bottom Cover, 8-14

- A-3
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

Optional Peripherals, 3-11


Options, 9-16
Outlet Test, 10-12

P
Patient I/O (Option), 5-7
PC Box Assy, 8-38
Periodic Maintenance Schedule, 10-2
Peripheral Checks, 4-18
Peripheral Connection, 3-11
Peripheral/Option Checks, 10-7
Peripherals, 9-16
Phantom, 10-10
Physical Inspection, 10-8
Plastic Covers, 9-6
Plastic Kit Replacement, 8-2
Power Diagrams, 5-12
Power On, 4-2
Power On/Off Standby Switch, 4-3
Power Shutdown, 4-5
Power Supply Adjustments, 6-2
Power Units, 9-14
PREA, 6-9
Preliminary Checks, 10-5
Probe (Transducer) Connection, 3-8
Probe Connector Cleaning, 10-9
Probe Holder, 9-9
Probe Leakage Current Test, 10-20
Probe Maintenance, 10-9
Probe/Connectors Usage, 4-15
Probes, 9-17
Product Icons, 1-5
PROMP, 6-10

R
REAR CONN Assy, 8-45
Rear Cover, 8-4
Rear Panel, 5-7
Rear Panel Connector, 3-17
Recording Devices, 3-11,, 9-8
Required Features, 2-7
Requirements for Periodic Maintenance, 10-4
Restarting System, 4-5

A-4 -
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

S
Safety, 1-7
SCSI ID Number, 4-12
Service Login, 5-17
Side Cover, 8-2
Software Configuration Checks, 4-17
Speaker Assy, 8-21
Special Tools, 10-4
Supplies, 10-4
Swivel Function Adjustment, 6-5
System Clock, 3-5
System Configuration, 3-9
System Features, 4-15
System Maintenance, 10-5
System Manufacture, 1-13
System Mode Checks, 4-15
System Settings, 3-9
System Specifications, 3-7

T
Theory, 5-2
Top Console, 5-7
Top Cover, 8-8
Trackball Assy, 8-30
Transducers, 3-14
TRAP, 6-9
TX Power, 5-14

U
Ultrasound Room Layout, 2-8
Unpacking the Equipment, 3-3

V
Video Specifications, 3-15

W
Weight, 3-8
When There's Too Much Leakage Current..., 10-23

- A-5
GE HEALTHCARE
DIRECTION 5154945, REVISION 4 LOGIQ™ P5/A5 SERVICE MANUAL

A-6 -
© 2004 and 2008, General Electric Company.
GE Medical Systems, a General Electric Company, going to market as GE Healthcare.
3200 N. Grandview Boulevard
Waukesha, Wisconsin 53149
USA

www.gehealthcare.com

You might also like